,il:
1 i
Ih
jm
k
•M
1 111 l'
•w^m.
i
!
!
i'
i United States OHice of Research and EPA/620/R-94/021
: Environmental Protection Development July 1994
Agency Washington DC 20460
^^M
?/EPA
 Ecosystem
 Monitoring and
 Ecological Indicators

 An Annotated
 Bibliography
Environmental Monitoring and
Assessment Program

-------
                                         EPA/620/R-94/021
                                         July 1994
   Ecosystem Monitoring and
      Ecological Indicators:
   An Annotated Bibliography
              Compiled by

  Jerry A. Griffith* and Carolyn T. Hunsaker*

               *ECO, Inc.
              Boston, MA

      "Environmental Sciences Division
       Oak Ridge National Laboratory
             Oak Ridge, TN
             Project Officer
             M. Craig Barber
     Environmental Research Laboratory
    U.S. Environmental Protection Agency
              Athens, GA
 ENVIRONMENTAL RESEARCH LABORATORY
 OFFICE OF RESEARCH AND DEVELOPMENT
U.S. ENVIRONMENTAL PROTECTION AGENCY
        ATHENS, GA 30605-2720
                                    Printed on Recycled Paper

-------
                                           NOTICE

The information in this document has been funded wholly or in part by the United States Environmental
Protection Agency under Interagency Agreement Number DW899934440 with the U.S. Department of
Energy. Work was carried out by the Oak Ridge National Laboratory, which is managed by Martin
Marietta Energy Systems, Inc., under Contract Number DE-AC05-840R21400 with the U.S. Department
of Energy.  It has been subjected to the Agency's review, and it has been approved for publication as
an EPA document. Mention of trade names or commercial  products does not constitute endorsement
or recommendation for use.

The submitted  manuscript has been authored by a contractor of the U.S. Government under Contract
No. DE-AC05-840R21400. Accordingly, the U.S. Government retains a nonexclusive, royalty-free
license to publish or reproduce the published form  of the contribution, or allow others to do so, for U.S.
Government purposes.
                                         ABSTRACT

This annotated bibliography serves as the initial literature base for ecological indicators for regional
monitoring within the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency's (EPA's) Environmental Monitoring and
Assessment Program (EMAP).  Five hundred and fifty-six citations on issues surrounding indicators of
ecosystem condition and ecosystem monitoring were obtained through a combination of computerized
searches and manual searches of reference lists of selected literature. One section directs readers to
the literature judged to be the most relevant to EMAP at this point in the program's development.
Citations are classified into nine categories: indicators of ecosystem condition/ecosystem health,
general issues surrounding ecosystem monitoring,  ecological endpoints, fauna, flora, techniques, lower
hierarchical level indicators, social issues, and EMAP-associated articles.
Key words: Ecological monitoring, Ecological indicators, Ecosystem health, Ecosystem assessment,
Environmental quality, Stress-response, Stress ecology, Biological monitoring, State of environment


Preferred citation:
Griffith, J.A. and C.T. Hunsaker.  1994. Ecosystem monitoring and ecological indicators: An annotated
       bibliography. EPA/620/R-94/XXX. Athens, GA: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
       Research and Development, Environmental Research Laboratory.


                                      Acknowledgments

We thank the following scientists for their helpful reviews of this document: David Rapport of the
University of Ottawa, Laura Jackson of the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, and Dean Carpenter
of ManTech  Environmental Technology, Inc.  We  also thank Dean Carpenter for suggesting a list of key
words to  use with Current Contents.

-------
                                           Contents

I.  Introduction and Background .           .    .     .      	  1

2.  Methods for Literature Search 	  2

3.  Results	  3
       3.1. Annotation	  3

4.  Summary of Selected Literature	  4
       4.1. Monitoring 	  4
       4.2. Ecological Indicators and Ecosystem Response to Anthropogenic Disturbances	  5
       4.3. Criteria of Good Indicators	  11

5.  Conclusion	  11
       5.1 Suggested Future Directions  	  15

6.  Guide to Literature by Category	  16

7.  References	  17




                                       List of Appendices

Appendix A.    Search profile keywords used  with current contents and focus on:global change .  .  18
Appendix B.    Annotated Bibliography  	  20


                                         List of Figures
Figure 1.       Generalized framework of biological/ecological effects of contaminants at
               various hierarchial levels (Sheehan et al., 1984 and adapted from de Kruijf,
               1991)	  10


                                         List of Tables

Table 1.        Comparison of ecological health research and human health diagnosis (adapted
               from Rapport et al., 1979)  	  8
Table 2.        Criteria/characteristics of ecological indicators	  12
                                               iii

-------
                                 1. Introduction and Background


 Recent efforts in ecology have focused on examining anthropogenic stresses on a regional scale and
 assessing ecosystem condition (Graham et al., 1991; Hunsaker et al., 1990; Loehle,  1989; Schaeffer et
 al., 1988).  One program in particular, the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency's (EPA's)
 Environmental Monitoring and Assessment  Program (EMAP), has defined among its  goals to confirm
 that the nation's environmental protection efforts are truly maintaining or improving environmental
 quality (Hunsaker and Carpenter, 1990; Messer et al., 1991).  The selection of ecological indicators for
 monitoring and reporting plays a vital role as stated in the program objectives:

        •       estimate the current status, trends, and changes in indicators of the condition of the
               nation's ecological resources on a regional basis with known confidence;

        •       estimate the geographic coverage and extent of the nation's ecological resources with
               known confidence;

               seek associations between  selected indicators of natural and anthropogenic stresses
               and indicators of the condition of ecological resources; and

               provide annual statistical summaries and periodic assessments of the nation's
               ecological resources.

 EPA has initiated a new, "top down" approach to ecological risk assessment, focusing on larger
 geographic scales and higher levels of biological  organization.  Past  approaches to risk assessment
 have traditionally involved single-species toxicity  tests and media-specific exposure  models and are
 often done at local scales (Kutz et al., 1992).  EMAP's monitoring of the status and trends in the
 condition of representative ecosystems will serve as the foundation of EPA's Ecological Risk
 Assessment Program.  EMAP will develop and use biological response indicators to assess ecological
 conditions, and will also measure indicators of contaminant or stress exposure to identify relationships
 between changes in response indicators and changing stresses on ecosystems over  time.  Habitat
 indicators (e.g., salinity, sediment type, vertical vegetation composition, snags, etc.) will be measured to
 account for natural variations in biological response indicators (Kutz et al., 1992).

 The purpose of this document is to provide  a general literature base  for ecological indicators and
 ecosystem monitoring. Through the 1970s, the application of the concept of indicators of environmental
 condition generally was focused upon  organisms  as specific indicators of air pollution/quality, water
 pollution/quality, etc. (e.g., Harris, 1976; Thomas, 1972).  This type of indicator is still an integral part of
 ecology and environmental assessment (Freedman,  1989).  This document focuses on the literature
 that addresses general indicators of ecological condition and issues surrounding the  EMAP program
 and ecosystem monitoring; it is not a comprehensive  listing of references on every biological indicator
 used in pollutant accumulation studies or in the context of a particular cellular or physiological
 response.  It is also not a comprehensive bibliography on wetland indicators, forest indicators,
 agroecosystem indicators,  etc.; the eight EMAP Ecological Resource Groups (agricultural ecosystems,
 arid ecosystems, forests, integrated landscapes, near-coastal waters, the Great Lakes, inland surface
waters, and wetlands) are tracking the specific literature on individual indicators and monitoring
techniques of interest to their respective resources.  For more detailed references on indicators
 considered for use in specific resource classes, see Hunsaker and Carpenter (1990).  Additional
 sources of information on indicators and monitoring strategies are in  an "indicator development
 strategy" (Olsen, 1992) and in published reports and articles by the individual resource groups (Heck et
al., 1991; Hedtke et al., 1992; Holland, 1990; Kepner et al., 1991; Liebowitz et al.,  1991; Palmer et al.,
 1991; Paulsen et al., 1991; Riitters et al., 1992; Whittier and Paulsen, in press).

We review literature on indicators of ecosystem state, generalized ecosystem responses to
anthropogenic stresses, rationale of monitoring programs, monitoring program design, functional vs

-------
structural monitoring, environmental indices, ecological risk assessment, and extrapolation from effects
at lower levels (e.g., toxicity tests, organisms) to higher levels (e.g., communities and/or ecosystems) of
ecological organization.  This report is divided into three sections: (1) methods for the literature search,
(2) results, and (3) a summary of selected literature judged to be among the most relevant to the
development of programmatic guidance on ecological indicators and ecosystem  monitoring.
                                2. Methods for Literature Search
Three sources for the literature search were utilized: (1) DIALOG "on-line" services (DIALOG Services,
1991); (2) the bibliographic data bases Current Contents:  Agricultural, Biological, and Environmental
and Focus On: Global Change; and (3) actual reference lists/bibliographies from articles, books, and
proceedings.

Specific data bases used in the "on-line" searches were BIOSIS, 1969-1981, Enviroline 1970-1992,
Pollution Abstracts 1980-1992, Environmental Bibliography (1980-1992), and the NTIS  (National
Technical Information Service) CD-ROMs, 1985-1992. In desiring a broader treatment of indicators
(generally, at higher levels of biological organization than the individual level), the keywords
environmental/biological/ecological  indicator were chosen and crossed with ecosystem/ecology. Using
the former without crossing them with ecosystem or ecology resulted in too many cellular and
organism-level indicators.  Inclusion of such terms as stress, monitoring, and trends yielded too many
unrelated articles while specific queries on "ecosystem health" or ecosystem indicators resulted in few
or no appropriate references. Apparently, the terms "ecosystem indicator" and "ecosystem health" have
only  been infrequently used in the recent past. As more literature is produced in this  area, additional
keywords suggested for future literature reviews are: environmental assessments, environmental
analysis, ecosystem health, stress-response,  environmental effects, ecoepidemiology,
environmental/ecological indices, state of environment, and ecosystem indicator.

A brief description of the contents of each data base follows:

        BIOSIS — 9000 serials, technical reports,  and conference proceedings

        Enviroline — 5000 journals and proceedings

        Pollution Abstracts — 2500 conference papers and serials

        Environmental Bibliography — 400 journals (Dialog Services, 1991)

        NTIS (National Technical Information Service, Springfield, Virginia) — Covers government
        sponsored research, development and education.  Contains analyses prepared by over 240
        government agencies.

A search profile consisting of over 20 keywords/phrases/authors was created and used to search from
January 1, 1991, through December 7, 1992,  in Current Contents (ISI, 1991) and Focus On: Global
Change (ISI, 1991).  The search profile is listed in Appendix A. For these current data bases a broad
keyword search was performed because it was easy to manually sort references.  Using a broad
search allowed as many related articles on indicators and monitoring as possible to be obtained.
Descriptions of these literature data bases are:

        Current Contents (ISI, 1991): Contains information for 1200 publications per year, including 930
        journals;

        Focus On: Global Change  (ISI, 1991): Is a data base of 14,000 science and social science
        journals, books, and proceedings.

-------
The reference lists of most of the literature identified in the previous steps were checked for literature of
interest.  Because the topic was difficult to bound with keywords, it was considered necessary to
manually check for some literature to ensure a comprehensive bibliography.


                                            3. Results
The literature search yielded 556 references. As stated previously, the search focused on general
indicators of ecosystem condition and not on the myriad of organismal and biological indicators (e.g.,
contaminant accumulation in lichens, mussels, fish, or other animal and plant tissue).  Citations for
articles dealing with ecosystem response to stress, analysis of long-term ecological trends, and general
ecological/biological monitoring philosophy were included. The majority of the references were
identified by manually searching the reference lists of appropriate articles.  Less than one-fifth of the
articles were identified from the computerized searches.

3.1. Annotation

Whenever possible abstracts are included for a reference.  For acquired literature that did not provide
an abstract, either an excerpt from the literature, a short description of the contents, or a summary of
the issues covered is included.  Keywords were entered for articles which supplied such terms
(approximately 10% of the total citations). A directory to the literature is provided  by classifying
citations into one or more of the following nine categories.

       Indicators of ecosystem condition/ecological health: This category includes literature dealing
       specifically with the concept of ecosystem indicators or discussing responses of ecosystems to
       anthropogenic perturbations, parameters used to monitor or characterize ecosystems, the
       construction of environmental indices, or information on the implementation of ecosystem
       indicators such as criteria of a good indicator of ecosystem condition.

       Ecosystem monitoring/general issues: Literature included in this category covers issues such as
       the rationale behind monitoring, general monitoring of ecological condition, structural vs
       functional monitoring, and specific case studies of ecosystem monitoring.

       Endpoints: All articles discussing at length, or in part, ecological or  regulatory endpoints are
       included in this category. Suter (1989)  defines endpoints as "valued ecosystem attributes;
       quantitative or quantifiable expression of environmental values that are accessible to prediction
       or measurement."

       Fauna: Included in  this category is literature dealing with the use of animals at a higher level
       than the individual level or physiological level (i.e., where animals or guilds of animals are being
       used as indicators of ecosystem condition).

       Flora:  Literature that deals with individual plants, communities, or forests and vegetation
       complexes is included in this category.

       Techniques: Included in this category is literature discussing monitoring design, statistical
       analysis of ecological data for trend analysis, issues of extrapolation of effects at lower levels to
       ecosystem levels, remote sensing applications, etc.

       Individual or Lower Level: Literature placed into this category addresses issues at the individual
       organism or at lower levels  of biological organization such as bioassays, physiological
       indicators, etc.

       EMAP-related: Literature placed into this category either provides a background/overview of the
       EMAP program or addresses some issue or aspect of the program.  This category primarily

-------
       includes literature written by EMAP scientists and administrators but also contains some
       literature written about EMAP by persons outside the program.

       Social: Literature placed into this category covers such issues as sustainability or sustainable
       development indicators, human response to environmental change, public participation in
       environmental monitoring programs, prioritizing environmental problems, etc.  Such material
       relates to the selection of environmental values in EMAP's indicator strategy.


                               4. Summary of Selected Literature

The articles reviewed in this section are judged to be among the most relevant and  appropriate to
programmatic issues surrounding the  development of ecological indicators for a national program such
as EMAP.

Other literature reviews on the subject of environmental monitoring and environmental indicators have
been performed. In a background report for the Canadian State of the Environment program, Sheehy
(1989) provides an annotated bibliography on 45 indicators in six areas: quality of life indicators,
environmental indices, environmental  quality profiles, biological indicators, chemical  indicators, and
urban environmental indicators.  A review of this literature is synthesized into a discussion on
requirements of good indicators, problems and limitations in development and  application, and what is
needed to improve the art of indicator development.  Rajagopal and others (1992) present a review and
data base of literature on information  integration related to environmental monitoring and assessment.
"Indicators" is one subtopic covered within four broad areas:  Institutional issues, resource/ecological
issues, design issues (mathematical/statistical), and technological issues (computer, GIS, remote
sensing, and others).  In an extensive review of environmental monitoring for protected areas,
Slocombe (1992) discusses indicators in the context of environmental monitoring and the analysis of
ecosystem stresses and responses while providing a lengthy reference list with particular depth on
Canadian  environmental monitoring schemes.   An excellent source of information on  indicators with
particular relevance to EMAP and to regional and national monitoring schemes can  be found in the
proceedings of a recent international symposium on ecological indicators (McKenzie et al., 1992).

4.1. Monitoring

The National Research Council (1990) has recently  recommended conducting comprehensive
monitoring of regional and  national  ecological status and trends and strengthening the role of
monitoring in environmental management.  The Council determined that monitoring  information meets
many needs including: (1) providing information needed to evaluate pollution abatement problems, (2)
serving as an early warning system allowing for lower-cost solutions to environmental problems, (3)
contributing to knowledge of ecosystems and how they are affected by human activity, (4) providing
essential data to the construction, adjustment,  and verification of quantitative predictive models, which
are an important basis for evaluating, developing, and selecting environmental management strategies,
and (5) providing environmental managers the scientific rationale for setting environmental quality
standards.

The philosophy  and objectives upon which  a monitoring program is based are critical to the success of
the program and are mentioned frequently in the literature (Roberts,  1991; Usher, 1991; Miller, 1978;
Hinds, 1984; Hellawell, 1991; Herricks and  Schaeffer, 1987).  Miller (1978) discusses  some of the past
deficiencies of EPA's monitoring program (mainly in relation to regulatory monitoring). Bernstein (1992)
has attempted to provide a framework for incorporating managerial perspectives with the more technical
issues surrounding ecological indicators. The premise of Cullen (1990), that monitoring is necessary
because we need to know information about the state of the environment both to help in choosing
appropriate management action and in evaluating what our interventions have achieved is reflective of
some of EMAP's objectives.  Hellawell (1990) presents three categories of reasons  for instituting a
monitoring program that also echo some of EMAP's objectives: (1) assessing the effectiveness of  policy
or legislation, (2) regulatory, and (3) detecting incipient change. Schindler (1987) lists characteristics of
successful monitoring programs: (1) they must be inexpensive enough to survive budget cuts in funding

-------
 agencies; (2) they must be simple and verifiable, so they are little affected by changes in personnel;
 and (3) they must include measurements which are highly sensitive to changes in ecosystems.  Good
 monitoring formats and bad formats (the "collect [data] now, think [of a good question] later" format) are
 described by Roberts (1991). Usher (1991) proposes a hierarchical set of questions that should be
 answered when implementing a monitoring system:

        Purpose:  What is the aim of monitoring?

        Method: How can this aim be achieved?

        Analysis:  How are the data, which will be collected periodically, to be handled?

        Interpretation: What might the data mean?

        Fulfillment: When will the aim have been achieved?

 In his stepwise methodology for a monitoring plan, Hinds (1984) stresses the importance of properly
 designed monitoring plans and describes some of the difficulties of ecosystem level monitoring as
 opposed to monitoring of organisms.

 What constitutes ecosystem integrity is another question that a national monitoring program must
 contend with.  Kay (1991) provides a framework for assessing ecosystem integrity by determining how
 an ecological system is moved away from an optimum operating  point due to changing environmental
 conditions. Karr (1987, 1991) discusses biological integrity for water resources and maintains that
 monitoring and assessment should be guided by: the need to preserve human health; the need to
 preserve aesthetic, recreational, and other uses of biological systems for direct human benefit; and  the
 need to preserve  life support systems that provide  both goods and services to human society through
 maintenance of healthy ecosystems. Steedman and Regier (1990) list the following characteristics of
 ecosystems with regard to ecological integrity: (1) energetic in that natural ecosystemic processes are
 strong and not severely constrained; (2) self-organizing,  in an emerging, evolving way; (3) self-
 defending against invasions by exotic organisms; (4) having biotic capabilities in reserve to survive and
 recover from occasional severe crises; (5) attractive, at least to informed humans; and (6) productive of
 goods and opportunities valued by humans.

 The literature stresses the importance of connecting monitoring and the choice of indicators to human
 values. Relevance to issues of concern to  humans is the most useful criterion in selecting indicators of
 ecosystem health (Kelly and Harwell, 1990).  Schroevers (1981) emphasizes the need for ecologists to
 help define the notion of quality, not by imparting what is bad or good but by providing the arguments
 necessary to  make judgements. As Green (1984) aptly asserts, "if the ecologist has not established
 any linkage between the public concern and the criterion variables used in his study, then it may be
 that nobody else will do it either."  To avoid meaningless data collection and wasted finances, a greater
 emphasis is needed on defining the questions to be answered by a monitoring program.   Perry and
 others (1987) declare that the primary objective of monitoring programs should be "asking the right
 questions at the right time and then collecting only that data necessary to answer the questions."


 4.2. Ecological Indicators  and  Ecosystem Response to Anthropogenic Disturbances

The selection, use, and development of ecological indicators used to characterize the response of
 ecosystems to various stresses will be crucial to the success of EMAP's monitoring endeavors.
Suggested  research on characterizing ecosystem response to anthropogenic perturbations emanates
from several sources. These include calls for increased understanding in the areas of long-term
monitoring, ecosystem response to disturbance, "leading environmental indicators," or status of the
state of the environment (Draggan et al., 1987; Lubchenco et al.,  1991; Barrett, 1976, 1978; Hildebrand
et al., 1987; Aim, 1991; Environmental Protection Agency,  1988; Holling, 1986, Huntley et al.,  1992;
 National Research Council,  1990).

-------
Ecological monitoring, which serves as the sensory tool for ecological risk management, is critical to the
understanding of long-term trends. Of paramount importance in ecological monitoring/assessment
programs is the concept of ecological indicators and the specific measurements used for these
indicators.  An indicator is defined as  a characteristic of the environment that, when measured,
quantifies the magnitude of stress, habitat characteristics, degree of exposure to a stressor, or degree
of ecological response to the exposure (Hunsaker and Carpenter,  1990). The concept of ecological
indicators has thus evolved from not only including analysis of bioaccumulation of xenobiotic material in
organisms or presence/absence of individuals or species but also to indicators of total ecosystem
functioning and structure.

Much of the literature on the assessment of ecological condition and stress ecology discusses
generalized responses of ecosystems to stress and should prove helpful in deciding which ecological
parameters to choose as indicators for quantifying the degree of stress and thus indicating condition.
Woodwell (1970) is among the earliest of researchers to generalize ecosystem and community
response to pollutants. His hypotheses stem from experiments on the effect of ionizing radiation on an
oak-pine community.  Odum (1985) categorized 18 generalized responses (trends) of ecosystems to
stress into four areas:

       Energetics
                      community respiration increases;
                      production/respiration becomes unbalanced (< or > 1);
                      production/biomass and respiration/biomass (maintenance:biomass structure)
                      ratios increase;
                      importance of auxiliary energy increases; and
                      exported or unused primary production increases.

       Nutrient Cycling
                      nutrient turnover increases; and
                      horizontal transport increases and vertical cycling of nutrients decreases; and
                      nutrient loss increases (system becomes more "leaky").

       Community Structure
                      proportion of  r-strategists increases;
                      size of organism decreases;
                      lifespans of organisms or parts (e.g., leaves) decrease;
                      food chains shorten because of reduced energy flow at higher trophic levels
                      and/or greater sensitivity of predators to stress; and
                      species diversity decreases and dominance increases; if original diversity is
                      low, the reverse may occur; at the ecosystem level, redundancy of parallel
                      processes theoretically declines.

       General System-level Trends
                      ecosystems become more open (i.e., input and output environments become
                      more important as internal cycling is reduced);
                      autogenic successional trends reverse (succession reverts to earlier stages);
                      efficiency  of resource use decreases;
                      parasitism and other negative interactions increase, and mutualism and other
                      positive interactions decrease; and
                      functional properties (such as community metabolism) are more robust
                      (homeostatic  or resistant to stressors) than are  species composition and other
                      structural  properties.

Odum's hypothesis is that a disturbance to which a community is not adapted reverses autogenic
development.  Schindler (1987, 1990) has compared these 18 generalizations to actual responses to
acidification observed in experimental lakes.

The metaphorical employment of the  ecosystem-as-organism concept and medical diagnosis analogy
as heuristic tools have been frequently used in assessing  ecological condition, most recently in a series

-------
of articles by Rapport and others. An introduction to the concept of "ecosystem medicine" is provided
in Rapport and others (1979), who outline possible questions in stress ecology that could be
investigated using analogous medical science methodology such as identifying ecological correlates to
human health "vital signs" to serve as diagnostic protocols, observing the presence of early-warning
signals of degradation, using epidemiology in studying biological invasions or ecosystem pathology, and
observing the presence of sensitive zones in ecosystems (Table 1). They compare the study of stress
in ecosystems with  the study of stress in organisms using the principles of Selye's General Adaptation
Syndrome, a physiology concept which identifies symptoms of stress in mammalian systems.  Rapport
has termed this kind of analysis "clinical ecology" (1992a).  Some of his selected response variables
are: nutrient pools in systems;  primary productivity; size distribution of dominant biota; species diversity;
and system retrogression, or an apparent reversion to an earlier successional stage involving among
other characteristics, a shift in  species composition to more opportunistic species; a simplification of
communities; the opening of niches; the loss of nutrient inventory; etc.  These generalized responses to
stress form the basis of an "ecosystem distress syndrome" (Rapport et al., 1985). In  later papers,
Rapport outlines the issues surrounding the diagnosis of ecosystem health. General approaches to
assessing ecosystem health are outlined in  Rapport (1989) and Rapport and Regier (1980). The
diagnosis of ecosystem health  and identification of ecosystem critical characteristics are discussed in
Rapport (1984) and Rapport and others (1981).  A case study of the Baltic Sea provides an example of
the application of this concept  (Rapport, 1989).  Norton (1989) also recognizes useful aspects of the
medical analogy as it: (1) acknowledges the dynamism of natural systems, (2) emphasizes relationships
among parts  of the  system and relationship of the functioning parts to the larger whole,  and (3)
encourages useful rules of thumb in the area of contextual management. However, Norton
acknowledges that the medical analogy does not provide an operable definition of ecosystem health; it
does  not set ecological condition goals to which managers must strive.

The concept of ecosystem health has also been promoted by Schaeffer and others (1988, 1991, 1992).
The medical science metaphor is utilized again as the roles of the human/veterinary physician and what
is termed "ecological system physician" are  compared.  A table is presented identifying  54 ecosystem
measures in relation to eight critical ecosystem characteristics: (1) habitat for desired  diversity and
reproduction of organisms; (2)  phenotypic and genotypic diversity among the organisms; (3) a robust
food chain supporting the desired biota; (4)  an adequatenutrient pool for desired organisms; (5)
adequate nutrient cycling to perpetuate the ecosystem; (6) adequate energy flux for maintaining the
trophic structure; (7) feedback  mechanisms  for damping undesirable oscillations; and  (8) the capacity to
temper toxic effects, including the capacity to decompose, transfer, chelate or bind anthropogenic inputs
to a degree that they are no longer toxic within the system (Schaeffer et al.,  1988).  An  earlier version
of this information is provided in Herricks and Schaeffer (1987).  Seven generalized responses of
ecosystems to stress are also provided. In  Schaeffer (1991), a comparison of classical  toxicology with
ecotoxicology, comparing animal and ecosystem responses to chemical exposures, is provided.
Chapman (1992) also provides a discussion of ecosystem health in a synthesis of material presented at
a conference devoted to the subject.  Of note in his article is the observation that among the 100
mostly professionals in attendance at that conference, not even a consensus was reached that a
definition of ecosystem health was possible.  This suggests that an assessment of the meaning of
ecological change observed in  long-term monitoring of ecosystems may be a difficult and controversial
task.

Schaeffer (1992) also evaluates the concept of an ecosystem threshold. Investigation into this area of
"ecosystem health" would provide information on the point at which, when crossed, ecosystems begin
to break down. An  associated  question is whether, in fact, thresholds exist, or whether  all impacts are
effective and  cumulative.  Herricks and Schaeffer (1987) provide a  review of test system (analysis units
ranging from simple biochemical assays to experimental manipulation of ecosystems)  selection for
ecosystem response to chemical exposure and provide a chart identifying for such test systems
individual level measures, measures for populations and below, system level factors and abiotic
elements.  Data characteristics (variability, sensitivity, and reproducibility) of common biomonitoring
measures (organization, function, state descriptors and habitat assessment) are provided in Herricks
and Schaeffer (1985).

Several scientists provide a counterpoint to the metaphorical usage of the concept of ecosystem health.
Suter (1993 in press) argues for caution in using multiparameter indices and the medical analogy.

-------
Table 1.        Comparison of ecological health research and human health diagnosis (adapted from
               Rapport etal., 1979)
 Ecological research question area
Analogous human health area
 Early warning indicators of ecosystem
 transformation
 Exotic plant/animal/virus
 invasion or outbreak of native
 indigenous pathogens

 The presence of "sensitive zones"
 in ecosystems


 Do ecosystems develop immunity to
 to particular classes of combinations
 of stress?
Early warning indicators of disease (e.g., the
CEA carcinoembryonic antigen as an indicator of
early intestinal cancer)

Epidemiology
The study of certain parts of the body that
are crucial to functioning and well-being
of the whole

Immune antibody responses to foreign antigens

-------
 Suter considers the "ecosystem health" concept a poor metaphor because unlike organisms,
 ecosystems are not consistently structured, do not develop in a consistent and predictable manner, and
 do not have mechanisms like the  neural and hormonal systems of organisms to maintain homeostasis.
 Statements attesting to the usefulness of analogous concepts such as "economic health" are not
 considered appropriate by Suter because economists, unlike environmental managers, have well-
 defined goals for an acceptable state of the economy.  Suter believes health is simply not an
 operational property of ecosystems and that a collected set of ecosystem properties combined into an
 index may have the following faults: ambiguity, the eclipsing of one variable by others, arbitrary
 weighting of variables, lack of measures possessing real-world units (monetary, for example),  and the
 obscuring of variables which make diagnostic analyses of environmental problems difficult.  Amir and
 Hyman (1992) also do not think that the ecosystem health concept is presently operable, but develop
 ecosystem stock and  flow variables as ecological health indicators in a step toward operability.  Kelly
 and Harwell (1989) believe the ecological/human health analogy is unsatisfying due to the complexity
 and variability in ecosystems. Calow (1992) believes "health" can be objectively understood when
 discussing organisms and populations, but does not deem the same concept as applicable to
 ecosystems.

 Finally, in addition to the medical  analogy approach is the environmental assessment framework of
 Loehle (1989) (and Loehle et al.,  1990a; Loehle et al.,  1990b), which emphasizes the successional
 characteristics of ecosystems because the majority of ecosystems have been influenced by
 anthropogenic disturbance. The assessment in this case  depends on how closely ecosystems are
 progressing along the expected successional sequence.

 Sheehan (1984) and Miller (1984) diagram the responses of ecological systems to toxic pollutants at
 varying temporal (days to centuries) and spatial scales: cellular/ physiological, individual, populations,
 and communities/ecosystems/landscapes (also adapted by de Kruijf, 1991) (Figure  1). Kimmins (1990)
 also provides a review of lower hierarchical level indicators (physiological and species).  Taub (1989)
 comments on assumptions and generalizations surrounding the implementation of indicators of
 environmental change and recommends new research on promising indicators of change.  Assumptions
 about indicators that are analyzed include such assertions as "human impacts will have different
 indicators than natural impacts," "all ecosystems will respond in the same manner to stress," and "a
 magic index exists that requires no detailed study."

 Kelly and  Harwell (1989, 1990) provide a thorough overview of the mechanisms involved in ecological
 disturbance and the issues surrounding evaluation of anthropogenic stress on the environment including
 exposure, response, recovery, and uncertainties in analysis (resulting from variability in exposure and
 ecosystems, and extrapolation across types of stress and ecosystems).  They present the basics for
 analyzing  ecological disturbances  within the framework of ecological risk assessment, and distinguish
 between four different purposes of indicators: intrinsic importance, early warning indicators, sensitive
 indicators, and process indicators.  Intrinsic importance refers to valuable species, endangered species,
 or other aspects of direct importance to humans.  The primary importance of early warning indicators is
 their rapid indication of effect. These types of indicators can be used as "red flags" to alert attention to
 a possible problem. Sensitive indicators focus on  actual responses rather than potential ecological
 effects.  In this case, there should be a strong specificity to a type of stress.  Process indicators
 highlight change in ecological functions and processes.  These indicators could also serve as early-
 warning or sensitive indicators. Indicators of ecosystem vulnerability focus on both  abiotic and
 biological aspects and include geochemical character, presence of physical refugia, linearity of food
 webs leading to a major species, etc.  De Kruijf (1989) also discusses these same issues while adding
 a discussion on extrapolation of effects at lower levels of biological organization to higher levels.
 Harwell and Harwell (1989) examine the complexity of ecosystem response to chemical exposure by
 discussing direct biological effects, indirect biological effects, ecosystem level effects, and extrapolation
 Issues.  Johnson (1988a, 1988b) analyzes ecosystem response to stress by  representing ecological
 parameters as multidimensional state vectors in a  Cartesian space.

The use of animals as indicators of ecosystem properties and responses, specifically to air emissions,
 Is presented in Newman and Schreiber (1984), in which a reference list for specific  case studies is also
 provided.  Indicators of biodiversity are provided by Noss (1991) and Williams and Marcot (1991).
 Other literature provides specific environmental parameters (indicators) used In monitoring wilderness

-------
2

01

C3
       <
       o
       Q.
                    ffl
                       ;«•*.•
                                L
                                            "I
                                             I

                                             U
                                                 Ul
                                           _S —
                                                                                                o J=
      LU
           Sal
l.i
IS-
                                                 10

-------
areas (Brims et al., 1991, 1992), national parks (Hermann and Stottlemyer, 1989), and in The
Netherlands (de Haes et al., 1989). Keddy (1992) reports on some of the issues surrounding
indicators, including the selection of indicators and monitoring in relation to environmental prediction
and decision-making.

4.3. Criteria of Good Indicators

The selection of indicators for characterizing ecosystem condition and their ongoing evaluation will be
an integral part of an environmental monitoring program.  Indeed, some believe that the Choice of
measurements (indicators) selected acts as a keystone in framing environmental  problems  (Albert! and
Parker, 1991).  A summary of criteria for indicators expressed in the literature is provided in Table 2.
Schaeffer and Herricks (1987) provide criteria for "measure" selection, with particular emphasis on
biological measures. Schaeffer and others (1988) provide criteria for determining ecosystem health.
Rapport (1990) provides the "three Rs" for a good indicator: relevance, robustness, and reliability.
Krantzberg (1990) and Day (1990) provide criteria for indicators with reference to the Canadian State of
the Environment Program.  Liverman (1989)  provides criteria for desirable global  sustainability
indicators.  Frost (1992) states that indicators may have two desirable but possibly contradicting
properties: (1) sensitivity to a variety of anthropogenic stresses and (2) predictability in unperturbed
ecosystems.  Since sensitive parameters may show some degree of unpredictable variability, the choice
of ecological indicators will involve compromising these two factors.  Miller (1984) also describes
characteristics of a good indicator. Still other authors synthesize various listings of criteria of good
indicators (Cairns and McCormick, 1992; Seidl and Murray, 1991; Sheehy,  1989).

Taub (1989) confronts some of the assumptions and generalizations about the implementation of
ecological indicators.  Marshall and Ryder  (1987) provide criteria for animals as indicators ofecosystem
health, specifically referring to the Great Lakes system. Kelly and Harwell (1990) distinguish between
two types of indicators: screening indicators (to act as a red flag) and state-specific indicators.  Riltters
(1990) provides indicator criteria for the assessment of forest health: strategic value, tactical value, and
scientific credibility.

                                         5. Conclusion

This bibliography is intended to serve as a comprehensive reference to literature  on general topics
related to ecological indicators and ecosystem/environmental monitoring. Environmental scientists and
managers within EMAP  and those persons involved in ecological monitoring and indicators  should
familiarize themselves with the literature in this document when conducting ecological assessments.

The use of such terms as ecosystem health and ecosystem indicator appear to be relatively new and
not yet common in the scientific and environmental literature.  The development of ecological indicators
at the ecosystem level and on  a regional scale is a science in its infancy, and accurate indicators of
ecological condition are  still being determined (Herricks et al., 1989).  Nonetheless, literature is rapidly
being produced in the subject area and more articles directly addressing the issue will undoubtedly
appear in the coming decade.  For future searches where more detailed or mechanism-specific
indicators are desired, the approach suggested by American Management Systems (1987)  may prove
fruitful.  For obtaining a  more thorough search of the term "endpoint," they suggested searching a
desired stressor (e.g., acid rain), in which case an abundance of literature exists,  most likely including
effects on ecosystem processes and structure.

Regardless of the actual choices, an adequate monitoring system designed to assess ecological
condition on a regional scale will consist of a multivariate  suite of indicators integrating biological,
chemical, and physical measures and integrating hierarchical levels (Cairns, 1990a; Izrael and Munn,
1986; Karr, 1987; Kelly and Harwell, 1990; Loehle, 1989;  Munn, 1988; Riitters, 1992; Schaeffer et al.,
1988; Spellerberg, 1991) rather than placing  inordinate emphasis on any one or two indicators.
                                               11

-------
     •a
     *
     10

     i
     i
       c.
I
T3
51
o
g

"o

8
•~
w




1
O
CM
5  jo

Cfl  O
           s   1
           •= s ?


           If 3
           p  S1
           O O  O c:
           >5 *3  O ^-
           2 jg  $ <£
           -° CD -= W

           2 =  Is"
             (D  5?) CD
           <» a -? -s
£  2 c
to  a.'w
Unc
                          i-



                          1
Cost-effectiven
                                     s *
                                     «S
ay
                                 2s    » c   «

                                 2s    El   =
                          S J   * a    g-3-   |

                          8/^j   si    8:2   s I"
                          Q--   Q- 2
Is
bio logical-*
hierarchy,
-n
$
11
f«
experiment
connection
(/>
1
O
f
&
organisms
CD
.c
o
(D
>
2
u5
c:
Must be se
to
c
o
•5
-o
8
s
environmei

I
§
CD
C
E

CO
en
2
-Sensitive
(0
0)
tude chang
jnge of
magni'
-Have a rs
i«
J?l
ise that wil
ntiation of
S £
Q- (D
»l
$
onsequenc
o
0
                                                                               ^3

                                                                             0) (TJ
                                                                             -C ±i
                                                                             -" 3
                                                                             "  CD -^
                                                                             CD ^ Q.
                                                                                1^!
                                                   £   S.
                                                                             rr  e £
                                 o

                                 CD
                                 O
                                 c




                                 I
                                 1

                                 I-
                                        CD


                                        T3
                                                              .g-


                                                              1
                                       £• 2 2 "

                                       i I §1
                                                  •S   CD CD
                               °1
                               •5 S
                     S E
                              1?!
                              C "tt -i
                              -i£ $ O

                              3 X O
                              O 
in
    S
    13

    O .
i!  5 E
n  > CD
O T3 O
£  g M

CO  CO T3
                                                     •D 1  O

                                                     2 3  «
                                     SEE   ~

                                     8-^S   ^1


                                     "H   1-
                                     IS -o  *"   P -S
                                                                                                                                   OJ
                                                                                            II
II  I
E

-5

CD
_O


2
U
O
.C
to
                                                                                               --

                                                                                              -S o
o
^:
CO
                                                                                                   cc <

-------
     s
  M
 r*i

Illi
  I

  *
  It
ill
    75. E «
   _ « "B o

   * iii
   ¥ li!
CM


I
    I

                               i
                I*
                f 2
                I 3
                I*
             •s
           I  §1

           i o  oo 8
               1
      .  I i
      1  « £
      •s  I si-
           S
           1.
                 i s %
                 111
                 ij *
                             1
                            il
                            4> t
                           «| 1 « §
                          '^ .2 5 !t -c
                                     s|l

                                                    i
                          if
                       s
                       s =
»  i  if^  «a|§sjc
I  i  ill  iii«  sfi

                                      1
                                                                   CO
                 I

                 •- "5
                 _>. $
                 § I




                 •6 I

                 li
               p   I p

-------
                            JJ
                               g
                                •
 •g
'§
 a.
 i
   8
   Q.
                               cr o
                                     nd
                                     m S.
                                     i.?
                                     £
                                               O
                                               o


                                               5"
                                     §. § o

                                     5. *• t


                                     5- I I
                                     5!? 5
IS  s
|3  §
                                         o  *
                                         a-  s
                                       5 »  —

                                       f»  i
                                       §1-9
                                       a I-

-------
5.1  Suggested Future Directions

The review of this literature on ecosystem monitoring and indicators of ecological condition has revealed
a great variety of information on general responses of ecosystems and foundations for a good monitoring
program. Ecologists need to work towards defining what is "good" ecological condition and to determine
how useful or misleading the "ecosystem health" analogy is.  Although scientists  and environmental
managers promoting the ecosystem health concept do not regard ecosystems as organisms, there still
exists the notion among some that this abstraction connotes an ecosystem/human medicine analogy which
may prove misleading when communicating environmental information to the public.
                                             15

-------
                             6. Guide to Literature by Category

Indicators of Ecosystem Condition/Ecosystem Health - 2, 4-6, 8, 9, 11, 12, 14, 17, 32-35, 37, 39-41,
44, 47, 53, 59-61, 63, 71, 78, 79, 81, 84-87, 89, 92, 96-98, 103, 105-107, 110-112, 114, 117, 119, 120,
123,  125, 126, 128-130, 133, 138,  140, 145, 149-153, 157, 161,  164, 165, 169, 171-173, 175, 176, 178,
183-188, 190, 192, 198, 203-206, 210-214, 216-219, 222, 224-227, 230, 235, 236, 239, 240, 243, 244-247,
249-251, 253-255, 257, 259-261, 264, 265, 268-271, 273-276, 278-280, 282, 283, 286, 288, 291-293, 299,
301,  310-312, 316, 319, 320, 324, 325, 329, 333, 335, 342, 344, 353-356, 359, 360, 362, 365, 371, 376,
378,  379, 382, 385, 387, 388, 390, 394, 395, 398, 400-402, 404-406, 409, 410, 413, 414-429, 431, 432,
436,  441-443, 453, 454, 457, 458, 460, 462, 463, 465, 472, 475-478, 481, 483, 484, 486, 487, 489, 490,
491,  496, 499, 501, 503, 505, 506, 508, 509, 512, 520, 528, 531, 533, 536, 538, 545, 547, 551, 556

Ecosystem Monitoring - general issues - 1, 3, 7, 13, 15-18, 24-30, 33, 34, 37, 42-46, 49-51, 54, 57-60,
62, 64-70, 75, 77, 80, 88-91, 93, 94, 99, 101, 104, 106, 108, 113, 114, 118, 119, 121, 123, 124, 132, 134,
138-144, 146, 152,  159-163, 165-167, 172, 177, 184,  189, 191, 192, 194, 196-199, 201, 202, 207, 208,
215,  229, 231, 238, 241, 246, 249-251, 253, 258, 260-264, 269, 270, 272, 282, 285, 287-293, 297, 300-
304,  309, 318, 320, 321, 324-327,  330-332, 334, 336, 337, 339, 343, 345-349, 358, 364, 368, 370, 372,
375,  378-381, 384, 389, 391-393, 396, 397, 402, 403, 413, 433, 435, 438, 440, 444-447, 451, 452, 453,
455,  462, 466, 471, 472, 474, 486, 490, 491, 502, 503, 511, 522, 523, 534, 535, 540, 546, 548, 553

Endpolnts - 6, 70, 74, 76, 86, 115, 123, 153, 163, 182, 185, 217-219, 221, 254, 255, 275, 276, 288, 504-
506

Fauna-28, 39-41,52, 63, 100,  103, 106, 107, 128, 143, 145, 152, 157, 161, 178,218,224,245,266,269,
270,  273, 277-279, 283, 306, 316, 339, 340, 342, 347, 353-356, 387, 436, 437, 474, 491, 501, 507, 508,
521,547

Flora- 1, 11, 29, 36, 38, 42, 60, 62, 117, 125, 138, 143, 162, 165, 178, 218, 223, 225, 236, 261, 282, 312,
318,  320, 331, 337, 365, 411, 413, 442, 443, 451, 479, 480, 482, 487-489, 491, 500, 512, 514, 540, 550

Techniques - 2, 19-21, 30, 31, 33, 34, 44-46, 55, 57, 58, 82, 83, 88, 90, 93, 95, 99, 109, 140, 141, 155,
168,  170, 185, 193, 196, 198, 202, 205, 241, 242, 262, 284, 287, 294, 295, 297, 298, 300, 303, 304, 307,
309,  328, 330, 332, 341, 343, 348, 361-363, 377, 378, 380, 397-399, 403, 413,  414, 423, 430, 450, 452,
454,  459, 464, 465, 516, 520, 521, 523, 527, 538

Individual or lower-level - 6, 10, 12,  29, 35, 38, 80, 112, 120, 122, 138, 143, 162, 169, 178, 186, 190,
204,  218, 224, 262, 267, 280, 283, 285, 286, 289, 311, 312, 316, 318, 320, 339, 348, 394, 408, 441, 459,
462,  473, 482, 514, 524, 554

EMAP-related - 20, 48, 53, 99, 193, 217-219, 242, 275, 276, 281, 291, 307, 320, 323-326, 361-363, 376,
388,  392, 393, 445, 543, 545

Social Issues - 25, 91, 96, 105, 114,  121, 125,  129, 131, 136, 174, 181, 210, 211, 222, 292, 301, 317,
319,  338, 344, 345, 352, 359, 360, 369, 382, 383, 412, 413, 417, 429, 444, 447, 458, 472, 492, 499, 522,
539
                                             16

-------
                                       7. References

DIALOG Information Systems. 1990. User's Guide to DIALOG. DIALOG Information Systems.

Heck, W.,  C. Campbell. G. Hess, J. Meyer, T. Moser, S.  Peck, J. Rawllngs, and A. Finkner. 1991.
Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP) — Agroecosystem Monitoring and
Research Strategy. EPA/600/4-91/013.  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Washington, DC.

Hedtke, S., A. Pilli, D. Dolan, G. McRae, B. Goodno, M.  Henry, R. Kreis, J. Eaton, R. Hoke, G.
Warren, D. Swackhammer, and S. Lozano. 1992.  Draft EMAP—Great Lakes Monitoring and
Research Strategy. June. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and Development,
Duluth, MN.

Holland, A.F., ed. 1990. Near Coastal Program Plan for 1990: Estuaries. EPA/600/4-90/033. U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency, Environmental Research Laboratory, Office of Research and
Development, Narragansett, Rl.

ISI (Institute for Scientific Information). 1991. Current Contents. Informational  Leaflet. Philadelphia,
PA.

ISI (Institute for Scientific Information). 1991. FOCUS ON:Global  Change. Informational Leaflet.
Philadelphia, PA.

Kepner, W., C. Fox, J. Baker, R. Breckenridge, C. Elvidge, V. Eno, J. Flueck, S. Franson, J.
Jackson, B. Jones, M. Meyer, D. Mouat, M. Rose, and C. Thompson. 1991. Arid Ecosystems
Strategic Monitoring Plan, 1991. EPA 600/4-91/018 Presissue copy.  U.S. Environmental Protection
Agency, Environmental Monitoring Systems  Laboratory, Las Vegas,  NV.

Llebowltz, N., L.  Squires, and J. Baker. 1991. Research  Plan for Monitoring Wetland Ecosystems.
EPA/600/3-91/-10. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Environmental Research Laboratory,
Corvallis, OR.

Olsen, A.R., ed. 1992. The Indicator Development Strategy for the Environmental Monitoring and
Assessment Program. EPA/600/3-91/023. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency Environmental
Research Laboratory, Corvallis, OR.

Palmer, C., K. Riitters, T. Strickland, D. Cassell, G.  Byers, M. Papp, and C. Liff. 1991.  Monitoring
and Research Strategy for Forests—Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP).
EPA/600/4-91/012. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,  Washington, DC.

Paulsen, S., D. Larson, P. Kaufman, T. Whittier, J. Baker, D. Peck, J. McGue, R. Hughes, D.
McMullen, D. Stevens, J. Stoddard, J. Lazorchak, W. Kinney, A.  Selle, and R. Hjort. 1991. EMAP-
Surface Waters Monitoring and Research Strategy: Fiscal Year 1991. EPA/600/3-91/022. Environmental
Research Laboratory, Office of Research and Development, U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency,
Corvallis, OR.


Note: All other references cited in the introductory text appear in the annotated bibliography in
Appendix B.
                                            17

-------
Appendix A.   Search profile keywords used with current contents and focus on:global change
                                              18

-------
(Ecosystem* or Ecol* or Environment*) and Indicator*
(Biol* Indicat*) or Bioindicator* or Biomarker* or (Biol* and Marker*)
Landscape Ecology
Ecos* or Ecol*
Indicat*
Index or Indices
Landscape*
Wildlife or Forest* or Wetland*
Lake* or Desert* or Coast*
Response*
Endpoint* or Predict*
(Expos* or Effect*) and (Man or Anthropo* or Climat* or Manag* or Pollut* or Disturb* or Impact)
Remote or Agroecosystem* or Arid
Stress* or Monitor*

Note: An * denotes a wild card, meaning that any suffix added to a word at the * will be searched.
                                              19

-------
Appendix B.     Annotated Bibliography
     20

-------
 LAddison, P. 1989.  Monitoring the health of a forest: A Canadian approach. Environ. Monitor. Assess.
 12:39-48.

 In Canada, acid rain is the generic term encompassing all forms of air pollution including wet and dry
 deposition, gaseous pollutant concentrations, and airborne particulates.  It was because these
 pollutants, alone or in  combination, may directly or indirectly affect the health of Canada's forests, that
 in 1984, the Canadian Forestry Service initiated a national forest monitoring program (Acid Rain
 National Early Warning System or ARNEWS).

 Research studies on pollutant effects of the past 15-20 years have demonstrated that it is not possible
 to define specific symptoms of acid rain or mixtures of pollutants on native tree species or specific
 responses of the forest ecosystem. Consequently, ARNEWS monitored incipient acid rain effects by
 determining the forest's state of health rather than by concentrating on specific pollutant responses.

 The detection system  entails experienced insect and disease survey forest rangers assessing both
 specific plots and the forest as a whole for extraordinary forest damage.  The techniques used include
 mensurational and symptomatological measurements as well as evaluation of stands for damage from
 natural and anthropogenic causes. Critical also to the system was the capability of the Canadian
 Forestry Service to support the detection system with research staff who could carry out studies to
 explain any abnormalities in forest condition  detected during the annual surveys. The ultimate outcome
 of the monitoring system, if unexplained forest damage is detected, is a research project on possible
 causes.

 2.Albert!, M.  and J.D. Parker. 1991.  Indices of environmental quality: The search for credible
 measures. EIA Rev. 11:95-101.

 Monitoring environmental change is much more difficult than most people think.  Environmental
 changes are difficult to interpret without a clear understanding of how environmental systems work.
 There are sharp disagreements among scientists and policymakers concerning the best measures and
 methods for measuring changes in environmental quality. In this "Viewpoint" article, the authors argue
 that the measures and methods used to monitor the status of the environment play an  important  role in
 framing environmental problems and in shaping the way we think about possible solutions.  They
 suggest that the success of environmental monitoring activities and their impact on policy-making
 depend above all on the ability to handle disagreement among experts.

 S.AIdhous, P. 1992. UK sets 'early warning  system'. Nature 355:383.

 This brief news item is quoted here: London: Nine UK government agencies, led by the Natural
 Environment Research Council, are setting up a new 'early warning system' designed to detect
 environmental change. Starting with eight stations, the Environmental Change Network (ECN) aims to
 monitor a range of British terrestrial ecosystems, recording a suite of data from simple meteorological
 measurements to samples of soil invertebrates. The network is expected to help to define future UK
governmental environmental  policy, but more stations may have to be added to distinguish between
 local environmental fluctuations and national trends. Relatively few countries have set up similar
 monitoring networks. The new British effort joins similar monitoring schemes in China, Sweden, and
the United States.

 4. Allmov, A., V.  Bul'on, B.  Gutel'makher,  and M. Ivanova.  1979. Use of biological and ecological
 indicators for determining the degree of pollution of natural waters.  (English translation of Vodnye
 Resursy). Water Resour. 6(5):737-747.

 Pollution and eutrophication of water bodies  are occurring as a result of anthropogenic influences.
They are characterized by a marked influence of the biomass of phytoplankton and, accordingly, of
primary production and by an increase of the content of blue-green algae in plankton,  causing
excessive water bloom.  In this case, the transparency of the water decreases, an increasing amount of
organics enters the hypolimnion of lakes, and an oxygen deficit is created in the bottom layers in the
stagnation period.  Pollution of water bodies  by organic matter (unlike eutrophication) does not
                                              21

-------
necessarily lead to an increase of phytoplankton biomass and primary production; in a number of
cases, a suppression of the development of phytoplankton algae or their complete disappearance may
even be observed. The use of methods of biological indication  of water quality and ecologo-functional
methods for assessing changes in aquatic ecosystems subjected to anthropogenic influences is
demonstrated in this work.

5.Aim, A.  1991. Leading environmental indicators. Environ. Sci. Technol.  25(5):839.

This editorial discusses the  need for development of environmental indicators to predict environmental
trends. It discusses indicators as predictive tools and discusses human health warnings also.

6.American Management Systems, Inc. 1987. Review of the literature on ecological endpoints. Report
to the Office of Policy, Planning and Evaluation, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. EPA Contract
No. 68-01-7002. American Management Systems, Arlington, VA.

The Office of Policy, Planning, and Evaluation (OPPE) asked American Management Systems,  Inc. to
conduct a literature review and to summarize ecological endpoints that are measured by researchers
and used  by analysts in ecological risk assessment. The goal of the review was to support the Office
of Research and Development in establishing ecological  risk assessment guidelines  and in arranging a
series of workshops on ecological  endpoint selection and measurement.  The review was also designed
to aid the  Office of Toxic Substances in preparing for U.S. leadership at a meeting of the Organization
for  Economic Cooperation and Development on test methods used to predict ecological effects.  This
document contains a review of the literature  and an annotated bibliography.

7.Amir, S. 1983. Ecosystems productivity and persistence: On  the need for two complementary views
in evaluating ecosystem functioning. ERC-047 Cornell University (Ecosystems Research Center),
Ithaca, NY. 103 pp.

8.Amir, S. 1989. On the use of ecological prices and system-wide indicators derived therefrom to
quantify man's impact on  the ecosystem. Ecol. Econ. 1:203-231.

Ecological prices and other system-wide, quantitative descriptors of ecosystem functioning are derived
from the assumption that  ecosystems allocate available resources efficiently among  their components.
However,  ecological prices  are not efficiency prices only, and their use does not assume that the
ecosystem is completely controlled by humans.  The same prices balance flows of different biomasses
in a multicomponent system.  As such, they  play the role of exchange prices in a decentralized
ecosystem.  Properly defined with the help of ecological  prices, the resulting ecosystem productivity is
no  less a  significant indicator of ecosystem functioning than is the national product for assessing the
functioning of an economy.  Considerations of the values taken simultaneously by our proposed
indicators  and by their economic analogs are of much help in judging the desirability of projects with
relatively mild environmental repercussions.  These values are  obtained from am integrated model of a
system in  which ecological  and economic activities are intertwined. However, for the indicators to have
an  analytical meaning, the methodology should  be  applied to trace only those dynamic paths during
which the  system possesses unique, state-dependent, intensive properties.  In other cases, a more
comprehensive methodology is scale-dependent and probabilistic in nature.  While delineating relations
between the structure of the system and  its behavior, this method implies that efficiency and viability
are two complementary rather than two commensurate attributes  of a single entity.   An outside observer
may be guided by subjective values in attempting to weigh these  features, but no inherent property of
the system exists that supports these values unequivocally. Nevertheless, this paper proposes an
approximation to overcome this difficulty  and to estimate a quantitative limit to the rate of substitution
between productivity and  viability.  Such  a limit is also an intensive property of the simulated system,
and the estimation of its value is shown to be crucial for studying the vulnerability of real ecosystems to
severe human-made disturbances.

9.Amir, S., and J. Hyman. 1992.  Measures of ecosystem health  and integrity. Pages 661-668. In: A.
Gasith, A. Adin, Y. Steinberger, and J. Garty, eds.  Environmental Quality and Ecosystem Stability. Vol.
5/B. ISEEQS Publications, Jerusalem.
                                              22

-------
The health and integrity of an ecosystem is a multifaceted concept.  It can become operational and of
use in setting environmental policies once it is backed up by a theory that explicates the basic
mechanisms of ecosystem functioning in response to stress.  Despite the fact that ecosystem health
remains a theoretical construct, the theory proposes a set of observed variables, basically the biotic
stock and flows of the ecosystem, empowered by a computable model, that give rise to operational and
diagnostic measures of ecosystem health.  The proposed measures are shown to correlate well with
several other qualitative and quantitative measures of ecosystem health.

Key Words: Ecosystem, Health, Redundancy, Stability, Turnover time

10.Anderson, J. 1971. Assessment of the  effects of pollutants on physiology and behaviour. Proc. R.
Soc. London Ser. B 177:307-320.

Many pollutants, even when present in the  water in concentrations well below lethal levels,  may cause
marked changes in the physiology and behavior of fish.  The work reported deals mainly with
salmonids. The responses to insecticides are particularly interesting. Of fundamental interest is the
suggestion that DDT seems to act by interfering with the normal thermal acclimation mechanism(s),
probably within the central nervous system. The results are not without practical significance. Some
responses, including those induced by heavy metal ions from mining wastes, may cause long-term
ecological changes of consequence.

11 .Anderson, J.E. 1991. A conceptual framework for evaluating and quantifying naturalness. Conserv.
Biol. 5:347-352.

Naturalness is a scientific concept that can be evaluated and quantified.  Intactness or integrity of
ecosystems can be defined and assessed in similar ways. Three  indices of naturalness are proposed:
(1) the degree to which the system would change if humans were  removed; (2) the amount of cultural
energy required to maintain the functioning of the system as it currently exists; and (3) the complement
of  native species currently in an area compared with the suite of species in the area prior to settlement.
These indices are complementary and provide a conceptual framework for evaluating naturalness. The
latter two can be quantified.

12.Arndt, U. 1992. Key reactions in forest disease used as effects criteria for biomonitoring. Pages
829-840. In: D.  McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the
International Symposium  on  Ecological Indicators held in Ft. Lauderdale,  FL, 16-19 October, 1990.
Elsevier,  Essex, England.

For 20 years biomonitoring has been a well-established procedure in support of practical environmental
protection in Central Europe.  It is used routinely around emittents or regionwide and statewide,
delivering important  data  on  effects and accumulation of pollutants in plants and animals.  These data
are used in the broadest sense to keep and optimize our surroundings.  Much less experience exists
with synecological bioindicators that give information about the behavior of ecosystems under pollution
stress. However, intensive research on forest disease within the last 10 years shows the necessity for
and provides the opportunity to develop a system for monitoring the current situation of our forests.
Using some of the known "key reactions" at different biological levels as effects criteria, a proposal of
synecological character is made for a biomonitoring at permanent  plots in the forests of Southern
Germany.

13.Arndt, U. 1992. Bioindication and the European perspective. Pages 1485-1490. In: D.  McKenzie,
D.E Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the International Symposium on
Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October 1990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

14.Arshad, M.A., and G.M. Coen. 1992. Characterization of soil quality: Physical and chemical  criteria.
Am. J. Altem. Agric. 7(1-2):25-31.

The impact of soil degradation on human welfare and the global environment presents a major
challenge.  A significant decline in soil quality has occurred worldwide through adverse changes  in its
                                              23

-------
physical, chemical, and biological attributes and contamination by inorganic and organic chemicals.
There Is a need to develop criteria to evaluate soil quality so that the progress of any corrective action
required by the International community can be monitored.  There currently are no  generally accepted
criteria to evaluate changes in soil quality.  This lack impedes the design and evaluation of meaningful
soil management programs.  This paper examines the principle physical and chemical attributes that
can serve as indicators of a change in soil quality under particular agroclimatic conditions.  Proposed
Indicators include  soil depth to a root restricting layer, available water-holding  capacity, bulk
density/penetration resistance, hydraulic conductivity, aggregate stability, organic matter, nutrient
availability/retention capacity, pH, and where appropriate, electrical  conductivity and exchangeable
sodium.  The authors also discuss the justification for selecting these key attributes, their measurement,
critical limits for monitoring changes in soil productivity, and future research needs  in soil quality.

Key Words:  Soil quality evaluation, Soil degradation

15.Auerbach, S.I.  1981. Ecosystem response to stress: A review of concepts  and  approaches. Pages
29-41. In: G. Barrett and R. Rosenberg, eds. Stress Effects on Natural Ecosystems. John Wiley &
Sons, New York.

Effective ecological policy designs require a clear understanding  of  the resilience and stability properties
of ecological systems and of the institutional and societal systems with which they  are linked. Any
pervasive understanding requires that the underlying scientific paradigms be well understood. The
stress concept underlies a more complete understanding of the impacts of anthropogenic perturbations,
the assessment of which  is necessary for the development of policies for environmental or ecosystem
management.

16.Auerbach, S.I.  1989. Monitoring the environment in the 21st century. Pages 165-171. In: R. Noble,
J. Martin, and K. Jensen, eds. Air Pollution Effects on Vegetation. U.S. Forest Service, Northeastern
Forest Experiment Station, Broomall, PA.

In this article, research directions regarding monitoring  are proposed and issues surrounding
environmental monitoring, such as the need to determine trends in  ecosystems or  in the environmental
parameters that influence these systems are discussed. Other issues discussed are long-term
monitoring and the problem of keeping monitoring systems dynamic rather than becoming mere
collections of data used for checking compliance.

17.Ausmus, B. 1984. An argument for ecosystem level monitoring. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 4:275-
343.

One objective of environmental monitoring programs is to document qualitative and quantitative
environmental changes in response to external stresses, including chemical contamination. Chemical
contaminant, biological, and ecological measurements have been used as environmental monitors.
Contaminant monitoring allows estimation of exposure; biological and ecological monitoring allows
estimation of uptake and  effects.

Measurements of ecosystem homeostasis such as nutrient cycling  processes  have been shown to be
good ecosystem level monitors. The rate of dissolved  nutrient loss from ecosystems has been
conclusively shown to increase as a function of chemical contamination until a new equilibrium is
reached, the pollutant input has become negligible, or until nutrient pools have become depleted.
Consequently, nutrient pools in environmental strata and in biota are altered and eventually depleted by
chemical stress.

The  use of nutrient cycling to determine sensitive responses to and long-term changes for chemical
contamination is an essential monitoring strategy for environmental management and compliance
purposes. Measurement of export (rapid response) and pools (long-term consequences) is within the
capability of current technology, is cost-effective,  and allows rapid implementation  of remedial measures
of environmental controls.
                                               24

-------
 '. Bnbich, H., D. Davis, and J. Trauberman. 1981. Environmental quality criteria: Some
considerations. Environ. Manage. 5(3): 191-205.

The physicochemical characteristics of the recipient environment into which chemical contaminants are
deposited may influence their chemical speciation, mobility, bioavailability, and toxicity.  In formulating
water quality criteria, the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA), in an innovative regulatory
approach, considered the modifying effect of abiotic environmental factors on pollutant toxicity.
Scientific knowledge of the interactions and correlations between pollutant toxicity and  abiotic factors
remains limited. Recognition of the influence of the physicochemical characteristics of the recipient
environment on pollutant toxicity has implications for the eventual formulation of regional, rather than
uniform and national, criteria. In addition, in developing water quality criteria that incorporate the effects
of pollutants on "aquatic life," EPA focused primarily on toxicity to aquatic animals and plants (including
unicellular algae). The effects of pollutants  on  microbe-mediated ecological processes that are
necessary for maintaining the state and quality of the ecosphere (such as biogeochemical cyclings, litter
decomposition, and mineralization) were not included in the formulation of the water quality criteria.  To
facilitate the recognition and quantification of adverse effects of pollutants on these ecological
processes, the development of a computation, termed the "ecological dosage 50%" (EcD50) is
recommended. Such a formulation could also be applied to setting environmental quality criteria for
terrestrial ecosystems.

Key Words: Pollutant toxicity, Water quality  criteria, Microbe-mediated ecological processes, Ecological
dosage 50%, Cadmium, Phenol, Physicochemical environmental factors

19.Bailey, R. 1991. Design of ecological networks for global monitoring. Environ. Conserv. 18(2):173-
175.

Worldwide monitoring of agricultural and other natural resource  ecosystems is needed  to assess the
effects of possible climate changes and/or air pollution  on our global resource base. Generally, there
are two choices for monitoring particular geographic areas. The first is a detailed examination of all
ecosystems in that area that could throw any light on those effects. This, however, is rarely possible
except in a small area. Thus, we are left with the alternative, for most areas a sampling strategy in
which sites would be selected for examination. Monitoring of all sites is neither  possible nor desirable
for large areas, and so a means of choice has to be devised and implemented.  The question then
becomes: Where should the necessary monitoring sites be located?.

20.Balogh, M.E., and R.S. Lunetta. 1991. Evaluation of remote sensing for the Environmental
Monitoring and Assessment Program's landscape characterization. In: GIS/LIS  '90  - Technical  Papers.
Geographic Information Systems/Land Information Systems Annual Conference, Anaheim, Ca.

21.Barnthouse, L.W. 1992. The role of models in ecological risk assessment: A 1990s approach.
Environ. Toxicol. Chem. 11(12):1751-1760.

Previously published reviews of mathematical models available for ecological risk assessment have
emphasized population and ecosystem modeling approaches originally developed 20 years ago or
more.  Discussions of applications have focused on quantifying  ecological effects of toxic chemicals and
pesticides.  This review emphasizes: (a)  modeling approaches developed within the last decade; (b)
applications to a broad array of  environmental problems on local, regional, and global scales; and (c)
the relevance of different types of models to different components of the risk assessment products.

Key Words: Time varying concentrations, Individual based model, Of the art,  Physiological ecology,
Lepomis macrochirus, Aquatic organisms, Simulation model, Sublethal copper, Regional scale,  Life
history

22.Barbour, M., J. Plafkln, B. Bradley, C. Graves, and R. Wisseman. 1992.  Evaluation of EPA's
rapid bioassessment benthic metrics: Metric redundancy and variability among reference stream sites.
Environ. Toxicol. Chem. 11:436-449.
                                               25

-------
The data analysis scheme used in the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency's (EPA's) rapid
bioassessment protocols (RBPs) integrates several community, population, and functional parameters
(or metrics) into a single assessment of biological condition. A reference database of
macroinvertebrate data obtained from 10 ecoregions in Oregon, Colorado, and Kentucky was used to
evaluate the appropriateness and variability of the  benthic metrics and the similarities of results among
ecoregions.  Several statistical procedures, including principle component analysis, correlation
coefficient, analysis of variance, and stepwise discriminant analysis, were used to test the efficacy of 17
community metrics. A general separation between the mountain ecoregions and the valley/plains
ecoregions was determined to exist for the metrics. Two of the original eight metrics described in the
EPA's RBPs for benthic macroinvertebrates were found to be highly variable and unreliable as
measures of biological conditions in some ecoregions.  Eleven metrics were determined as being
valuable in discriminating between montane and valley/plains groupings of ecoregions.

Key Words: Bioassessment, Metrics,  Ecoregions, Macroinvertebrates, Streams

23.Barrett, G.W. 1974. The trophic dynamic aspects of equitability as an indicator of ecosystem stress
effects,  (abstract only).  First International Congress of Systematic and Evolutionary Biology Abstracts,
University of Colorado,  Boulder, CO.

It is suggested that the equitability concept of Lloyd and Ghelardi provides an approach for the
evaluation of stress effects on total ecosystems when both the stressor and the stress effects are
viewed in a trophic dynamic manner.  The equitability index is a measure of fit of observed relative
abundance of  species to those as predicted by MacArthur's broken-stick model for contiguous, non-
overlapping niches.  It appears that equitability values on a long-term basis  more nearly approach one
for higher-trophic-level groups compared with lower trophic level groups when both groups are
presented with identical stressors (e.g., fire, pesticides, grazing, etc.). The duration of this response
pattern appears to be the result of the trophic level at which the stress is directed; the lower the "target"
trophic level, the longer the duration of stress effects on secondary consumers. This response may be
the result of long-term energy resource limitation at higher trophic levels.

24.Barrett, G.W. 1978. Stress effects on natural ecosystems. Ohio J. Sci. 78:160-162.

This  article briefly addresses the need for both structural and functional approaches to the study of
stress, and the research of ecosystem-level stress.

25.Barrett, G.W. 1985. A problem-solving approach to resource management. Bioscience 35(7):423-
427.

To assess stress in a given system, resource management must take into account socioeconomic as
well as biological and physical factors. The 19-step algorithm presented here should help applied
ecologists tackle management problems holistically, objectively, and systematically.

26.Barrett, G., and R.  Rosenberg, eds. 1981. Stress Effects on Natural Ecosystems. John Wiley &
Sons, New York. 305 pp.

This  book provides a compendium of information regarding stress ecology.   Chapters include
discussions on: an integrative approach to stress,  a working definition and critique/review of stress,  a
review of concepts and approaches to ecosystem  response to stress, the effects of stress on
succession, and a future approach to stress in ecosystems.

27.Barrett, G., G. Van Dyne, and E. Odum. 1976. Stress ecology. Bioscience 26:192-194.

Numerous studies have already addressed the evaluation of foreign stress effects on total ecosystems.
Among  the perturbations considered are pesticides, fire, and radiation.  Various stress effects on the
structure and function of ecosystems have been summarized by Odum and by Woodwell.  More
recently, in the U.S.  International Biological Program (IBP) a series of ecosystem-level natural stress
experiments was conducted in grasslands, deserts, tundra, and coniferous and deciduous forests.
                                               26

-------
These large-scale studies are being followed by numerous small-scale ecosystem-level investigations
dealing with stress ecology.  However, no attempt has been made to provide a set of guidelines for
testing perturbations and for evaluating stress response in the future. The objective of this article is to
offer the following set of guidelines for testing and evaluating perturbations on total ecosystems.

28.Bayly, I., and P. Lake. 1979. The use of organisms to assess pollution of freshwater: A literature
survey and review. Publication No. 258. Ministry for Conservation, Victoria, Australia.

29.Bazzaz, F.A. 1990. The response of natural ecosystems to the rising global CO2 levels. Annu. Rev.
Ecol. Syst. 21:167-196.

The large body of literature on the response of  crops and intensively managed forests to elevated CO2
is not treated in this review because this information has been thoroughly reviewed recently elsewhere.
Instead, this review concentrates on the response of natural vegetation to elevated CO2  and on some of
the predicted climate changes that may result.  The review addresses the response of individuals to
CO2 at the physiological level and  the consequences of that response at population, community, and
ecosystem levels.  It must, however, be emphasized that  (1) most of the findings on the physiological
and allocational response to CO2 were first discovered in  agricultural crops, and (2) much of the initial
work on plants from natural ecosystems tests that variation among species in these responses.

30.Beck, M. 1991. Forecasting environmental change. J.  Forecast. 10(1-2):3-19.

A context and introduction are provided for nine contributed articles on Forecasting Environmental
Change.  Since the first  quantitative studies of the "predicament of mankind" at the end of the  1960s,
large-scale forecasting models have attracted substantial  criticism on the grounds of failing both to
inform the policy process and to embrace the notion of surprise-rich futures. Almost all attempts to
develop models of environmental systems, on whatever scale, have been dogged by the skeptic's
question:  Is the model capable of predicting  conditions substantially different from those observed in
the past?  The question, strictly speaking, is not answerable. The paper defines, therefore, three
approaches to the development of models—the mechanical, metric, and linguistic paradigms—and
constructs a reorientation of the customary problem of prediction in order to explore the concept of
reachable and radically different futures.  Such  reorientation depends crucially on  a juxtaposition on the
linguistic and mechanical descriptions of  a system's behavior.  The nine papers in this special issue are
then summarized in the context of reconsidering how we formalize our thinking about the behavior of
systems, and what might be meant by the systematic analysis of reachable futures.

Key Words: Environmental systems, Environmental  change, Reachable futures

31.Belward, A. 1991. Remote sensing for vegetation monitoring on regional and global scales. Pages
169-187. In: Remote Sensing and  Geographical Information Systems for Resource Management in
Developing Countries. ECSC, EED, EAEC, The Netherlands.

Information is needed to assess the impact of human activities, to predict future conditions, and to
arrive at a more complete understanding of the processes supporting the earth system.  But  what
information should  be obtained? Being responsive to both climate and human activity, the vegetation
canopy is in itself a good indicator of  ecosystem condition. Vegetation is dynamic in responding and
adapting to prevailing environmental conditions; these dynamics are manifested in changes in the
distribution of vegetation types and in changes in plant growth and development. In either case,
monitoring such change  calls for repeated observation and measurement.

The study of vegetation dynamics  on  regional and global scales is concerned with the community,
biome, and ecosystem levels of organization  rather than with individual plants or, even, populations.
Repeated observation and measurement on these scales  is not possible with conventional in situ
measurements. However, satellite sensor remote sensing does  provide a mechanism for global
observation on a regular and repeatable basis.  Vegetation monitoring on regional/global scales is an
integral part of natural resource surveys such as tropical deforestation assessment, agricultural
production forecasting, bush fire monitoring, and environmental degradation monitoring.  These are the
                                              27

-------
themes of subsequent chapters of this book; this chapter introduces some of the fundamental
considerations to using remote sensing for this type of work.

32.Bernard, D. 1990. Workgroup issue paper: Community or ecosystem level indicators. Environ.
Monitor. Assess. 15:281-282.

This presentation was designed to serve two purposes: (1) to summarize practical experience in
selecting indicators at the community or ecosystem level for use in environmental monitoring programs
and (2) to provide questions that would serve as focal points for working group discussions.

Accordingly, the introduction is built around the following three questions: (1) Is there anything that can
be measured at the ecosystem level that cannot be measured at the community  (or lower) levels?; (2)
What types of indicators are appropriate for use in monitoring programs that are  designed to detect
problems involving cumulative effects? and; (3) What role will monitoring of indicators play in helping us
determine whether efforts to restore  damaged ecosystems have been successful?

An attempt is made to highlight issues associated with these questions rather than to answer them.

33.Bernes, C., B. Giege, K. Johannsson, and J. Larsson. 1986. Design of an  integrated monitoring
programme in Sweden. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 6:113-126.

A National Swedish Monitoring Program, the PMK, has been designed for regular and permanent
recording of environmental conditions and long-term changes in background regions, and for keeping
track of the flux of pollutants in and between various media. Many of the projects involved deal with
integrated monitoring of terrestrial and limnic ecosystems. This work is carried out in or near some 20
small watersheds, usually selected in national parks or nature reserves.  The environmental factors
monitored in these areas include  concentrations of chemical substances in precipitation, soil,
groundwater, surface water, and organisms, as well as biological parameters (e.g., population size and
reproductive capacity of certain species) that may indicate effects  of environmental disturbances.  The
data from this program can be used  as a reference to environmental data acquired near pollution
sources, and as a basis for measures against, for example, acid rain, heavy-metal pollution,  and use of
pesticides. The biological parameters may also reveal  effects of yet unknown pollutants or other
disturbances.

34.Bernstein, B.B. 1992. A framework for trend detection: Coupling ecological and managerial
perspectives. Pages 1101-1114. In:  D. McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological
Indicators. Proceedings of the International Symposium on Ecological Indicators  held in Ft. Lauderdale,
FL, 16-19 October 1990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

Ecological indicators of environmental trends must fulfill two distinct, yet  related,  functions. They must
be ecologically realistic and at the same time managerially useful.  Each function alone presents difficult
challenges, and together, they create an often conflicting set of constraints. This situation is made
difficult because scientific and managerial views of the  world reflect different perspectives, assumptions,
and values.

From an ecological perspective, the  development of effective trend measures is  complicated by the
many different underlying processes that contribute to ecological change. There are, for example,
many kinds of successional sequences, cycles, and chaotic or random events.  In addition, events and
trends  at larger space and time scales can mask, enhance, or interact with more-localized processes.
Finally, complex, site-specific  interactions and indirect effects often confound the interpretation of
trends.

From a managerial perspective, the  need for definitive  information often  conflicts with the complex
realities of ecological systems. Management attention  frequently focuses on time and space scales that
do not  match those on which ecological processes are occurring.  Further, there are cultural differences
between the two perspectives in standards of proof and in use and understanding o( concepts such as
causality and probability.
                                               28

-------
 Illustrated with examples of effective as well as ineffective indicators, this paper explores these issues
 in detail.  It builds on this discussion and on the examples to suggest a framework for evaluating and
 developing useful indicators.  It also stresses the point of view that indicators are necessarily context-
 dependent; they cannot be interpreted independent of their ecological and managerial context. In many
 cases, a suite of indicators, rather than a single one, will be best suited to fulfilling the complex needs
 of trend detection.

 35.Best, E., and J. Haeck, eds.  1983. Ecological indicators for the assessment of the quality of air,
 water, soil, and ecosystems. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 3(3-4) :205-406.

 36.Binkley, D., T.D. Droessler, J. Miller. 1992. Pollution impacts at the stand and ecosystem levels.
 Pages 235-257.  In: R.K. Olsen, D. Binkley, and M. Bohn, eds. Response of Western Forests to Air
 Pollution. (Series: Ecological Studies: Analysis and Synthesis 97). Springer-Verlag, New York.

 37.Blrd,  P., and D.J. Rapport. 1986. State of the environment report for Canada. Environment
 Canada, Ottawa.

 38.Boer, J. 1983. Ecological indicator organisms for environmental protection policy. Symposium on
 Ecological Indicators for the Assessment of the Quality of Air, Water, Soil, and Ecosystems. Environ.
 Monitor. Assess. 3(3-4) :399-403.

 39.Bohac, J., and R. Fuchs. 1991. The structure of animal communities as bioindicators of landscape
 deterioration. Pages 165-178. ln:D.W. Jeffrey and B.  Madden, eds. Bioindicators and Environmental
 Management. Academic Press, London.

 Biodiagnostic evaluation methods were developed from 1986-1990.  Biodiagnostic investigations are
 made on a range of life forms and at various scales.  They are performed both at population and
 community levels.  The data on plants and animals must be obtained at the appropriate scale of
 investigation  (e.g.,  local, regional, and fluvial). Biomonitoring at regional and fluvial scales mainly uses
 populations of small mammals and communities of birds. These groups, because of their size and
 migratory habits, are optimal bioindicators of the complex of factors that degrade the landscape and
 lead to air pollution.

 Biomonitoring at the local scale mainly uses populations and communities of invertebrates.  These
 groups have  small  body sizes and a lower tendency for migration and, therefore, are suitable for
 indicating local environmental factors  such  as unsuitable application of fertilizers and pesticides,
 unsuitable methods of landscape management, and overdrainage and the consequent desiccation of
 the landscape.  Biomonitoring at the local scale is often the sole method used to investigate the biotic
 conditions in  reserves and national parks. The investigation of key organisms and their communities in
 portions of the landscape is important for the research at regional scales.  The mosaic of well-
 preserved landscape units increases the stability of the landscape.

 Key Words: Ecological classification, Square mapping, Environmental factors, Invertebrates, Birds,
 Czechoslovakia

 40.Bolger, P. 1990. Rapporteur's report of work group: Indicators and assessment of the state of
fisheries. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 15:295-296.

This  article identifies the most important indicators that should be examined, and the indicator
 thresholds which could  be used to alert managers to achieve sustainable management of the fisheries
 resource.

41.Bongers, T. 1990. The maturity index: An ecological  measure of environmental disturbance based
on nematode species composition. Oecologia 83:14-19.

 Nematode assemblages constitute a potential instrument for assessing the quality of submersed,
temporarily submersed, and terrestrial soils and for the development of an ecological typology and
                                              29

-------
biomonitoring system. Interpretation of physical or pollution-induced disturbances has hitherto been
based mainly on changes in diversity, dominance patterns, or percentage of dorylaimids
(Adenophorea).  The maturity index, based on nematode fauna, is proposed as a gauge of the
condition of the soil ecosystem.  Values on a colonizer/persister scale are given for nematodes that
occur in The Netherlands.  The possibilities for the use of this index are demonstrated by a respective
interpretation of some literature data. The use of nematodes in environmental studies is discussed.

Key Words: Nematodes, Maturity,  Ecology, Colonization, Biomonitoring

42.Bormann, F. 1985. Air pollution and forests: An ecosystem perspective. Bioscience 35(7):434-441.

Widespread forested areas may be undergoing early stages of ecosystem decline. Although this is
difficult to detect because of uncertainty about pollution input and the natural variation common to any
ecosystem, the potential danger is too grave to delay regulatory action while waiting for conclusive
research that may never become available.

43.Bourdeau, P., and M. Treshow. 1978. Ecosystem response to pollution. Pages 313-330. In: G.
Butler,  ed. Principles of Ecotoxicology. SCOPE 12. John Wiley & Sons, Chichester, England.

Although the  book as a whole covers ecotoxicofogy and response to pollution at lower hierarchical
levels,  this chapter covers response of the system as a whole to pollution.  The chapter is divided into
the following sections and subsections:  Introduction;  Methods of Studying Ecosystem Response;
Assessment of Levels of Pollution—(i) quantitative, (ii) qualitative; Assessment of Effects on
Ecosystems—(i) eutrophication,  (ii) acid rain in lakes, (Hi) oil spills in the environment, (iv) detergents in
sewage, (v) ecosystems with algal and protozoan communities, (vi) rivers and lakes,  (vii) estuarine
ecosystems, (viii) coral reefs,  (ix) mangrove ecosystems, (x) terrestrial ecosystems; Conclusions and
Predictions—(i) diversity, stability,  maturity of ecosystems,  (ii) effects of pollution on ecosystem
characteristics.

44.Boyle, T., ed. 1987. New Approaches to Monitoring Aquatic Ecosystems. ASTM 940. American
Society for Testing and Materials,  Philadelphia.

This volume represents recent state-of-the-art research in the field of environmental monitoring. The
purpose of this collection of papers is to provide a range of examples of areas in which new methods
and approaches of environmental  monitoring  are being employed.  This volume is intended for
scientists who will design monitoring programs as part of their research and for environmental
managers who initiate the questions for monitoring and who would be the ultimate users of the results.
The papers in this volume elaborate specific concerns, questions, and program criteria that characterize
the development of monitoring programs and provide specific examples as paradigms for future
monitoring programs. Contributions to this book address preplanning monitoring programs, decision
making in relation to monitoring, and case studies.

45.Boyle, T., J. Sebaugh, and E. Robinson-Wilson. 1984.  A hierarchical approach to the
measurement of changes in community structure induced by environmental stress. J. Test. Eval.
12(4):241-245.

A new index of dissimilarity to measure changes in community structure caused by environmental
stress  is proposed.  A new statistical algorithm was also devised to test the similarity or dissimilarity
between two  communities.  This procedure tests the mean dissimilarity between the same communities.
These  new indices of community structure are cast in a proposed hierarchical scheme for testing
different degrees of changes in stressed communities.  Several examples illustrate that the proposed
procedures give a more interpretable comprehensive analysis than does a limited set of indices.

Key Words: Statistical tests,  Environmental tests, Biological surveys, Community dissimilarity, Statistical
test of dissimilarity, Hierarchical community measurement scheme, Stressed communities
                                               30

-------
46.Breckenridge, R.P. 1990. The role of quality assurance in conducting terrestrial ecosystem
monitoring.  Pages 73-81. In: D.R. Hart, ed. Proceedings of the Third Annual Ecological Quality
Assurance Workshop. Environment Canada,  Canada Centre for Inland Waters.

47.Bretherton, F. 1989. Taking the pulse of the planet. EPA  J. May/June:40-41.

This article briefly addresses and argues for the premise that we must monitor the "vital signs" of the
planet.  Very general global measurements are suggested. The issues surrounding the measurements
and models are also discussed.

48.Bretthauer, E.W. 1991. The need for EMAP. Lake Line September:4-5.

Why do we need a national program to address ecological status and trends? The author welcomes
the opportunity to provide a perspective on new directions for the Environmental Protection Agency and
on the role that an ecological status and trends program will play.  No doubt the membership of the
North American Lake Managers Society will want to debate the specifics of the lake component of this
program, and a view of the larger perspective will be useful in doing so.

49.Breymeyer, A. 1981. Monitoring of the functioning of ecosystems. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 1:175-
183.

The theoretical basis, content, and possible applications of the program "Monitoring of Ecosystems" are
considered.  A functional definition of ecosystem is proposed, and some features of ecosystems are
defined on this basis.  The program "Monitoring of Ecosystems" is visualized as a large-scale program
of simple measurements of the rates of the main ecosystem processes.  The expected results can be
utilized in two ways: (1) a comparative knowledge of ecosystem functioning provides the fundamentals
of geography of ecosystems, and (2) the constant, repeatable evaluation of a given ecosystem function
provides a basis for its rational management.

SO.Breymeyer, A. 1990. Measuring function and disfunction in ecosystems. Pages 116-140. In: W.
Grodzinski, E.B. Cowling, and A. Breymeyer, eds.  Ecological  Risks: Perspectives from Poland and the
United States.  National Academy Press, Washington, DC.

Topics covered in this workshop contribution are: Ecosystems: definition and function; Natural
influences on ecosystems; Anthropogenic influences on ecosystems; Status of forest ecosystems in
Poland and; Evolution of ecosystems.

51.Bro-Rasmussen, F., and H. Lokke. 1984. Ecoepidemiology— A casuistic discipline describing
ecological disturbances and damages  in relation to their specific causes: Exemplified by chlorinated
phenols and chlorophenoxy acids. Regul. Toxicol. Pharmacol. 4:391-399.

Ecoepidemiology is a recently created concept that is analogous to human epidemiology. It is the study
of ecotoxicological effects at the levels of ecosystems, biological communities, and populations in
relation to causative environmental exposures, mostly by chemicals. Ecoepidemiology is described by
presenting an example of unintentional dissipation and possible discharges of chlorophenols and
phenoxy acids into the terrestrial environment. A specific case of a marine area is given, the Koge Bay
immediately to the south of Copenhagen, Denmark.  The examples are illustrative of the complex
situation that characterizes most ecoepidemiological cases. Difficulties with which the
ecoepidemiologist are confronted  are not only the identification of possible causative and confounding
chemicals and the description of ecoepidemiological effects per se, but also the assessment of critical
pathways of multimedia pollutants.  Biomonitoring, computer-based handling of data from natural
localities, and determination of a variety of anthropogenic impact factors are necessary elements of
ecoepidemiological studies.

52.Brock, R., T. Crlsman, W. Courtenay, and V. Nilakantan. 1991. The ecological effects of exotic
species in North American Lakes. Pages 95-104. In: Hydrology of Natural and Manmade Lakes. Series:
                                              31

-------
IAHS Publications 206. International Association of Hydrological Sciences, Wallingford, United Kingdom.


Effective lake management requires a clear understanding of the complex interrelationships between
abiotic and biotic forces. As humans have continually sought to biomanipulate lacustrine ecosystems
for perceived gain, exotic species have reached dominance in many North American lakes.  Because
natural ecosystems require many years to develop, a sudden addition of an exotic species usually
results in dire consequences.  Exotic fish, zooplankton, mollusks, and aquatic macrophytes drastically
change any lake ecosystem in which they become firmly established.

SS.Bromberg, S.  1990. Identifying ecological indicators: An environmental monitoring and assessment
program. J. Air Waste Manage. Assoc. 40(7):976-978.

The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency is initiating the Environmental Monitoring and Assessment
Program (EMAP) to monitor the status and trends of the nation's near-coastal waters, forests,
freshwater wetlands, surface waters, agroecosy stems, and arid lands. This program is intended to
evaluate the effectiveness of Agency policies for protecting ecological resources within these systems.
Monitoring data collected for all ecosystems will be integrated for national status and trends
assessments.

54.Bromenshenk, J., and E. Preston. 1986. Public participation in environmental monitoring: A means
of attaining network capability. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 6:35-47.

In the Puget Sound region of the United States a task force of community volunteers using bees
monitored environmental pollution. This paper discusses advantages and limitations of public
involvement in the assessment of regional environmental problems, particularly with respect to
biological monitoring.  This approach not only yielded extensive information about pollution levels but
also was very cost-effective.

55. Brown, D.E., C.H.  Lowe, and C.P. Pase. 1979. A digitized classification system for the biotic
communities of North America. With community (series) and association examples for the southwest. J.
AZ-NV Acad. Sci. 14(Supplement 1, May):1-16.

In previous publications on the North American Southwest System the authors have addressed
primarily the North American Southwest region. Responses to both this classification system and the
classification have been favorable in both interest and use. In this report the classification
nomenclature at digit levels 1-4 is expanded to represent the North American continent.

The Southwest System is evolutionary in basis and hierarchical in structure. It is a natural biological
system rather than primarily a geography-based one in the sense of Dice 1943; Bailey 1978 and
others.  The resulting classifications are, therefore, natural hierarchies.

This  classification system is tentatively being considered for use in prototype ecological resource
assessments by the EMAP Integration and Assessment Group.

56.Bruns, D. 1991. Editorial: Ecological monitoring for global change. Environ. Monitor. Assess.
This editorial provides introductory remarks on the symposium on environmental monitoring  held at the
74th Annual Meeting of the Ecological Society of America.

57.Bruns, D., G. Baker, J. Clayton, S. Greene, M. Harmon, M. Minshall, T. O'Rourke, B. Smith, C.
Staley, G. White, and G. Wiersma. 1988.  Integrated environmental monitoring at remote ecosystems:
First annual report. Informal report, EGG-CEMA-8713. EG&G Idaho, Inc., Idaho Falls, ID.
                                              32

-------
58-Bruns, D., and G.B. Wiersma. 1988. Research plan for integrated ecosystem and pollutant
monitoring at remote wilderness study sites. Informal Report, EGG-EES-7951. EG&G Idaho, Inc., Idaho
Falls, ID.

59-Bruns, D., G.B. Wiersma, and G. Minshall. 1992.  Evaluation of community and ecosystem
monitoring parameters at a high-elevation,  Rocky Mountain site. Environ. Toxicol. Chem. 11:459-472.

A multimedia systems approach was used  to field test wilderness monitoring guidelines (U.S. Forest
Service) at a high elevation site in western Wyoming. Five evaluation criteria having a primary
emphasis on an ecosystem conceptual framework were applied to selected ecological parameters
(aquatic and terrestrial) that the authors ranked on a relative scoring basis.  The ecosystem conceptual
criterion was based on the general attributes of the subalpine system, the nature of the potential
environmental problem (acidic deposition),  and the ecological resources at risk.  The other criteria were
data availability, uncertainty, usability of methods, and cost-effectiveness. Data on sulfate deposition
and buffering capacity of soils and surface waters relative to an elevational gradient supported the
notion of greater risk to ecological resources in the subalpine environment.  Within this ecosystem
perspective, litter decay  and taxonomic richness of lotic macroinvertebrates had the highest rating,
followed by lotic functional feeding  groups and lignin-to-nitrogen ratios.  A biotic index for stream
macroinvertebrates received the lowest rating on an ecosystem conceptual basis and also scored low
on the uncertainty and cost-effectiveness criteria; however, suggestions were made for future
improvement.  Most parameters were similar in regard to variability and usability, except for functional
groups,  which exhibited greater data variability.

Key Words:  Ecosystem monitoring, Terrestrial, Aquatic, Subalpine

GO.Bruns, D., G.B. Wiersma, and E. Rykiel.  1991. Ecosystem monitoring at global baseline sites.
Environ. Monitor. Assess. 17(1):3-31.

Integrated ecosystem and pollutant monitoring is being conducted at prototype  global baseline sites in
remote areas of the Noatak National Preserve, Alaska; the Wind River Mountains, Wyoming; and
Torres del Paine National Park, Chile.  A systems approach has been used in the design of these
projects. This approach includes (1) evaluation of  source-receptor relationships, (2) multimedia (i.e. air,
water, soil, and biota) monitoring of key contaminant pathways within the environment, (3) the use of
selected ecosystem parameters to detect anthropogenic influence, and (4) the application of a systems
conceptual framework as a heuristic tool.

Initial short-term studies  of air-quality (e.g., SO2 and NO2)  plus trace metal concentrations in mosses
generally indicate pristine conditions at all three sites as expected, although trace metals in mosses
were  higher at the Wyoming site.  Selected ecosystem parameters for both terrestrial (e.g., litter
decomposition) and aquatic (e.g., shredders, a macroinvertebrate functional feeding group) habitats at
the Wyoming site reflected baseline conditions when compared with other studies. Plans are being
made to use U.S. Department of Energy research parks for global change monitoring.  This will involve
cross-site analyses of existing ecological data bases and the design of a future monitoring  network
based on a systems approach as outlined in this paper.

61.Brydges, T. 1990. Rapporteur's report of work group: Indicators and assessment on the state of
forest. Environ. Monitor.  Assess. 15:301-302.

This articles briefly addresses three questions: (1) How do we separate "normal" from human-induced
change  in forests?; (2) How can we predict long-term changes based on backward-looking science?
and; (3) How do we decide on the acceptability of changes?

62.Burkman, W.G., and  G.D. Hertel. 1992. Forest health monitoring. J. For. 90(9):25-26.

This article provides a brief description of the Forest Health Monitoring Program and EMAP. Subtopics
include:  Program establishment; Establishing permanent plots; Information integration and; Program
support.
                                              33

-------
63.Cairns, J., Jr. 1974.  Indicator species vs the concept of community structure as an index of
pollution. Water Resour.Bull. 10:338-347.

This article compares the advantages and disadvantages of using indicator species vs assemblages of
organisms as indexes of pollution.

64.Cairns, J., Jr. 1979.  Biological monitoring — concept and scope. Pages 3-20.  In: J. Cairns Jr., G.
Patil, and W. Waters, eds. Environmental Biomonitoring, Assessment, Prediction and Management—
Certain Case Studies and Related Quantitative Issues. International Co-operative  Publishing House,
Fairland, MD.

Biological monitoring is the  regular, systematic use of organisms to determine environmental quality.
Chemical-physical monitoring determines the concentration or level (e.g., temperature) of the various
components. However,  currently no reliable way exists, other than biological monitoring, to determine
the integrated, collective impact of these chemical-physical parameters on living material.
Consequently, space flights with human crews include both types of monitoring.

This paper is divided into three  sections: (1) a rationale for using biological monitoring, (2)  a discussion
of how it might be used, and (3) some of the problems that must be resolved before biological
monitoring is widely accepted.

Key Words: Monitoring,  Toxic chemicals,  Hazard evaluation, Bioassays

65.Cairns, J., Jr. 1981.  Biological monitoring. Part VI — future  needs. Water Res. 15:941-952.

Biological assessment of water  pollution  has depended historically on the direct observation of effects in
natural systems. This is  unsatisfactory for two reasons: (1) best management practices require
prevention rather than documentation of  damage and (2) direct observation of an  event in one system
does not necessarily permit one to make claims about events in other systems. The documentation of
damage is a necessary  part of biological monitoring.  Methods for determining whether biological
integrity has been impaired are  still being developed,  although a wide variety of methods for different
types of ecosystems is currently available for practical use.  As a consequence, the most important of
the future needs in biological assessment of pollution are: (1) development of a predictive capability and
(2) developing the means of validating the accuracy of the predictions, which will in turn enable
corrections to be made when the predictions are in error.

66.Cairns, J., Jr. 1990a. The genesis of biomonitoring in aquatic ecosystems.  Environ. Prof. 12:169-
176.

The field of biological monitoring had its  genesis first  in the protection of humans and, subsequently,
the organisms living  in natural systems against deleterious effects clearly evident  to the general public.
Ideally, biological monitoring should focus on maintaining  established quality control conditions to
ensure the health and well being of natural  systems.  Some professionals disagree with the focus on
large systems, maintaining that  regulatory agencies and industry are primarily interested only in  small
fragments of these larger systems.

Biological monitoring of  isolated ecosystem fragments is a consequence of the genesis of the field.  For
example,  focusing on single species toxicity tests as a primary  determinant of ecosystem health and
failure to validate or confirm the predictive models based on single-species laboratory tests are a result
of the origins of the field rather  than good scientific practices. The purpose of this paper is to raise
questions about  whether currently-used methodology is  accepted because of its origins or  because of
its scientific suitability.

67.Cairns, J., Jr. 1990b. Global climate/ecosystem monitoring: Inland aquatics. Spec. Sci. Tech.
                                               34

-------
There has been much discussion of global climate change as a result of increased atmospheric carbon
dioxide (the greenhouse effect).  Small changes of only a few degrees in average annual temperature
may have a dramatic effect on the length of the growing season of wheat and other crops on which
civilization depends. The  effects on ecosystems will probably be equally dramatic. The physical
measurements will be straightforward, although distinguishing a trend from normal variability will not
be.  However, because  the relationship between changes in climate and biological/ecosystem effects is
not linear, a global biomonitoring system is  essential to document these as soon as they occur.
Unfortunately, this matter  has not been given the attention it deserves by ecologists or governments.

68.Cairns, J., Jr. 1991. Environmental auditing for global effects. Environ. Audit. 2(4):187-195.

Even though this is an era of unprecedented global change, information feedback loops have not been
established that will explain the nature of the environmental changes taking place. The continuance of
this rapid change is ensured because no determination has been made nationally or internationally of
the condition of environmental quality necessary for sustainable, long-term use of the planet.  Ideally,
an audit takes place in order to ensure that previously established quality control conditions are being
met.  These quality control conditions need not be cast in concrete since they are not in any other
quality control situation, but they are  established and, when changed, are changed on the basis of
evidence indicating the merit of such changes. These changes are not always in one direction (that is,
toward more rigid standards).  Standards may be relaxed when evidence demonstrates that either no
deleterious effects will occur or that these effects are minimal.  Because  of the very rapidity of the
changes occurring (e.g., reduction in biodiversity), global monitoring cannot be preceded by a long trial
period of local and regional monitoring. Some humans simply do not believe that the thin  envelope
around the planet in which life occurs is seriously threatened.  Others fear that the end is near.  Both
groups are handicapped by the lack of robust monitoring information that will provide trend analyses
and other information to determine: (1) whether conditions are deteriorating rapidly, (2) where the
earth's worst trouble spots are, and (3) what management decisions  are  likely to alter this  deteriorating
situation since chemical, physical, and biological  monitoring, if properly coupled, will indicate
cause/effect relationships.  This manuscript focuses on an overall strategy for environmental auditing for
global change and provides illustrative attributes that might be used effectively at different levels of
biological organization.

Key Words: Global auditing, Global monitoring, Environmental quality control, Global change, Ecological
information systems, Landscape monitoring, Early warning systems

69.Cairns, J., Jr., A.J.  Buikema, D. Cherry, E. Herricks, and W. Van der Schalie, eds. 1982.
Biological Monitoring in Water Pollution. Pergamon Press,  New York.

70.Cairns, J., Jr., and P.V. McCormick. 1991. The use of community- and ecosystem-level end points
in environmental hazard assessment: A scientific and regulatory evaluation. Environ. Audit. 2(4):239-
248.

Even with a strong scientific basis for the use of toxicity tests at higher levels of biological  organization
(e.g., communities) for predicting environmental risk, a strong resistance to the use of such endpoints
remains among regulators. The use of community- and ecosystem-level end points has been criticized
for a lack of consensus  regarding which endpoints should be measured. Furthermore,  it has been
argued that the decisiveness and accuracy of predictions at these higher levels of biological
organization are no greater than those resulting from single species tests and are more costly to
generate. A rapidly increasing body of evidence refutes many of these assertions.  This paper
synthesizes recent evidence on the applicability of microcosm  tests using microbial communities for
predicting effects of chemicals on natural communities and ecosystems.  These tests have been
effective in providing explicit predictions of hazardous concentrations of many chemicals and in
identifying instances where standard single species protocols either underestimate or overestimate the
degree of risk.  The cost of many  microcosm tests is comparable  to single species tests.  In addition to
the usefulness of microcosm tests as exploratory tools in ecotoxicological research, recent evidence
supports their incorporation into regulatory procedures in some limited way.  Although more substantive
                                               35

-------
Investigation is essential before such tests can be accepted as integral parts of the regulatory process,
further effort in this direction is warranted.

Key Words: Communities, Ecosystems, Ecotoxicology, End points, Hazard assessment,
Microorganisms, Single species tests

71.Cairns, J., Jr., and P.V. McCormick. 1992. Developing an ecosystem-based capability for
ecological risk assessments. Environ Prof. 14:186-196.

Ecological risk assessment is a scientific process for estimating, with a known degree of certainty,
anthropogenic effects on the integrity of natural ecosystems and the services they provide. An
inordinate focus has  been placed on bottom-up risk assessment strategies, which emphasize
laboratory based testing.  Laboratory protocols alone are incapable of estimating uncertainties
associated with attempts to extrapolate data among levels of environmental complexity, biological
organization,  and a multitude of potential impact scenarios. Top-down approaches to risk assessment,
which utilize ecological indicators present in natural ecosystems,  can address these problems and
ensure that previously stated environmental objectives are met. Monitoring programs designed to
protect ecosystem integrity should include: (l)compliance indicators—for assessing the degree to which
previously stated environmental conditions are maintained; (2)diagnostic indicators—for determining the
cause of deviations outside the limits of acceptable conditions; and (3)early warning indicators—for
signalling impending  deleterious changes in environmental conditions before unacceptable conditions
actually occur. While scientific, economic, and political constraints preclude development of an ideal
monitoring  system at this time, implementation of iess comprehensive programs currently is feasible.

72.Cairns, J., Jr., P.V. McCormick, and B.R. Niederlehner. 1992. Estimating ecotoxicological risk and
impact using  indigenous aquatic microbial communities. Hydrobiologia 237(3):131-145.

Emphasis has increased on accuracy in predicting the effect that anthropogenic stress has on natural
ecosystems.  Although toxicity tests low in environmental realism, such as standardized single species
procedures, have been useful in providing a certain degree of protection of human health and the
environment,  the accuracy of such tests for predicting the effects of anthropogenic activities on complex
ecosystems is questionable. The use  of indigenous communities of microorganisms to assess the
hazard of toxicants in aquatic ecosystems has many advantages. Theoretical and practical aspects of
microbial community  tests are discussed, particularly in related to widely cited problems in the use of
multispecies test systems for predicting hazard.  Further standardization  of testing protocols using
microbial colonization dynamics is advocated on the basis of previous studies, which have shown these
parameters to be useful is assessing risk and impact of hazardous substances in aquatic ecosystems.

Key Words: Hazard assessment, Microorganisms,  Communities,  Ecosystems, Single species testing,
Multispecies testing,  Extrapolation

73.Cairns, J., Jr., and B.  Niederlehner. 1989. Adaptation and resistance of ecosystems to stress: A
major knowledge gap in understanding anthropogenic perturbations. Specul. Sci. Technol. 12(1):23-30.

The capacity  of ecosystems to adapt to anthropogenic stress is currently poorly understood.
Unfortunately, there are few places in the world where human activities do not have a major influence
on natural systems. The capacity of natural systems to generalize an adaptation from one stress  to new
stresses is virtually unknown. Mechanisms of adaptation at the community level and the influence of
the type of stress (whether common in evolutionary history, such as organic enrichment, or
unprecedented, such as synthetic pesticides) are only partially understood, and  their reversibility is not
ensured once the stress is removed.  An improvement is needed  in our ability to predict the effects of
anthropogenic stress on natural systems.  Multiple stresses are ubiquitous in systems but are ignored in
predictive models because of a lack of data.  An information base may confirm hypothetical ranking of
the vulnerability of ecosystems based on their history of stress and contribute to the general
understanding of stress ecology.
                                               36

-------
74.Cairns, J., Jr., B. Niederlehner, and E.P. Smith. 1992.  The emergence of functional attributes as
endpoints in ecotoxicology. Pages 111-128.  In: G.A. Burton, ed. Sediment Toxicity Assessment. Lewis
Publishers, Inc., Boca Raton,  FL.

75.Cairns, J., Jr., G. Patil, and W. Waters, eds. 1979.  Environmental Biomonitoring, Assessment,
Prediction and Management — Certain Case Studies and Related Quantitative issues. International Co-
operative Publishing House, Fairland, MD.

This volume, while focused largely on environmental biomonitoring, assessment, prediction, and
management, includes some applications to the management of certain populations and ecosystems for
uses beneficial to man.  These have added dimensions of complexity and have certain requirements for
monitoring  assessment and prediction. The volume is organized into four sections: biomonitoring —
concepts and methods, environmental  assessment and prediction, environmental management,  and
other management studies and quantitative issues.

76.Cairns, J., Jr., and J.R. Pratt. 1986. Ecological consequence assessment: Effects of bioengineered
organisms. Water Resour. Bull. 22(2):171-182.

The introduction of genetically altered microorganisms into natural ecosystems presents  fundamentally
new problems in risk assessment and ecological effect evaluation.  Novel microorganisms, produced by
any of  several new methods, have the ability to survive and reproduce in the environment.  Because
most of these organisms are bacteria, they have the potential to interfere with natural processes,
displace natural populations, infect new hosts, move between ecosystems, and cause far-reaching
ecological disturbances.  This paper reviews currently available methods in ecological research that
might be used in evaluating the ecological effects of releasing genetically altered microorganisms. Both
structural and functional  evaluations are critically reviewed.  Microcosm, mesocosm, and field tests
should provide valuable  predictions concerning the potential ecological impact of genetically altered
organisms.  Ecosystem assessments will also be useful in post-release studies such  as those currently
used to evaluate toxic impacts. The current problem does not require the development of new testing
methods but rather the creation of adequate predictive models (both conceptual and systems-based) to
predict the  potential for adverse effect of genetically altered organisms.

Besides discussing genetically altered organisms, this  article provides, in general terms,  information on
structural versus functional assessments, methods in ecological  assessment, ecosystem functional
analysis, ecosystem assessment, gaps in ecological data, and ecological end points.

Key Words: Genetic engineering, Ecosystem assessment, Environmental impact, Community structure,
Ecosystem function

77.Cairns,  J., Jr., and J.R. Pratt. 1986. On the relation  between structural and functional analyses of
ecosystems: Editorial.  Environ. Toxicol. Chem. 5:785-786.

There are two approaches to ecosystem research and the measurement of environmental impact, and
these are clearly at odds. One studies ecosystem structure as the sum of interacting species, many of
which usually differ from site to site even in healthy ecosystems.  The other approach studies
ecosystem  function by tracing the flow of matter and energy through the processing compartments.
What course should be charted — structure or function? What should be measured? Three possible
relationships between  structural and functional parameters are discussed.

78.Cairns,  J., Jr., and J.R. Pratt. 1987. Ecotoxicological effect indices: A rapidly evolving system.
Water Sci. Tech. 19(11):1-12.

Ecotoxicology has evolved from a  modest number of single-species acute-toxicity tests to an integrated
system of hazard evaluation for predicting adverse effects of chemicals and complex mixtures on
environmental health.  The process of screening and regulating chemicals and industrial discharges has
improved water quality but has generally not been validated in receiving ecosystems.  This deficiency
results  from the regulation of individual chemicals that  rarely occur alone in the environment and from
                                              37

-------
the size of the problem.  Many receiving ecosystems have literally hundreds of discharges of complex
effluents. Typical single species laboratory tests  fail to account for the complexity of ecosystems and
the strong interactions that may occur among the component species. Evidence is accumulating that
complex test systems such as microcosms and mesocosms can fill this void.  Microcosms and
mesocosms can be constructed, experiments can be conducted cost-effectively, and several endpoints
can be measured in complex systems by the standard dose-response paradigm. For example, the
current regulation of chlorine discharges is based on three chronic exposures  to chlorinated sewage
effluent.  In a microcosm test, the authors determined adverse biological effects at nearly an order of
magnitude less chlorine  (1 ng/l) for the loss of microbial species. To be effective as  hazard evaluation
tools, microcosms and mesocosms must include ecologically meaningful processes and must be useful
in  making decisions regarding environmental safety and harm. This can only  be done with adequate
statistical design and intensive sampling.  Nevertheless, laboratory ecosystems can be useful in making
direct measurements of  effects on a large number of interacting species and can be  tied to a site-
specific problem in a particular ecosystem or can be standardized by using regional-type ecosystems
as references.  By using complex natural communities, the ability to validate test system predictions
increases because the test system complexity mimics that found in the  real world.

Despite hopes that a few sensitive  species might be used to make decisions quickly  on environmental
effects,  ecological health will only be maintained when scientists and regulators come to grips with the
problem of protecting ecologically important processes as well as sensitive species.  This will mean
developing increasingly  realistic tests in which environmentally realistic concentrations of chemicals can
be tested without resorting to the use of safety factors or extrapolation from limited data bases.
Developing such tests does not mean skyrocketing costs for screening chemicals and effluents. It does
suggest, however, that regulators and toxicologists will need to deal with new information and leam new
skills rather than relying  on historically pleasing but ecologically deficient testing programs.

Key Words:  Ecotoxicology, Toxicity testing, Multispecies testing, Hazard evaluation

79.Cairns, J., Jr., and J.R. Pratt. 1990. Biotic impoverishment: Effects of anthropogenic stress. Pages
495-505. In: G.M. Woodwell, ed. The Earth in Transition:  Patterns and Processes of  Biotic
Impoverishment. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, England.

The author recognizes two types of impoverishment: losses of diversity in a landscape as  human
effects spread and the in situ transitions that accumulate  under chronic disturbance,  usually, but not
always, reducing the diversity of a community and making it more vulnerable both to invasion and other
disruption.  The insights are refreshing,  if complex and disturbing. They confirm the  very patterns now
familiar: chronic disturbance in aquatic systems favors the hardy cosmopolitan species that reproduce
rapidly and usually do not form the basis of complex food webs. The patterns are systematic,         >
predictable,  and increasingly common.  One of the greatest dangers  is that the disturbances will
become so close to universal that sources of species for  ^introduction  will be lost, despite the  general
hardiness of the protists used.

SO.Cairns, J.J., and W. Van der Schalie. 1982. Biological monitoring. Part 1  — early warning  systems.
Water Res.  14:1179-1186.

One aspect  of biological monitoring is the use of aquatic  organisms to provide an early warning of the
presence of toxic materials in water.  Possible applications of this concept are: (1) in an industrial
setting to help prevent hazardous waste spills or (2) in a  water treatment plant to check on potable
water supplies. These tasks have  been traditionally carried out exclusively by chemical-physical
techniques applied either continuously or at frequent intervals. The inadequacy of these methods by
themselves  in predicting toxicity is discussed by the author. This article describes the operational
requirements that must  be met by a biological toxicity early-warning system and some of the organisms
and techniques which have been or may be employed in such systems. An early warning toxicity
monitoring system will be considered to have  the following characteristics:
                                               38

-------
 1. The organisms are held either in a laboratory situation or in the field under controlled conditions and
        are exposed on an intermittent- or continuous-flow basis to the water or wastewater being
        tested.
 2. A physiological or behavioral parameter of the organism is monitored by a recording device capable
        of responding to abnormal conditions indicated by the organism.
 3. The function of the monitor is primarily for detection of short-term changes in toxicity vs chronic or
        cumulative effects.

 81.Calow, P.  1992. Can ecosystems be healthy? Critical consideration of concepts. J. Aquat. Ecosys.
 Health 1:1-5.

 Health, it is argued, implies that a system has an optimum state that can be defended.  For organisms
 and populations this can be understood objectively and generally in terms of  neo-Darwinian principles.
 Similar reasoning cannot be applied to ecosystems. The possible advantages and difficulties of
 applying this concept of health to ecosystems are critically considered.

 Key Words: Analogy, Control, Fitness, Optimization, Teleology

 82.Carpenter, S. 1990. Large-scale perturbations — opportunities for innovation.  Ecology 71(6):2038-
 2043.
 Several approaches are discussed for statistical analysis of large-scale (and possibly unreplicated)
 ecological experiments. These include intervention analyses and comparisons  of alternative models
 using Bayes' formula.  Such techniques are  unfamiliar to many ecologists and are not typically Included
 in graduate curricula in ecology. This article argues for increased  training in these areas and for
 collaborations between statisticians and ecologists to develop innovative approaches to the analysis of
 large-scale perturbations.

 83.Carpenter, S., and P.  Matson. 1990. Editorial: Statistical analysis of ecological response to large-
 scale perturbations. Ecology 71(6):2037.

 This editorial outlines the issues surrounding statistical approaches for interpreting response to large-
 scale perturbations and cites as a critical challenge the understanding and management of  Earth's
 resources in the face of environmental change.

 84.Chaphekar, S. 1991. Bio-indicators. J. Environ.  Biol.  12(SI):U163-U164.

 85.Chaphekar, S. 1991. An overview on bio-indicators. J. Environ. Biol. 12(SI):163-168.

 86.Chapman, P. 1991. Environmental quality criteria: What type should we be developing? Environ.
 Sci. Technol. 25(8):1353-1359.

The development of environmental quality criteria is a major global industry; it occupies the time and
 pays for the salaries of professionals in a variety of fields.  Scientists provide  the framework for or
argue against  their promulgation; administrators try to make criteria work or seek loopholes; politicians
favor them (or say they do); environmentalists alternately promote  and denounce them; and members
of the general public hope the criteria will protect the environment  but not adversely affect their own
jobs or lifestyles.

 Is all this activity achieving its objective of improving environmental quality? Are we sure what the
objective is? The author believes that the answer to both these questions is a clear "no." The purpose
of this article is to explain this position,  to suggest possible remedies, and to  urge their immediate
implementation.  Subtopics of this article are: Criteria vs guidelines; Endpoints;  Ecosystem health;
 Reality vs perception; A line between good or bad;  Prediction vs reaction;  What do we want to protect
and; Numbers do not ensure quality.

87.Chapman,  P. 1992. Ecosystem health synthesis: Can we get there from here? J. Aquat. Ecosyst.
Health 1:69-79.
                                               39

-------
This paper provides a synthesis of the presentations made by participants at the International
Symposium on Aquatic Ecosystem Health (July 23-26, 1990, Waterloo, Ontario, Canada). A working
definition of the ecosystem concept and a framework for defining ecosystem health are proposed,
based on both "hard" and "soft" science. Assessment of ecosystem health can be approached either
from the bottom up (reductionist approach) or from the top down (holistic approach).  The Symposium
clearly followed the former approach;  present approaches to science and management are also
generally reductionist. It is argued that realistic solutions require primarily holistic approaches; such are
often claimed but rarely attained. Reductionist approaches are useful for diagnosis and prediction (i.e.
warning of potential problems), provided that they are based on appropriate statistical, biological, and
societal levels of significance.

Key Words: Ecosystem health, Environmental quality, Environmental assessment, Indicators

88.Chapman, P., R. Dexter, and L. Goldstein. 1987. Development of monitoring programmes to
assess the long-term health of aquatic ecosystems: A model from Puget Sound, USA. Mar. Pollut. Bull.
18(1):521-527.

Monitoring consists of repetitive data collection for the purpose of determining trends in certain
parameters.  The term has been used (and misused) in an environmental context; often the final
recommendations of short-term environmental studies suggest that  monitoring should be done.  The
purpose of the present paper is to describe a holistic approach to environmental monitoring developed
for Puget Sound, which the authors believe to be  broadly applicable to all nearshore  marine
environments in development, purpose,  and application.  As such, this paper provides specific
information complementary to previous recent discussions on  data acquisition and general program
design for marine pollution monitoring.

89.Chapman, P., E.A. Power, and G.A. Burton,  Jr. 1992. Integrative assessment in aquatic
ecosystems.  Pages 313-340. In: G.A. Burton, Jr., ed. Sediment Toxicity Assessment. Lewis  Publishers,
Inc., Boca Raton, FL.

Integrative assessments are  defined as  investigations involving attempts to integrate  measures of
environmental quality to make an overall assessment of  the status of the system. The measures can
include two or more of the following components:  sediment toxicity  tests, sediment chemical  analyses,
tissue chemical analyses, pathological studies, and community structure studies.  The purpose of such
investigations is to determine environmental quality; such may be defined in terms of relative and/or
current status, but particularly related  to ecosystem health.  Specifically, integrative assessments
involve more than one generic measure of environmental quality.

This book chapter is not a comprehensive review  of all possible integrative assessments.  Rather, this
chapter describes the conceptual basis for integrative assessments and provides selected specific,
recent examples of an integrative concept and an application  of that concept.

90.Clarke, R. 1986. The Handbook of Ecological  Monitoring. A GEMS/UNEP publication. Clarendon
Press, Oxford, England.

This book contains the following sections and subsections:
1. Habitat Monitoring Theory: what is ecological monitoring, the uses of ecological monitoring, the
       history of ecological  monitoring, ecological monitoring in practice,  the costs of ecological
       monitoring, developing an ecological monitoring  program, and towards a global system;
2. Ground Monitoring: climate measurements, soil mapping and interpretation, landform classification,
       soil erosion and sediment yields, vegetation monitoring, large mammal herbivores, nutrition and
       population dynamics, and social and economic surveys;
3. Aerial Monitoring: the use of light aircraft, operational procedures for aerial surveys and monitoring,
       selection of data variables, survey planning, piloting and navigation, the front-seat observer
       records, the rear-seat observations, 35-mm vertical sample photography, the aerial survey data
       base, and the control of bias;
                                               40

-------
4. Remote Sensing: Principles of remote sensing, photographic sensors and application, imaging with
        nonphotographic sensors, multispectral scanners, active microwave systems, space systems
        useful for ecological monitoring, meteorological satellites, and manned satellites;
5. GRID — A Tool for Environmental Management: national, regional, and global environmental data;
        utility of existing environmental data; toward a global data base for the environment; and the
        future of environmental data management.

91.Cocklln, C., S. Parker, and J. Hay. 1992. Notes on cumulative environmental change I: Concepts
and issues. J. Environ. Manage. 35:31-49.

Environmental impact assessment, as it has been practiced generally, is limited in several ways. Two
characteristics are cause for particular concern.  The first is that it is a reactive process, rather than
representing a proactive approach to environmental management. The second is that the
project-based approach often means that the combined effects of two or more developments are often
overlooked. Concepts developed under the heading of cumulative environmental change present some
clues to the appropriate reform of impact assessment, particularly with respect to these two failings.  An
analysis of the concept is presented here and the authors discuss also some general issues that arise
in respect to the assessment of cumulative environmental change.  The latter include boundary issues,
ecological response characteristics, monitoring, socio-economic effects and issues in evaluation. A
consideration of the institutional context for the management of cumulative change leads us to  propose
a regional approach, as opposed to project based assessments.  Links between cumulative effects
assessment, state-of-the-environment reporting and planning of sustainability are explored.

Key Words: Cumulative environmental change,  Cumulative effects assessment, Environmental  impact
assessment, Environmental planning, Environmental monitoring

92.Colborn, T.E., A. Davidson, S.N. Green, R.A. Hodge, C.I.Jackson, and R.A. Liroff. 1990. Great
Lakes, Great Legacy? Conservation  Foundation/Institute for Research on Public Policy, Washington,
DC and Ottawa, ON.

Within this book, the following indicators are presented to assess the status of the Great Lakes: air
quality, surface water quality, contaminated sediments, groundwater, body burdens of toxics, population
status, habitat, fisheries, forests, wetlands, soil erosion, agricultural productivity, shorelines, human
health, and economic conditions.

93.Connell, J., and W. Sousa. 1983. On the evidence needed to judge ecological stability or
persistence. Am. Nat. 121:789-824.

The balance of nature has been  a background assumption in natural history  since antiquity." This
continues to be true today; some modern field ecologists, assuming that natural ecosystems are stable,
have applied ideas of mathematical stability theory to the actual communities they are studying. The
authors believe that, before one applies such theory to a natural population or community, one should
first decide whether or not it is stable. Their aim is to describe the sorts of evidence needed to obtain
from natural populations or communities to  decide whether they are stable or persistent, as defined  in
this article. One aspect that is stressed in particular is whether any given real community exists in
multiple stable states in different places at the same time or in the same place at different times.

94.Conservatlon Foundation. 1987. State of the Environment: A View Towards the Nineties.
Conservation Foundation, Washington, DC.

95.Cormack, R., and J. Ord.  1979. Spatial and Temporal Analysis in Ecology. Statistical Ecology
Series. International Co-operative Publishing House, Burtonsville, MD.

This book contains sections on time-series and spatial patterns in ecology and statistical methods for
spatial point patterns in ecology.
                                              41

-------
96.Costanza, R., B. Haskell, and B. Norton, eds. 1992. Ecosystem Health: New Goals for
Environmental Management. Island Press, Covelo, California.

The introduction to this book covers what ecosystem health is and why we need to worry about it.  The
book is divided into two sections: Philosophy and ethics, and Science and policy.  Topics such as the
following are covered: Problems of scale and context, Ecosystem health and ecological theories, and
The operational definition of ecological health.

97.Costanza, R. 1992. Ecological economic issues and considerations in indicator development,
selection, and  use: Toward an operational definition of system health. Pages 1491-1502. In: D.
McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds.  Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the International
Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL,  16-19 October 1990. Elsevier, Essex,
England.

98.Couillard, D., and Y. Lefebvre. 1985. Analysis of water quality indices. J. Environ. Manage. 21:
161-179.

To facilitate communication  on water quality among professionals of this resource, several summarizing
tools, or water quality indices, were developed.  Because of the general features of these Indices are
little known, this article instructs the reader regarding the main components of the indices and the
intrinsic characteristics of the operational process.  Also included  is a list of 20 indices described by
category, goals, methodology, applicability, and notes.

Key Words: Index, Water quality index, Water pollution, Water quality, Environmental impact,
Environmental evaluation, Environmental management, Pollution control

99.Courtemanch,  D.L. 1991. EMAP: Considerations for its design and use. Lake  Line 11(4):14-17.

This article provides a background to EMAP and asks the question "Will EMAP in its present form  be
adequate to address its needs and how will EMAP interface with other status and trends work?" The
author does not believe some concerns have yet been adequately resolved by the U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency.  Until these issues are resolved, the author believes that the design and
implementation of this new status and trends program can  only be tentative and that, specifically,
additional considerations must be made before support of the lakes pilot program  is justified. The
author focuses on the Northeast Lakes Pilot Project of the  surface water component.

lOO.Cousins,  S. 1991. Species diversity measurement — choosing the right index. Trends Ecol. Evol.
6(6): 190-192.

Species are, by definition, different from each other. This fact favors ranking rather than additive
indices.  In addition, new methods show how the degree of difference between species can be included
in an index.  The functional  aspect of species diversity is strengthened by incorporating other
differences between species (such as body size, or whether predator or parasite)  as a component of
diversity. The choice of index and measurement of diversity are influenced by these developments.

101.Cowell, E. 1978. Ecological monitoring as a tool in industry. Ocean Manage.  4:273-285.

102.Cowling,  E.B. 1992. Challenges at the interface between ecological and environmental monitoring:
Imperatives for research and public policy. Pages 1461-1482.  In:  D. McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J.
McDonald, eds.  Ecological  Indicators. Proceedings of the  International Symposium on Ecological
Indicators held in Ft. Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October 1990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

Human activities of many sorts are changing the chemical, physical, biological, and social environment
of every nation of the world. Some of these changes are beneficial for human health and welfare and
for the stability of ecosystems on which the quality of human life depends.  However, many others are
having either short-term or long-term adverse effects on human health or on the purity of our air and
water, the quality of our lakes and streams, the cleanliness of our oceans, the productivity of our
                                              42

-------
wetlands and estuaries, the health and productivity of our forests and croplands, the quality of scenic
vistas in our national parks, the quiet and solitude of our wilderness, the safety of our food supplies,
and our personal sense of well-being.

The monitoring of changes in human health and in the health, productivity, genetic composition, and
stability of ecosystems requires a long-term commitment and awareness of the natural dynamics of
human populations and of both the structure and function of ecosystems.  The monitoring of changes  In
the quality of the environment also requires a long-term commitment and substantial understanding of
the chemical, physical, and biological processes that take place in the air, surface waters,
groundwaters, soils, and the geological substrata of the earth.

Research is the key to the improved understanding of human health,  the structure and functions of
ecosystems, and both natural and anthropogenic changes in environmental quality.  Continuing
investments in research by governmental, industrial, and public-interest  organizations will be necessary
if future monitoring systems are to become more rationally based, cost-effective, and trustworthy
indicators of future changes in environmental quality.  This research should include efforts to develop
more effective monitoring systems and to discover better ways to implement and sustain existing
monitoring programs. It should also involve studies on the use of monitoring data in environmental
decision making.

Some suggestions for research on ecological and environmental monitoring and its importance in public
decision making are presented using lessons learned from the National  Atmospheric Deposition
Program (NADP), the National Acid Precipitation Assessment Program (NAPAP), and the
Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP).

103.Crawford, T.J. 1991. The calculation of index numbers from wildlife monitoring. Pages 225-248 In:
B. Goldsmith, ed.  Monitoring for Conservation and Ecology. Chapman and Hall, London.

Economic health is sometimes described by  using various indices; recently, there has been interest in
assessing the state of the environment through such indices.  This chapter describes the construction
of indices from wildlife monitoring data and some of the problems peculiar to these types of biological
data that are not shared by economic data.

104.Crawley, M. 1990. The responses of terrestrial ecosystems to global climate change. Pages 141-
164. In: G. Macdonald and L. Sertorio, eds.  Global Climate and Ecosystem Change. [Series: NATO
Advanced Science Institute Series, Series B, Physics 240 (1990)]. Plenum Publishing Corporation, New
York.

105.Crenna, C.D. 1991. Working  towards an environmental information  statement: Summary paper.
Environmental Information for the Twenty-First Century: International Forum held in Montreal, Quebec.
NTIS No. MIC-91-06693/HDM (Available through National Technical Information Service, Springfield,
VA). Environment Canada, Ottawa. 28 pp.

In 1989, the Group of Seven (G7) summit leaders agreed on the importance of environmental
information and requested that the Organization for Economic Co-operation and Development examine
how selected environmental indicators could  be developed to improve the  integration of environmental
and economic decision making and measure progress towards sustainable development. At the 1990
G7 Summit, the Prime Minister of Canada proposed that environmental  information be improved on a
worldwide basis and announced that Canada would organize the International Forum on Environmental
Information for the Twenty-first Century.  This summary paper identifies  the key issues from the four
theme papers and suggests a framework that could be used to guide  discussion in the workshops and
lead to the development and adoption by the forum of a statement of  common conclusions and
recommendations for the future.

106.Crispin, S. 1991. Using Natural Heritage data to monitor Great Lakes ecosystem health. Endang.
Spec.  Update 8(5-6): 1-4.
                                             43

-------
The Natural Heritage Data Centers have collected data on hundreds of rare species and natural
communities in the Great Lakes Basin.  These data can be utilized to identify a set of population- and
community-level biological indicators of the change in ecosystem health related to water quality. The
Nature Conservancy has developed broad categories for identifying the potential of rare species and
natural community elements as indicators of water quality and ecosystem health: fish-eating animals
feeding from Great Lakes waters; animals living or feeding from wetlands in the Great Lakes Basin;
upland communities dependent on major Great lakes ecosystem processes not related to water quality
and; species not directly related to aquatic ecosystems of the Basin. The data system already serves
on a state-by-state basis for the environmental review process, endangered species protection, and
natural area management.

107.Croonqulst, M., and R, Brooks. 1991.  Use of avian  and mammalian guilds as indicators of
cumulative impacts in riparian wetland areas. Environ. Manage. 15(5):701-714.

A new method of assessing cumulative impacts of human activities  on bird and mammal communities
of riparian-wetland areas was  developed by  using response guilds to reflect how species theoretically
respond to habitat disturbance on a landscape level.  Using documented information for each species,
all bird and mammal species of Pennsylvania were assigned values for each response guild to reflect
their sensitivity to  disturbances; high guild scores corresponded to low tolerance toward habitat
disturbance. The  authors hypothesized that, given  limited time and resources, determining how wildlife
communities change in response to environmental impacts can be done more efficiently with a
response-guild approach than a single-species approach.  To test the model,  censuses of birds and
mammals were conducted along wetland and riparian areas of a protected and a disturbed watershed
in central Pennsylvania. The percentage of  bird  species with high response-guild scores (i.e., species
that had specific habitat requirements and/or were neotropical migrants) remained relatively stable
through the protected watershed. As intensity of habitat alteration increased through the disturbed
watershed, percentage of bird species with high response-guild scores  decreased. Only 2 to 3% of the
neotropical migrants that had specific habitat requirements were breeding residents in disturbed
habitats compared to 17%-20% in reference areas.  Species in the  edge and exotic guild classifications
(low guild scores)  were found  in greater percentages in the disturbed watershed.  Composition of
mammalian guilds showed no consistent pattern  associated with habitat disturbance.  Avian response
guilds reflected habitat disturbance more predictively than did mammalian response guilds.

Key Words: Guilds,  Wetlands, Cumulative impacts, Birds, Mammals, Environmental assessment,
Riparian-watershed  restoration

108.Cullen, P. 1990. Biomonitoring and environmental management. Environ. Monitor.  Assess. 14:107-
114.
The advantages of biological monitoring of the environment have been long recognized. Direct
measurements of  biota of importance rather than chemical surrogates,  integration of monitoring over
time and measurement of subtle changes  brought about by minor or intermittent pollution have all been
propounded as advantages.

There appear to be  a variety of barriers to the wider adoption of biomonitoring approaches: the
perception that biomonitoring takes longer and is more expensive than chemical monitoring, the idea
that chemical measurements are an adequate surrogate for direct measurement of biological change,
and the belief that interpretation of biological data is complex and uncertain compared with chemical
data.  These widely held myths are addressed and some  broad principles to guide the development of
biomonitoring programs are developed.

109.Dale, V., R. Franklin, W. Post, and R.  Gardner. 1991. Sampling ecological information: Choice of
sample size. Ecol. Modell. 57:1-10.

It is necessary to identify factors that  significantly affect sample statistics obtained from ecological
measurements. The authors used a computer simulation to examine the effects of sample size on  the
mean and variance  for four frequency distributions  of the  attribute of interest. The kurtosis of the
underlying distribution affects fluctuations in  the sample mean as the number of samples increases.
                                              44

-------
For large sample sizes, the sample mean of the log normal distribution is less than the population mean
because of the skewness of that distribution. The standard error-to-mean ratio, kurtosis, and skewness
can be used as guides to suggest the appropriate number of samples to adequately characterize the
true distribution.

HO.Danks, H.V.  1992. Arctic insects as indicators of environmental change. Arctic 45(2):159-166.

The great diversity of terrestrial arthropods in the Arctic suggests that these organisms are especially
useful in monitoring environmental change there, where warming as a result of climatic change is
expected to be especially pronounced and where current conditions are limiting for many organisms.
Based on existing information about Arctic faunas and  how they differ from temperate faunas, this
paper suggests several elements, including ratios and other quantitative indices, that can be used for
long-term evaluations of change. These elements include composition indices,  range limits, marker
species,  interspecific ratios, relationship shifts, phonological and physiological indicators, and key sites.
Using such elements in a planned way would exploit the diversity of Arctic insects and emphasize their
importance in arctic systems.

Key Words: Polar Bear pass, Bathurst Island, Life history, Northwest Territories, Vegetation

HLDavey, G.  1980. The use of biological parameters for the assessment of water quality — A
literature review. Publication 99. Environmental Protection Agency (Australia), Melbourne, Australia.

112.Day, K. 1990. Rapporteur's report of work group: Indicators at the species and biochemical level.
Environ.  Monitor.  Assess. 15:277-279.

This article summarizes ideas from a conference workgroup that began with two main objectives: (1) to
develop criteria for indicators (generic) and (2) to propose a list of species level indicators. The
workgroup distinguished predictive from descriptive factors including effect from cause, effect from
effect and cause from effect.  It also looked at the nature of stress, the importance of species,
environments — managed or unmanaged,  and locations. The group felt that it had achieved the first
objective, but did  not get very far with the second objective, the list of "key" species.

113.Deblnski, D., and  P. Brussard.  1992. Biodiversity assessment and monitoring procedure in
Glacier National Park. Pages 393-409. In: D. McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological
Indicators. Proceedings of the International Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in  Fort
Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October 1990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

One way in which the status of an ecosystem may be assessed is to document changes in its
biodiversity over time.  Because biodiversity can be defined at the level of species, habitats, or genes,
temporal changes can be assessed at three very different levels. These changes may indicate
responses to natural disturbances, human-induced changes, or long-term environmental trends.

Thus, the immediate goals of this project were to (1) choose appropriate "indicator taxa" or "indicator
groups" that could be inventoried and monitored and serve as indices of the state of the overall
biological diversity in Glacier, (2) establish  an appropriate sampling regime and methodology, and (3)
evaluate  various analytical techniques for dealing with the data base.  The ultimate goal is to be able to
track patterns of changing distribution and abundance in several indicator taxa  well into the future.

114.de Haes, H.,  M. Nip, and F. Klljn. 1991. Towards sustainability: Indicators of environmental
quality. Pages 89-105.  In: O. Kuik and H. Verbruggen, eds. In Search of Indicators of Sustainable
Development. Kluwer Academic Publishers, Dordrecht, The Netherlands.

This chapter presents a method for assessing environmental quality.  Subsections include: Ecosystem
approach and environmental quality assessment; The choice of areas; Multifunctional area and
environmental quality requirements; Determining an environmental quality objective; The selection of
quality parameters; Quantification and; An example assessment for the Dutch Lowland Peat area.
                                              45

-------
115.de Kruijf, H. 1991. Extrapolation through hierarchical levels. Compar. Biochem. Physiol.
100C(1/2):291-299.

The translation of results from low hierarchical levels to higher levels meets with difficulties with respect
to temporal, spatial, and organizational scales. In addition, the translation of stress effects through
hierarchical levels has not yet been possible, thus hampering ecological risk assessment. Three
approaches to link the various levels are described: the energetics, endpoint and minimal structure.  A
concept to integrate these approaches to enable extrapolation of stress effects across hierarchical
levels is described.

116.Dennls, B.,  and G. Patil. 1979. The sensitivity of ecological diversity indices to the presence of
pollutants in aquatic communities. Pages 379-413. In: J. Cairns, G. Patil, and W. Waters, eds.
Environmental Biomonitoring, Assessment, Prediction, and Management — Certain Case Studies and
Related Quantitative Issues. International Co-operative Publishing House, Fairland, MD.

The authors examine the sensitivity of species diversity indices of aquatic communities to changes in
water temperature and nutrient concentration. They adopt the "average rarity" definition of diversity
proposed by Patil and Taillie. Their diversity index family (delta beta) is found to be a weighted average
of species richness and evenness, and beta is shown to be a measure of the weight that is attached to
evenness. Weak relationships between diversity  and temperature or nutrient concentration are
detected through regression analysis of a variety  of data sets from many different locales. However,
the direction and magnitude of such relationships differs between locales, and little of the variability in
community diversity is accounted for by temperature and nutrients in these data. They conclude that
diversity  indices  might be useful for signaling that unknown ecological changes are taking place at
given sites but that these indices are not substitutes for detailed biological investigation.

117.Depietri, D.E. 1992. The search for ecological indicators — Is it possible to biomonitor forest
system degradation caused by cattle ranching activities in Argentina. Vegetatio 101 (2): 109-121.

Cattle ranching is a typical disturbance factor in the North Patagonian forests.  The selection of modal
areas having similar natural environmental conditions enabled the analysis of the response of the
system to exploitation.  Different structural parameters  in the  vegetal community were  studied and
secondary data on fire frequency and livestock censuses were compiled. An area gradient showing
different  degrees of degradation was defined, which was presumed to show the stages an area goes
through when under livestock farming. Three ecological indicators were defined: key species, as
indicators of the  occurrence of a degradation  process;  vegetal cover, as an indicator of the stage a
degradation process is going through; and vegetal biovolume, as an  indicator of when the degradation
process has become critical. These indicators must be used together in order to obtain a good
diagnosis of the  state of the area under exploitation.

11 S.Diaz. R.J. 1992. Ecosystem assessment using estuarine and marine benthic community structure.
Pages 67-85. In: G.A. Burton, Jr., ed. Sediment Toxicity Assessment. Lewis Publishers, Inc., Boca
Raton, Fla.

This chapter is an introduction to the use of benthic community structure as  a means of assessing
ecosystem response to contaminated sediments is estuarine  and marine ecosystems. Since
contaminants that enter estuarine and marine ecosystems eventually bind to sediment particles and are
deposited on the bottom, emphasis on benthic organisms as  a primary means of assessing ecosystem
response is warranted. Of particular importance are the macrobenthic invertebrates because of their
basic longevity, sedentary life styles, proximity to sediments,  influence on sedimentary processes, and
trophic importance.

119.Dixit, S.S., J.P. Smol, J.C. Kingston, and D.F. Charles. 1992. Diatoms: Powerful indicators of
environmental change. Environ. Sci. Technol. 26(1):23-33.

Diatoms are being used increasingly to assess short- and long-term  environmental change because
they are informative, versatile,  flexible, and powerful ecological indicators. Diatoms respond rapidly  to
                                               46

-------
f.hanges in many ecological characteristics.  Assemblages are usually diverse and therefore contain
considerable ecological information.  For this reason and because it is easy to obtain large numbers of
individuals, robust statistical and multivariate procedures can be used to analyze assemblage data.

The article begins by describing the kinds of questions regarding ecosystem condition assessment that
are increasingly being asked.  The article is  an overview of how diatoms can be used in monitoring
environmental change.

120.Dixon, D., P. Hodson, J. Klaverkamp,  K. Lloyd, and J. Roberts. 1985. The role of biochemical
indicators in the assessment of ecosystem health—their development and validation.  Associate
Committee on Scientific Criteria for Environmental Quality, Publication No. NRCC 24371. National
Research Council of Canada,  Ottawa.

121.Doberski, D., and I. Brodle. 1991. Long-term ecological monitoring in schools and colleges. J.
Biol. Ed. 25(2):123-128.

122.Doving, K.B. 1991. Assessment of animal behaviour as a method to indicate environmental
toxicity. Comp. Biochem. Physiol. 100C(1/2):247-252.

This review focuses on the effects of toxic agents on fish  behavior in particular.  Special attention will
be devoted to the role of chemosensory systems because (1) these systems are directly exposed to the
environment; (2) they mediate a large part of the behavioral repertoire; (3) they are developed early in
life, and in some fishes the olfactory organ is developed before the mouth opens; and (4)  the receptor
cells in these organs show a remarkably rapid and unspecific uptake both of stimulants  and toxicants.
The author evaluates the methods and the results of the various methods used in behavioral toxicology
with respect to advantages and disadvantages and considers the feasibility of the methods.

123.Draggan, S., J. Cohrssen, and R. Morrison.  1990. Environmental Monitoring, Assessment and
Management — The Agenda for Long-term Research and Development. Praeger, New  York. 176 pp.

This book originates from an expert panel meeting  on monitoring, assessment, and environmental
management.  It covers issues surrounding long-term environmental research and recommends
research needs relating to  such areas as environmental change, the dynamics of stressed ecosystems,
ecological markers, biological indicators of ecological health, and ecosystem level studies.

124.Dubey, P. 1991. Biomonitoring the environment — Theory, practice and problems. J. Environ. Biol.
12(SI):233-241.

125.Dumar, K. 1989. Indicators for measuring changes in income, food availability and consumption,
and the natural resource base. AID Program Design and Evaluation Methodology-12, AID-PN-AAX-223.
NTIS No. PB90-261975/HDM. Center for Development Information and Evaluation, Agency for
International Development, Washington, DC. 42 pp.

This report documents the  findings of a workshop held in  1988 to identify a set of simple, practical
indicators for monitoring the impact of the Agency for International Development's (AID'S) agricultural
and rural assistance program.  Three groups of indicators are discussed:  (1) indicators to measure
income change (e.g., macro-level indicators such as Gross National Product, Gross Domestic Product
and microlevel indicators such as household income and expenditures, and indicators of intrahousehold
income distribution); (2) indicators to measure changes in food consumption (e.g., per capita calorie
intake, food expenditures, and market availability and prices) and anthropomorphic indicators such as
weight at birth; and (3) natural resource indicators (e.g., including indicators of topsoil erosion, crop
yield, actual land use vs soil suitability, surface and groundwater pollution, and the status of rangelands,
forests, and wetlands). Good indicators should provide valid measures and be reliable,  sensitive to
change, replicable, and based on easily accessible data; they should also be measurable quickly and
cost-effectively.
                                              47

-------
126.Ecological Society of America. 1981. Symposium: Indicators of ecosystem responses to fossil
fuel residuals.  Annual meeting of the Ecological Society of America, 16-20 August 1980, Indiana
University, Bloomington. Abstracts of presented papers. Bull. Ecol. Soc. Am.  62:90-91 and 107-108.

127.Ecology Committee. 1980. Goals and criteria for design of a biological monitoring system.
Environmental  Protection Agency, Science Advisory Board, Washington, DC. 53 pp.

128.Edwards,  C. J., R.A. Ryder, and T.R. Marshall. 1990. Using lake trout  as a surrogate of
ecosystem health for oligotrophic waters of the Great Lakes. J. Great Lakes Res. 16(4):591-608.

The Great Lakes Water Quality Agreement (1978) between Canada and the  United States provided for
the accommodation of ecosystem objectives for the Great Lakes Basin ecosystem.  Accordingly, the
two parties to the agreement, under the aegis of the International Joint Commission, acted in concert to
define ecosystem objectives for the Great Lakes, and to provide a vehicle for practical application of
these objectives. For the oligotrophic portions of the Great Lakes, the lake trout was selected as an
exemplary organism for the detection of well-being or "health" of the system. The suitability of lake
trout derived from the fact that it occupied  a sensitive, integrative node at the top trophic level of the
system. There, in its role as a terminal  predator, the lake trout acted as a major controlling factor over
the remainder of the cold-water community.  The lake trout,  as the organism of choice, best satisfied  a
comprehensive set of qualifying criteria for indicator organisms. A secondary organism, Pontoporeia
hoyi, was selected  as complementary to the lake trout because it was indicative of oligotrophic system
quality  at another sensitive, integrative  node, namely the mud-water interface of the demersal zone. To
provide a practical  means for management application of the lake trout as an oligotrophic ecosystem
surrogate, a Dichotomous Key was devised and subsequently upgraded to a menu-driven computer
based expert system.  This system was designed explicitly for ecosystem managers to rapidly detect
the state of health of an oligotrophic ecosystem.  It focused  specifically on questions dealing with the
niche characteristics and habitat requirements of the lake trout. An optional printed output not only
described the relative state of the system,  but in addition, underlined the areas of greatest degradation
and pointed out the current information needs. Preliminary testing of the Dichotomous Key on each of
the Great Lakes has shown its value as a first logical and necessary step in the process of system
rehabilitation.

Key Words: Fish management, Lake trout, Indicators, Bioindicators

129.EnvIronment Canada. 1990. Environmental indicators: Opinions of potential users. Technical
Report Series No. 117. Performed under contract by Western Environmental and Social Trends,
Ottawa. NTIS No.  MIC-91-02035/HDM. Available from  National Technical Information Service,
Springfield, VA. Sponsored by Canadian Wildlife  Service, Strategies and Scientific Methods Branch,
and Sustainable Development Branch;  and Environment Canada, Corporate  Policy Group. Environment
Canada, Ottawa, Ontario. 86 pp.

This qualitative study asked opinion leaders familiar with environmental matters across Canada for their
views on environmental indicators developed to provide Canadians with a better understanding of
environmental conditions and trends within the context of sustainable development.  The methodology,
results, and analysis of the opinion research are summarized.

130.Environment Canada. 1991. Report on Canada's progress towards a national set of environmental
indicators: State of the Environment Report Series no. SOE 91-1. State of the Environment Reporting
SSC-EN1-11/91-1E; ISBN-0-662-18394-0.  Environment Canada (Indicators Task Force), Ottawa,
Ontario. 108 pp.

Environmental indicators, like economic indicators, are important tools for translating quantities of data
into succinct information that can be readily understood  and used by decision  makers and the general
public.   The Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development (OECD) has taken the first  step
in leading an international initiative to develop a series of indicators, and Canada is beginning to work
on developing  a similar series. This report presents a brief  overview of efforts  now under way to
                                              48

-------
 develop consistent, reliable indicators to measure the quality of our environment, the stresses placed on
 it, and the steps taken to prevent or reduce those stresses.

 Forty-three indicators in 18 issue areas are presented in the annex of this report.

 131.Environmental Protection Agency. 1987. Unfinished business: A comparative assessment of
 environmental problems. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Policy Analysis and Office of
 Policy, Planning, and Evaluation. Washington,  DC.

 132.Environmental Protection Agency. 1988. Future risk:  Research strategies for the 1990's. SAB-
 EC-88-048. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Science Advisory Board, Washington, DC.

 133.Envlronmental Protection Agency. 1990. Region 10 environmental indicators: FY 89 report.
 EPA/910/9-90/018. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Seattle, WA. 182 pp.

 This is EPA Region 10's third annual summary of environmental indicators for air, water, and land
 media.  The Region's programs in air, water, toxics, pesticides, and hazardous waste are attempting to
 characterize their progress in addressing environmental degradation via the measures described in the
 report. The FY 89 report builds on the  FY 88 document with the addition of (1) FY 89 data; (2) new
 measures and deletions; and (3) new programmatic areas in which indicators have  been developed,
 including underground injection control (UIC), accidental releases, and terrestrial environments. Each
 chapter includes an introduction providing pertinent background information for each environmental
 indicator.

 134.ESSA (Environmental Social Systems Analysts, Ltd.). 1982. Review and evaluation of adaptive
 environmental assessment and management. EN 21-36/1983E. Environment Canada, Ottawa.

 135.Evans, D.O., G.J. Warren, and V.W. Cairns. 1990. Assessment and management of fish
 community health in the Great Lakes: Synthesis and recommendations. J. Great Lakes Res. 16(4):639-
 669.

 A conceptual framework for evaluating the effects of toxic contaminants on fish communities in the
 Great Lakes includes general ecosystem principles that define the  hierarchical structure, homeostatic
 mechanisms, and general stress syndromes as well as the effects  of anthropogenic stressors at various
 levels in the ecosystem. The large number of  influences on ecosystem behavior has obscured direct
 relationships between stressors and system reactions. A broad assessment of ecosystem health in the
 Great Lakes should incorporate field-oriented studies, toxicological data, and knowledge about human
 interactions with the environment.

 136.Eyles, J. 1990. Objectifying the subjective: The measurement  of environmental quality. Social
 Indicat. Res. 2:139-153.

The paper begins by examining the nature and measurement of environmental quality (EQ) pointing to
the tensions between insider and outsider accounts and lay and expert perceptions. Lay accounts are
seen as particularly crucial in residential environments and quality of life (QoL) research into these
fields is assessed. But QoL and EQ are seen  as closely related phenomena. While there are exist
important concepts and approaches (e.g., relating to the nature of places and the significance of
contextual data), it is argued that ethnographic investigations and the theory of structuration may help
reconcile the tensions and that all approaches  will lead to better interpretation, understanding and
explanation of the nature of the subjective world.

 137.Falrweather, P. 1991. Statistical power and design requirements for environmental monitoring.
Aust. J. Mar. Freshwater Res. 42(5):555-567.

This paper discusses, from a philosophical perspective,  the reasons for considering the power of any
statistical test used in environmental biomonitoring.  Power is inversely related to the probability of
making a Type II error (i.e., low power indicates a high probability of Type II error).  In  the context of
                                              49

-------
environmental monitoring, a Type II error is made when it is concluded that no environmental impact
has occurred, even though one has. Type II errors have been ignored relative to Type I  errors (the
mistake of concluding that there is an impact when one has not occurred), the rates ot which are
stipulated by the a values of the test.  In contrast, power depends on the value of alpha,  the sample
size used in the test, the effect size to be detected, and the variability inherent in the data. Although
power ideas have been known for years, only recently have these issues attracted the attention of
ecologists and methods been available for calculating power easily.

By understanding statistical power, researchers are able to improve to improve environmental
monitoring and to inform decisions about actions arising from monitoring in three ways. First, it allows
the most sensitive tests to be chosen from among those applicable to the data. Second, preliminary
power analysis can be used to indicate the sample sizes necessary to detect an environmental change.
Third, power analysis should be used after any nonsignificant result is obtained to judge whether the
result can be  interpreted with confidence or the test was too weak to examine the null  hypothesis
properly. Power procedures are concerned with the statistical significance of tests of the null
hypothesis, and they lend little insight, on their own, into the workings of nature.  Power analyses are,
however, essential to designing sensitive tests and correctly interpreting their results. The biological or
environmental significance of any result, including whether the impact is beneficial or harmful, is a
separate issue.

The most compelling reason for considering power is that Type II errors can be more costly than Type  I
errors for environmental management. This is because the commitment of time,  energy, and people to
fighting a false alarm ( a Type I error) may continue only in  the short term until the mistake is
discovered. In contrast, the cost of not doing something when in fact it should be done (a Type II error)
will have both short- and long-term costs (e.g., ensuing environmental degradation and the eventual
cost of its rectification). Low power can be disastrous for environmental monitoring programs.

138.Feder, A., and W. Manning. 1979. Living plants as indicators and monitors. Pages 1-14. In: W.
Heck, S. Krupa, and S. Linzon, eds. Handbook for the Assessment of Air Pollution Effects on
Vegetation. Air Pollution Control Association, Pittsburgh, PA.

139.Finn, J. 1976. Measures of ecosystem structure and function derived from analysis of flows. J.
Theor. Biol. 56:363-380.

Several measures of ecosystem structure and function are derived from the application of economic
input-output analysis to ecosystem compartment models.  Total system throughflow  (TST) is defined as
the sum of all compartmental throughflows. Average path length of the i-th inflow (APL-1) is  defined as
the average number of compartments through which the i-th inflow passes. Average path length for an
average inflow (APL) is the mean of APL-1 weighted according to the size of the inflows.  APL is shown
to be  equal to TST divided by the  sum of all inflows.  TST can be partitioned  into a portion resulting
from cycled flow (TST-c) and a portion resulting from low  straight through the system (straight
throughflow TST-s).  The portion of APL from cycled flow divided by the portion from straight
throughflow is the cycling index (Cl).  This index indicates how many times further than the straight
throughflow path length an average system inflow will  travel because of cycling.  Three simple
ecosystem models are examined to demonstrate the usefulness of these measures  in  explaining
ecological phenomena.

140.Forster,  E., M. Matthies, L. Peichl, and W. Mucke.  1991. A Meta database of environmental
monitoring programmes — concept and evaluation. Toxicol. Environ. Chem. 30(1-2):101-107.

Eighty-one environmental monitoring programs have been randomly selected and stored in a meta
database. The programs were compared by their concept,  sample and site description, sample
treatment, analytical methods, and information exchange. The data fields are based on a detailed
questionnaire, which is oriented to the guidelines for specimen banking.  The programs were classified
on the basis of the main  environmental compartments considered: air, soil, water, and biota.  Most
include the measurement of pollutants in one or more media, and some include measurements of
biological or physical effects.  Program comparison was difficult because of the differences in concept,
                                              50

-------
site descriptions, sample treatments, and analytical methods.  Based on this study, a harmonization of
long-term monitoring programs, conducted by the state governments of Germany, should be
undertaken.

Key Words: Environmental monitoring programs, Meta database

141.Fox, D., J. Bernabo, and B. Hood. 1987. Guidelines for measuring the physical, chemical, and
biological condition of wilderness areas. General Technical Report RM-146. U.S. Department of
Agriculture, Forest Service, Rocky Mountain Forest and Range Experiment Station, Fort Collins, CO.

This report presents appropriate scientific protocols to measure current conditions of air quality related
values (AQRVs) in wilderness areas. These protocols are intended to be guidelines for quantifying the
existing status of AQRVs, monitoring for changes from these existing conditions, and subsequently,
evaluating whether the changes are naturally occurring or the result of human-caused air
pollution/chemical deposition. Measurements taken to monitor condition are divided into several
categories: atmospheric environment, soils and geology (including aquatic chemistry), and vegetation.
When a specific pollutant is not identified or for such concerns as acid deposition that may cause
ecosystem-level effects, basic and long-term monitoring is recommended.

142.Franz, E.H. 1981. A general formulation of stress phenomena in ecological systems. Pages 49-54.
In: G. W. Barrett and R. Rosenberg, eds. Stress Effects on Natural Ecosystems. John Wiley & Sons,
Chichester.

The concept of stress was new to the lexicon of biomedical and social sciences in the first  half of the
twentieth century.  With antecedent usages in middle English and physics, Sir William Osier identified
stress and strain as basic factors in  angina pectoris—a relationship which he attributed to hard work
and worry!  In physics, these terms had been given precise definitions according to Hooke's law of
elasticity.  The law relates the deformation of metals to the load producing it; stress is the independent
variable or cause, and strain is the dependent variable or effect.

Routine inspection of the contemporary literature in ecology suggests that stress phenomena are of
increasing interest.  It also reveals that ecologists subscribe to several formulations of the stress
concept and to different definitions of the term. The fundamentals of some traditional approaches are
reviewed, concluding with the introduction of a general formulation for ecological systems.

143.Freedman, B. 1989. Environmental Ecology: The Impacts of Pollution and Other Stresses on
Ecosystem Structure and Function. Academic Press, San Diego, CA.

The central focus of this book is on the ecological impacts of anthropogenic stresses. Besides the
introductory chapter, there are eleven others: Air pollution; Toxic elements; Acidification; Forest decline;
Oil pollution; Eutrophication of freshwater; Pesticides; Harvesting of forests; Loss of species richness;
Ecological effects of warfare and;  Effects of stress  on ecosystem structure and function.  A  bibliography
containing over 1500 references and an index organized by biological, chemical, geographical, and
subject categories are also included.

144.Freedman, B. 1992. Environmental stress and the management of ecological reserves. Pages
303-308. In: J. Willison,  S. Bondrup-Nielsen, C. Drysdale, T. Herman, N. Munro, and T.  Pollock, eds.
Science and the Management of Protected Areas.  Elsevier, Amsterdam.

Ecological reserves are established for the conservation of valued ecological heritage, which could
include rare and endangered species and their habitat, endangered ecosystems, or typical
representatives of widespread natural ecosystems.  However, ecological reserves are continuously
subjected to natural and anthropogenic stresses of multifarious types and intensities, and in the face of
such stress change is inevitable. Consequently, ecological  heritage cannot be protected by
simple-minded  management such as the delineation of reserve boundaries, or the prohibition of
harvesting of biological or other natural resources.  The  appropriate management of protected areas
must also include a close, adaptive attention to the likely ecological response to changes in
                                              51

-------
environmental stresses that will occur naturally or, more likely, as a result of an increasing intensity of
human activities.

145.Freytag, G. 1978. The significance of amphibia and other lower invertebrates as indicators for
changes in ecosystems: Observations at Lake Balaton, Hungary.  (In German). Salamandra 14(4):203-
206.

Observations for 20 years on amphibians and other lower invertebrates of the Tihany Peninsula (Lake
Balaton, Hungary) reveal a remarkably close correlation with different methods of mosquito control and
with mass tourism.

146.Frledel, M. 1991.  Range condition assessment and the concept of thresholds: A viewpoint. J.
Range Manage. 44(5):422-426.

Dissatisfaction persists with current approaches to range condition and trend assessment.  Sometimes
assessed condition does not truly represent the past or the potential of range.  One of the likely causes
is a failure to re-examine and change, if necessary, the theoretical basis of  assessment, in line with
developing understanding of ecological processes.  The concept of thresholds of environmental change
appears to provide a reasonable alternative in some circumstances to the concepts of  gradual
retrogression and  secondary succession that are currently accepted. The author suggests that
environmental change can be discontinuous, with thresholds occurring between alternative states.
Once a threshold is crossed to a more degraded state, the former state cannot be attained without
significant management effort, such as prescribed burning, ploughing, or herbicide application, rather
than by simple grazing control.  Examination of data from extensive monitoring programs and from a
study of grazing impact, as well as more general sources  of information, indicates that thresholds of
change may be identifiable in arid rangelands. A practical means of monitoring proximity to thresholds
is available and, with the aid of multivariate analysis, the effects of spatial variability  and season can be
separated from those of management. The potential of this approach deserves investigation in a wider
variety of environments.

Key Words: Succession, Site potential, Ordination,  Classification,  Trend

147.Frlend, A.  1988. Federal government databases relevant for environmental risk management.
Pages 63-89. In: C. Fowle, A.  Grima, and  R. Munn, eds. Information Needs for Risk Management.
University of Toronto, Toronto.

148.Fritz, J. 1990. A Survey of Environmental Monitoring and Information Management Programmes of
International Organizations. United Nations Environment Program (UNEP), Global Environmental
Monitoring System.  Harmonization of Environmental Measurement (HEM) Office, Munich, Hartmut
Keune, Director. UNEP HEM, Munich.

This report provides a summary of international environmental monitoring programs, including  EMAP.
The three core  sections of the report are: (1)  monitoring and research programs, which describes the
activities of 45 programs; (2) data and information systems programs, which describes 21 programs
devoted to data integration; and (3) harmonization  programs, which summarizes the activities of 12
organizations involved in developing standards and harmonization information. Information provided for
monitoring programs includes type of program, geographic area of implementation, program objectives,
data management, and cooperation with other national or international agencies.

149.Frost, T.M., S.R. Carpenter, T.K. Kratz, and J. Magnuson. 1992. Choosing ecological indicators
of condition: Effect of taxonomic aggregation on sensitivity to stress and natural variability. Pages 215-
228. In: D.  McKenzie,  D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the
International Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL,  16-19 October 1990.
Elsevier, Essex, England.

To assess overall ecosystem condition, it is necessary to  choose indicators of environmental stress that
incorporate two basic, and potentially contradictory, properties. Ecological indicators should be
                                              52

-------
sensitive to the variety of anthropogenic stresses that could occur.  At the same time, such indicators
must be reasonably predictable in unperturbed ecosystems; some natural benchmark is necessary
against which to assess a deviation resulting from stress.  If sensitive parameters of ecosystem
condition also exhibit greater levels of unpredictable variability, the choice of ecological indicators will
involve a compromise between two conflicting factors.

150.Fuentes, E., B. Kronberg, and H. Mooney. 1991. The west coasts of the Americas as indicators
of global change. Trends Ecol. Evol. 6(7):203-204.

This "news and comment" feature discusses the issues of  being able to distinguish landscape changes
caused by management from those resulting from global climate change, which would require both
monitoring and the development of whole-system models.  The idea behind using the west coasts of
North and South America as global climate change indicators  is that they are similar but disjunct
ecosystems in which a known variable differs.  This approach  has proved successful in the past in
distinguishing between management- and naturally-induced landscape changes.

151.Gelinas, R., and J. Slaats. 1989.  Selecting indicators for state of the environment reporting: Draft
report. Technical Report Series No. 8. NTIS No. MIC-90-06282/HDM. Strategies for Scientific Methods
Branch. Canadian Wildlife Service, Ottawa, Ontario. 28 pp.

The federal government has recently established a national state of the environment (SOE) reporting
program to provide a better understanding of environmental conditions and trends to Canadians.  An
important step in the program is to identify which indicators will be used to represent the state of the
environment.  This report defines the indicators and describes the role of SOE reporting and indicators,
discusses the desirable characteristics of SOE indicators, and describes current and proposed indicator
research.

Keywords: Environmental monitoring, Environmental education

152.General  Accounting Office. 1991.  Wildlife management: Problems being experienced with current
monitoring approach. GAO/RCED-91-123. General Accounting Office, Washington, DC. 8 pp.

The Forest Service's management indicator species approach to monitoring, as currently practiced,
appears to have several practical drawbacks and can be prohibitively expensive to implement.
Furthermore,  Forest Service officials responsible for conducting monitoring in the field have said that
even when planned data collection efforts are completed by using this monitoring approach, the data
can have limited usefulness because observed population  changes in the  species being monitored
often cannot be related to overall habitat conditions or the  effects of Forest Service management
actions.  Forest Service  headquarters officials recognize that practical problems have been experienced
but believe these difficulties have stemmed more from the  way that management indicator species
principles were applied, rather than from fundamental weaknesses with the concept itself. The officials
said they are  attempting to improve their direction to field staff and believe that with revised direction
many of the problems observed can be resolved.

153.Gentile, J.H., and M.W. Slimak. 1992. Endpoints and indicators in ecological risk assessments.
Pages 1385-1399. In: D. McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of
the International Symposium on Ecological  Indicators held  in Fort Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October  1990.
Elsevier,  Essex, England.

The U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency (EPA) is beginning to develop  ecological risk assessment
guidelines that will be used within EPA to conduct ecological risk assessments. This work began in
early 1988 by identifying appropriate ecological endpoints of concern that can be used in assessing
risk. EPA's current ecological assessments fall into four broad categories: prediction of chemical  risks,
prediction of project impacts, retrospective analyses of site-specific impacts, and the monitoring of
ecological changes. The framework for ecological risk assessments includes the hierarchy of biological
organization - from the ecosystem down to the individual organisms - and  emphasizes the use of
assessment endpoints (indicators) at one level and measurement assessment endpoints at another.
                                              53

-------
This framework permits both a holistic and a reductionist approach.  Assessment endpoints as defined
by this effort are equivalent to the use of indicators for purposes of interpreting environmental
conditions.

154.Gerritsen, J., and B. Patten. 1985. System theory formulation of ecological disturbance. Ecol.
Modell. 29:383-397.

Ecological disturbance is defined in the context of a dictionary definition and state-space system theory.
Disturbance can be partitioned into cause and effect. The cause is the exogenous disturbance, and its
effect is unusual behavior of system state or output, with respect to nominal behavior.  A disturbance
can act on input, state, or the coupling parameters (process) of a system and is  observed  by change in
state or output.  Another attribute of the system model, the response function, which determines state,
can also be changed indirectly as a result of disturbance.

Both timing and magnitude  of phenomena are important in determining nominal behavior and deviations
from nominal.  Systems and behavior are hierarchical such that disturbances at any given  level are not
necessarily disturbances at higher or lower levels of organization.  For an event  or extended
phenomenon to be considered a disturbance, it must have three properties, two  of timing and one of
magnitude, relevant to the level at which disturbance is manifested: (1) low frequency of recurrence
with respect to the temporal scale,  (2) low temporal predictability with respect to the level's time scale,
and (3) production of a significant deviation from nominal outputs or state.  Simple models of well-
known ecological phenomena illustrate different classes of disturbance: (1) change of state; (2) change
of state followed by change of transition function; (3) change of input; and  (4) change of input followed
by change of state and transition function.

155.Giersch, C. 1991. Sensitivity analysis of ecosystems—an analytical treatment. Ecol. Modell. 53(1-
2) :131-146.

Parameter sensitivities of mathematical models of ecosystems are studied analytically.  A procedure for
analytical  calculation of relative sensitivities is developed, and summation properties of sensitivities with
respect to parameters in which the model equations are homogeneous are derived.  A simple plant-
herbivore  system is used to illustrate analytical calculation of parameter sensitivities and the type of
information that can be obtained from the approach.

156.Gilbert, R. 1987. Statistical Methods for Environmental Pollution Monitoring. Van Nostrand
Reinhold,  New York.

157.Gilbertson, M. 1990. Freshwater avian and mammalian predators as indicators of environmental
quality. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 15(3) :219-224.

The objective of this paper  is to outline (1) the advantages and disadvantages of using four avian and
mammalian predators, the bald eagle, osprey, mink, and otter, as indicators of environmental quality
and (2) the kinds of information on these species that could be collected to make a defensible scientific
case for regulatory action.  This paper starts from the premise that if these species are  present and
maintaining their populations, then  aquatic environmental quality is probably satisfactory.

158.Godron, M., and R. Forman.  1983. Landscape modification and changing ecological
characteristics.  Pages 12-28. In: H. Mooney and M. Godron, eds. Disturbance and Ecosystems:
Components of Response.  Springer-Verlag, New York.

The authors have two objectives: (1) to use some of the most encompassing or fundamental ecological
concepts to pinpoint emergent patterns when comparing the natural landscape with the major types of
human-modified landscapes, and (2) to focus  more specifically on how the structural characteristics of
landscapes change along a gradient of increasing human  modification.

159.Goldsmith, B. 1991. Synthesis. Pages 269-271. In: B. Goldsmith, ed. Monitoring for Conservation
and Ecology. Chapman and Hall, London.
                                               54

-------
This postlude to the book presents a checklist of questions regarding issues that should be addressed
when embarking on a monitoring program.

160.Goldsmlth, B. 1991. Preface. Pages IX-XIV. In: B. Goldsmith, ed. Monitoring for Conservation and
Ecology. Chapman and Hall, London.

This preface to the book outlines the composition of a good monitoring program. A discussion of the
newly fashionable discipline of monitoring is also included.

161.Goldsmith. B., ed. 1991. Monitoring for Conservation and Ecology. Chapman and Hall, London.

This book covers aspects of environmental monitoring from the local scale to the national scale.
Chapters include discussions on definitions of monitoring, development of a rationale for monitoring,
aspects concerning wildlife, bird, and butterfly monitoring, and use of environmental indicators for
national-level monitoring.

162.Graham, R.L., M.G. Turner, and V. Dale. 1989. CCyinduced climate change  and forest resources.
Pages 233-241. In: R.D. Noble, J.L. Martin, and K.F. Jensen, eds. Air Pollution Effects on Vegetation
Including Forest Ecosystems.  Proceedings of the Second US-USSR  Symposium. U.S. Department of
Agriculture, Forest Service, Northeastern Forest Experiment Station,  Broomall, PA.

The objective of this paper is to examine potential forest responses to increases in atmospheric CO2
and to CO2-induced climatic change. Forest responses to CO2 and climate may be examined by using
five biotic paradigms: biosphere, biome, ecosystem, stand, and tree.  Each paradigm has its own
spatial and temporal scale and its own set of unique phenomena responsive to CO2 and climate
change.  First these paradigms are used to review forest responses to CO2 and climate. Next, the
linkages between these paradigms and the implications of these linkages for future research on the
impact of elevated atmospheric CO2 and climate change on forest resources are described.

163.Graham, R., C. Hunsaker, R. O'Neill, and B. Jackson. 1991. Ecological risk  assessment at the
regional scale. Ecol. Appl.  1(2): 196-206.

Ecological risk assessments are used by policymakers and regulatory agencies to balance and
compare ecological risks associated with environmental hazards. An approach for  regional-scale
ecological risk assessment is described and demonstrated by modeling environmental risks associated
with elevated ozone in a forested region.  The demonstration illustrates (1) how a regional-scale risk
assessment might be done, (2) the importance of spatial characteristics in considering regional-scale
risk, and (3) the necessity of considering terrestrial and aquatic linkages.  Generic problems often
encountered when doing regional assessments, the foremost of which is the frequent lack of region-
specific and spatial data, are also highlighted.  In the demonstration,  two  levels of elevated ozone and
five different at-risk regional features are considered (forest cover, forest edge, forest interior, landscape
pattern, and lake water quality).  The mechanism for impacts on these features is ozone-induced stress
in coniferous trees, patches of which can then be killed by bark beetle attacks.  A stochastic spatial
model of land-cover change is developed to evaluate the risks of significant changes in the selected
ecological features as a consequence of these ozone-triggered beetle attacks.  Risk to regional water
quality of lakes is evaluated by linking the land-cover output from the spatial stochastic model to an
empirical water-quality model that is sensitive to land-cover changes  within a lake's watershed. The
risk analysis shows that those environmental features that are sensitive to the location of coniferous
forest (such as forest edge) are at risk  of a significant change as a result of ozone-induced conifer
mortality, even though overall  coniferous forest cover is only slightly affected. The  analysis  also
suggests a high probability of changes  in regional water quality of lakes as a consequence of location-
specific forest-cover change.

Key Words: Adirondack region, Bark beetle infestation, Disturbance,  Ecological  risk assessment,
Regional risk  assessment,  Risk assessment demonstration, Scale
                                              55

-------
164.Granatstein, D., and D. Bezdicek. 1992. The need for a soil quality index: Local and regional
perspectives. Am. J. Altern. Agric. 7(1-2):12-16.

Our knowledge of soil is based primarily on quantitative analysis of isolated physical, chemical, and
biological properties.  However, the interaction of these quantitative aspects determines soil quality.
Integrative tools are needed by researchers, farmers, regulators, and others to evaluate changes in soil
quality from  human activity at a local and global level.  An index needs to be adaptable to local or
regional conditions.  For example, the parameters needed to determine changes in soil quality may
differ between a semi-arid wheat field and a rice paddy. Suitable reference points and optimum ranges
are needed for soil quality attributes.  The present challenge is to integrate a suite of soil tests into a
meaningful index that correlates with productivity, environmental, and health goals.

Key Words:  Soil health, Soil condition, Soil analysis

165.Graves, B.M., and P.L. Dittberner. 1986.  Variables for monitoring aquatic and terrestrial
environments.  Biological Report 86(5),  National Ecology Research Center. NTIS No. PB87-
113916/GAR. U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service, Fort Collins, CO. 63 pp.

This manual provides general conceptual guidelines for designing habitat monitoring projects and
identifying key variables that may indicate habitat quality.  References are provided that lead to more
detailed discussions of important topics. The field of habitat monitoring is quite broad and appropriate
field methods may vary from site to site. Hence, the manual cannot provide a step-by-step procedure
for habitat monitoring. Rather, it provides a framework and general principles; designers of individual
monitoring programs must integrate and adapt these to specific circumstances.

166.Gray, J. 1980. Why do ecological monitoring? Mar. Poll. Bull. 11:62-65.

Recently, criticism has been raised against ecological monitoring on the grounds that obtaining the
basic data -  the species lists and species abundances  - is time-consuming or that ecological monitoring
is relatively insensitive. The insensitivity arises because usually only absence of species can be used;
this is true because natural changes in  abundance of species over time (the background noise)  are
difficult to separate from pollution effects.  The feeling  seems to be that if effects of pollutants could be
detected in individuals at the physiological  or biochemical level  before abundance changes are
observed, then such techniques for monitoring are preferable.

Much money has been wasted on conducting surveys  in the guise of obtaining so-called "baselines,"
which because of their inadequate survey design could never fulfill the stated goal of detecting effects
of a particular pollutant.  The question "How can one come up with a passable ecological monitoring
program that can be expected to answer the questions being posed?" is approached by first
considering  alternatives to ecological monitoring.

167.Gray, J. 1989. Effects of environmental stress on  species of rich assemblages. Biol. J.  Linnean
Soc. 37:19-32.

Selye's widely used model of responses of individual organisms to a stressor is not appropriate for
describing effects at the population or community level. At the  ecosystem level a number of functional
responses have been suggested by Rapport, Regier, and Hutchinson, but detailed analysis  shows that,
in general, functional responses are not sensitive to early detection of impending ecosystem damage.

Three clear  changes in community structure occur in response  to stressors.  These are reduction in
diversity, retrogression to dominance by opportunistic species, and reduction in mean size of the
dominating species.  Statistically significant reductions in diversity occur rather late in the sequence of
increased stressor impact.  The first stages of impact are clearly shown by moderately common
species, yet most attention  has concentrated on the common species.  Species that dominate in heavily
stressed habitats are often species complexes, and the possible genetic mechanisms causing this are
considered.
                                               56

-------
Although changes in the mean size of the dominant organisms can be shown in experiments, there is
no dear evidence that recorded reductions in the size ot North Atlantic and North Sea plankton are
induced by human-made stressors.

Key Words: Stress, Diversity, Dominance, Size

168.Green, R. 1984.  Statistical and nonstatistical considerations for environmental monitoring studies.
Environ. Monitor. Assess. 4:293-301.

In environmental studies statistics is too often used as a salvage operation or as an attempt to show
"significance" in the absence of any clear hypothesis. Good design is needed, not fancier statistics.
Too often we pursue short-term problems that are in fashion rather than study long-term environmental
deterioration that really matters.  Since change, often unpredictable change, is an intrinsic part of
nature,  it is pointless to fight all environmental change.  We must choose our  level of concern and then
influence environmental change where we can. The judgement on whether a given  change is bad
cannot be left to the statistician or to statistical tests; the politician in consultation with the ecologist is
responsible for it. The statistical significance of a hypothesized impact-related change should be tested
against year-to-year variation in the unimpacted situation rather than against replicate sampling error.
This is another argument for long-term studies. Attributes of good design and appropriate criterion and
predictor variables are discussed.

169.Grodzlnskl, W., and T. Yorks. 1981. Species and ecosystem level  bioindicators of airborne
pollution: An analysis of two major  studies. Water Air Soil Poll. 16:33-53.

Bioindication of air pollution effects has received considerable attention in recent years. The attention
has been almost entirely focused on individual species,  and relatively little notice has been given to
ecosystem-level process and function  monitors.  Long-term research projects  in the  Niepolomice Forest
in southern Poland and the Colstrip area in southeast Montana, U.S.A., were  analyzed for both organism-
 and system-level indicators and  monitors for Sulfur, trace element, and  fluoride pollution originating in
nearby coal-fired industrial processes.  Species of lichens exhibited changes in morphology and
survival, and pine species exhibited pollutant accumulation in needles at both  sites.  Declines in Scotch
pine growth in Poland of up to 20% were compared with declines in western wheatgrass rhizome
biomass in Montana to illustrate system-wide effects on  primary productivity.  Directly observable
declines in decomposition rate were noted for both sites at higher pollution levels and tied to system-
wide occurrences of nutrient deficiency and toxicant buildup in soil pools.  Pollutant increases in deer
antler composition, changes in grasshopper dietary patterns, and lichen density and health were
postulated  to have system-level implications as well.

170.Gutman, G. 1991. Monitoring land ecosystems using the NOAA Global Vegetation Index data set.
Paleogeogr. Paleoclimatol. Paleoecol.  (also called Global and Planetary  Change Section V.4) 90:195-
200.

The Global Vegetation Index (GVI) data set  produced by NOAA from Advanced Very High Resolution
Radiometer measurements for 1985-1988 was used to derive the temporal variability of surface
characteristics of diverse ecosystems over the globe.  The GVI data were screened  for residual cloud
contamination and haze.  The viewing geometry was restricted to within  25° of nadir. The results are
demonstrated by using monthly means of the satellite derived parameters spatially averaged over 250
km x 250 km.  Phenology of land ecosystems as manifested by the surface albedo,  greenness and
temperature is analyzed.  A color-composite technique for mapping global ecosystems is introduced.

171.Haberern, J. 1992. A soil health index. J. Soil Water Conserv. 47(1 ):6.

In this viewpoint article, the author stresses the importance in maintaining a high quality of soil
condition.   He discusses the soil health index, being created by the Rodale Institute, which will be a
report card that documents the gains and losses in soil quality worldwide.
                                               57

-------
172.Haedrich, R. 1975. Diversity and overlap as measures of environmental quality. Water Res.
9:945-952.
It is argued that indices of diversity (information function H) and overlap (percentage similarity PS) can
be used together to assess environmental quality. The method is tested by using data on demersal
fishes from nine Massachusetts estuaries and embayments. Annual diversity ranged from H (log e) =
0.4 to 2.4, with low diversities in areas of apparent high pollution and higher diversities in areas of
lesser pollution. Where annual diversity is low,  little seasonal change is reflected in a high PS from
season to season; where annual diversity is high, a relatively lower PS indicates a greater degree of
change.  To calculate both H and PS the number of individuals in each species in a sample is required.
This  data should be considered important in the conduct of faunal surveys that contribute to an
environmental impact statement.

173.Haire, M. S.,  N.N. Panday, O.K. Domotor, and D.G. Flora. 1992. Chesapeake Bay water quality
indices.   Pages 1115-1134.  In: D. McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J.  McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators.
Proceedings of the International Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL,  16-19
October 1990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

Although current monitoring program results provide scientists and technical staff with invaluable
information concerning the health of the Bay system, difficulties are encountered when relaying this
information to concerned  citizens and legislative officials.  The Maryland Department of the Environment
(MDE) has pursued the development of water quality indices to  simplify the results of the monitoring
program  and make them  understandable to the lay audience.

The two water quality indices intended to describe the environmental quality of the Chesapeake Bay
and its tributaries  are (1)  a "nutrient loading index," which documents the amount of nutrients entering
the Chesapeake Bay from point and nonpoint sources and (2) a "eutrophication index," which
incorporates the important parameters of overenrichment into a  single value that represents water
quality response to nutrient controls.  Indices were developed for the Patuxent Estuary, the Potomac
Estuary,  and the mainstem Chesapeake Bay. This report describes the development  and results of
these water quality indices.

174.Halford, G.S., and P.W. Sheehan. 1991. Human response to environmental change. Int. J.
Psychol.  26(5):599-611.

A range of factors affect human response to environmental change. They include the information
available, understanding of the phenomenon, the nature of the decision-making processes implied, and
the motivation for change. One major factor affecting decision making is that scientific information Is
not fully and accurately disseminated through society. The media have an important role in this
process but cannot disseminate all of the necessary information in the manner required and do not
reliably present information that cannot be misinterpreted.  Further, scientific uncertainty about and
complexity of biosphere changes complicate the process of reaching a rational decision.  The mental
model that people have of their world tends to be maintained unless it is contradicted  by experienced
events;  thus, global change is likely to be understood only to the extent that it affects everyday life.
Much of  human reasoning is essentially analogical rather than having a standard logic, and its validity
depends on finding a suitable analogical model. It is suggested that risk, or defense situations may
provide useful analogies. Finally, we need to consider the motivational problems created by the
sacrifices that must be made to deal with the problem effectively.

175.Hamblin, A., ed. 1992. Indicators for agroecological regions in Australia. Pages 68-74. In: A.
Hamblin, ed. Environmental Indicators for Sustainable Agriculture. Bureau of Rural Resources, Dept.
Primary Industry and Energy,  Queen Victoria Terra, Australia.

176.Hamblin, A.  1992. Environmental indicators for sustainable agriculture: Workshop conclusions.
Pages 83-85. In: A. Hamblin, ed. Environmental Indicators for Sustainable Agriculture. Bureau of Rural
Resources, Dept. Primary Industry and Energy, Queen Victoria Terra, Australia.
                                               58

-------
 177.Harris, H.J., P.E. Sager, H.A. Regier, and G.F. Francis. 1990. Ecotoxicology and ecosystem
 integrity: The Great Lakes examined.  Environ. Sci. Technol. 24(5): 598-603.

 This article assesses the contribution of ecotoxicology to the study of stressed ecosystems.  The article
 overviews the concept of ecosystem integrity and how to assess it and discusses stress ecology and
 the interconnections between environmental stressors.

 178.Harrison, E.A. 1976. Bioindicators of pollution: A bibliography with abstracts. NTIS/PS-76/0868.
 National Technical Information Service, Springfield, VA. November.

 This bibliography presents abstracts relating to the use of microorganisms, animals, plants, and fishes
 to detect air and water pollution. Some of the organisms discussed are algae, bacteria, aquatic plants,
 oysters, snails, clams, insects, annelida, amphibians, beaver, and fungi.  (This updated bibliography
 contains 189 abstracts, 22 of which are new entries  to the previous edition.)  The bibliography covers
 the period 1964 to October 1976.

 179.Hart, B., ed. 1982. Water quality management:  Monitoring programs and diffuse runoff. Water
 Studies Centre. Chisolm  Institute of Technology and Australian Society for Limnology, Melborne,
 Australia.

 180.Hart, K., and J. Cairns, Jr. 1984. The maintenance of structural integrity in freshwater protozoan
 communities under stress. Hydrobiologia 108(1 ):171-180.

 The structural assimilative capacity (ability to maintain biological integrity under stress) of protozoan
 communities from nine lakes in the area of the University of Michigan Biological Station, Pellston,
 Michigan, and six stations at Smith Mountain Lake, Virginia, were studied (1) to determine if
 communities from lakes of differing trophic state differ in their ability to assimilate various amounts of
 copper sulfate and (2) to  explore the possible influence of average density of individuals and/or
 qualitative differences in the types of species present on any observed differences in assimilative
 capacity.

 In both the northern Michigan and Smith Mountain Lake Studies, a trend in response was demonstrated
 along the eutrophic-oligotrophic gradient; eutrophic communities had a greater structural assimilative
 capacity than did oligotrophic communities. Both mean species density and community composition
 appear to be important factors in the ability to maintain structural integrity.

 Key Words: Assimilative capacity, Protozoans, Communities, Eutrophication, Artificial substrates,
 Colonization.

 181.Harwell, M., W.  Cooper, and R. Flaak. 1992. Prioritizing ecological and human welfare risks from
 environmental stresses. Environ. Manage. 16(4):451-464.

 The ecological systems of the Earth are subjected to a wide array of environmental stresses resulting
 from human activities. The development of appropriate environmental protection and management
 policies and the appropriate allocation of resources across environmental stresses  require a systematic
 evaluation of relative risks.  The data and methodologies for comprehensive ecological risk assessment
 do not exist, yet we do have considerable understanding of ecological stress-response relationships.  A
 methodology is presented to utilize present knowledge for assignment of relative risks to the ecological
 systems and human welfare from environmental stresses.  The resultant priorities,  developed for the
 EPA's relative risk-reduction project, highlight global climate change, habitat alteration, stratospheric
 ozone depletion, and species depletion  as the highest environmental risks, significantly diverging from
the current emphasis by EPA and the public on toxic chemical issues.  Enhanced attention to ecological
issues by EPA and development of ecological risk assessment methodologies that  value ecological and
economic issues equitably are key recommendations.

Key Words: Ecological risk assessment, Relative risk reduction, EPA, Welfare risks
                                               59

-------
182.Harwell, M., C. Harwell, and J. Kelly. 1986. Regulatory endpoints, ecological uncertainties, and
environmental decision making. Pages 993-998. In: Oceans 86 Proceedings. Marine Technology
Society, Washington, DC.

183.Harwell, M., C. Harwell, D. Weinstein, and J. Kelly. 1987. Anthropogenic stresses on
ecosystems: Issues and  indicators of response and recovery. ERC-153, Ecosystems Research Center.
Cornell University, Ithaca, NY.

184.Harwell, M., C. Harwell, D. Weinstein, and J. Kelly. 1990. Characterizing ecosystem responses
to stress. Pages 91-115. In: W. Grodzinski, E.B. Cowling, and A.I. Breymeyer,  eds. Ecological Risks:
Perspectives from Poland and the  United States. National Academy Press, Washington, DC.

Environmental  risk assessment and management involve the use of methodologies to assess risks to
the health of biological systems, especially the stresses from human activities.  The use of appropriate
ecological indicators to measure environmental effects of these stresses can allow a realistic evaluation
of risks.

185.Harwell, M., and  C. Harwell.  1989. Environmental decision-making in the  presence of uncertainty.
Pages 516-540. In: S. Levin, M. Harwell, J. Kelly, and K. Kimball, eds.  Ecotoxicology: Problems and
Approaches. Columbia University Press, New York.

This chapter covers many topics related to sources of uncertainty in the making of environmental
decisions. Sections include: (1) Effects of chemicals on ecosystems: (a) Direct biological effects, (b)
indirect biological effects, (c) ecosystem-level effects, (d) recovery processes; (2) sources of ecological
uncertainty:  extrapolation issues (from microcosms, models and intact ecosystems); and (3) ecological
information to improve decision making.

186.Havas,  M. 1990. Rapporteur's report of workgroup: Chemical indicators. Environ. Monitor. Assess.
15:287-288.

This conference workgroup summary defines a chemical indicator and  discusses approaches to
chemical monitoring.

187.Hayden, F.G. 1991. Instrumental valuation indicators for natural resources and ecosystems. J.
Econ. Iss. 25(4):917-934.

The purpose of this article  is to present a general instrumental methodology for determining value
indicators with an application to natural resources and ecosystems. The article uses the knowledge
base of the Social Fabric Matrix and the principles of general System Analysis.

Subtopics include: Valuation measurement as indicator creation; Indicator design standards; Policy
analysis paradigm; Valuation; Norms and control valuation;  Biodiversity valuation; Stability valuation;
Ecodevelopment evaluation; Restoration costs and; Restoration valuation.  EMAP and the
Agroecosystem Resource Group are mentioned in the article.

188.Hekstra, G. 1983. Indicators in complex systems. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 3(3-4):369-374.

This article briefly discusses aspects of indicators and monitoring.  Subtopics include: Indication as  a
general term; Factors  and  trends; Ecosystem parameters used as indicators; Diversity and stability;
Flows of matter, energy, and information and; Lines of research.

189.Hellawell, J.M. 1977.  Change in natural and managed ecosystems: Detection, measurement, and
assessment. Proc. Royal Soc. London Ser. B 197:31-57.

Change is an intrinsic property of ecosystems. To achieve effective conservation, acceptable rates and
directions of change need  to be determined.  A preliminary step is the  development of methods for
detecting, measuring,  and  assessing the significance of ecological change.
                                              60

-------
Prolonged surveillance of "natural" and artificially modified systems is necessary to distinguish those
elements of change that are short-term fluctuations (cyclical or stochastic) from  those that are part of
the long-term, perhaps irreversible, trends.  Criteria for selecting appropriate parameters (e.g.,
biocoenoses, community diversity, populations of indicator species, or production estimates) are
required, together with appropriate techniques for monitoring them.

Although few ecosystems are totally isolated from anthropogenic influence, those that remain largely
unaffected serve as reference systems against which changes in intensively exploited or unmanaged
(i.e., unprotected) ecosystems may be compared.

190.Hellawell, J.M. 1986.  Biological Indicators of Freshwater Pollution and Environmental
Management. Elsevier Applied Science Publisher, London.

This book is a comprehensive review of stresses to aquatic ecosystems.  The sections dealing with
indicators generally refer to individuals or indicator species  as environmental indicators.  The chapter on
biological indicators has sections on selection of indicators  (providing characteristics of ideal and good
indicators, and factors that affect indicator reliability), populations as indicators, community structure  as
an indicator, and functional changes in  communities.  Also discussed are the ecological consequences
of imposed environmental stresses to aquatic ecosystems.

191.Hellawell, J.M. 1991.  Development of a rationale for monitoring. Pages  1-14. In: B. Goldsmith, ed.
Monitoring for Conservation and Ecology. Chapman and Hall, London.

"Monitoring" has become an omnibus term and is sometimes applied, almost indiscriminately, to a
range of disparate activities. These may include, for example, attempts to describe prevailing
environmental conditions; the occurrence, distribution and intensity of pollution; or the status of
ecological communities or  populations of species or simply  to provide a watching brief on the
countryside at large.

Because "monitoring" is a process, not  a result, a means to an end rather than an end in itself, it
should not be surprising to find that so many kinds are undertaken.

Implicit in the rationale for  most monitoring activities is a recognition of the potential for change. One is
concerned, therefore, to secure a  means of detecting a  change, of establishing its direction, and of
measuring its extent or intensity.   This stage may prove to be the simpler part of a monitoring process:
often it is more difficult to assess the significance of the change that has been encountered.  Monitoring
schemes, especially those concerned with ecological change, may founder through lack of adequate
criteria to determine significance, and even well-established procedures for pollution monitoring may, in
reality, be based on largely arbitrary limits of acceptability for given pollutant concentrations.

This chapter, above all, stresses the importance of establishing clearly defined objectives to ensure the
development of a successful monitoring strategy.

192.Herendeen, R. 1990. System level indicators in dynamic ecosystems: Comparison based on
energy and nutrient flows. J. Theor. Biol. 143(4):523-554.

System-wide indicators of  ecosystem structure and function depend strongly on the choice of flow
variable, or numeraire.  The author compares two such  indicators, exergy and ascendancy, by using
biomass energy or elemental nitrogen as flow variable.  Comparison is for steady-state (data from Cone
Spring and Tayozhny Log Bog). In both systems, measured flows are available in terms of biomass
energy;  nitrogen flows are  imputed by calculating dynamic nitrogen intensities (analogous to energy
intensities).  The author finds that  when using these two flow variables steady-state normalized
ascendancy differs as much for one ecosystem as it does for two different ecosystems in which the
same flow variable is used. This implies that the question of flow variable choice needs to be resolved
before strong conclusions can be  made about intersystem comparisons. For dynamic behavior,
nitrogen-based exergy shows no more,  and sometimes less, variation over time  than does energy-
based  exergy.  Both nitrogen- and biomass-based ascendancy follow variations in system stock and
                                               61

-------
show little additional variation. Analyzing the size, concentration, and structural components of exergy
and ascendancy aids in understanding these behaviors.  Trophic positions are also compared by using
the two flow variables.

193.Hermann, K. M.J. Hewitt, and D.J. Norton. 1991. Using existing sampling frames in a
comprehensive national monitoring program. In: GIS/LIS '90. Geographic Information Systems/Land
Information Systems Annual Conference, Anaheim, Ca. American Congress for Surveying and
Mapping, Falls Church, Va.

194.Herricks,  E.,  and D.J. Schaeffer. 1985. Can we optimize biomonitoring? Environ. Manage. 9:487-
492.

Biomonitoring is an element of environmental management that must become more sophisticated to
meet the demands of legislation and public concern for environmental safety.  Data collection and
analysis techniques must improve if environmental scientists are to take full advantage of the
information content of field and laboratory biomonitoring efforts. Issues associated with biomonitoring
addressed in this  article include test system selection and the data characteristics of various
biomonitoring techniques. The authors identify optimization as a possible approach to resolving
conflicts between  legal defensibility, scientific accuracy, and the requirements of environmental
managers.

Key Words:  Biomonitoring, Bioassay, Toxicity testing, Bioassessment

195.Herricks,  E.,  and D.J. Schaeffer. 1987a. Selection of test systems to evaluate the effects of
contaminants on ecological systems. Civil Engineering Studies, Environmental Engineering Studies No.
17. University of Illinois, Urbana.

196.Herricks,  E.,  and D.J. Schaeffer. 1987b. Selection of test systems for ecological analysis. Water
Sci. Technol. 19(11):47-54.

Biological monitoring programs developed for ecosystem management, including experimental testing
and descriptive assessments, can be improved through careful selection of test systems.  Test systems
are a defined analysis unit employed to examine or assess. Test systems may range from simple
biochemical assays to experimental manipulation of ecological systems. The authors have developed
an efficient methodology for selecting test systems  to assess the ecological system effects of
chemicals.   The process includes the recognition of ecosystem critical factors, identification of potential
measures for these factors, and selection of appropriate metrics for experimentation or assessment.  A
decision tree, which leads to two methods for test system selection, is proposed.

Key  Words: Biomonitoring, Bioassay, Bioassessment, Environmental assessment, Toxicity testing

197.Herricks,  E., D.J. Schaeffer, and J. Perry. 1988. Biomonitoring: Closing the loop in the
environmental sciences. Pages 351-366. In: S. Levin, M. Harwell, J. Kelly, and K. Kimball, eds.
Ecotoxicology: Problems and Approaches. Columbia University Press, New York.

For the purpose of this chapter,  biomonitoring is defined as the analysis of the performance of living
systems' structures to provide essential  information for  decision making. Although some form of
biomonitoring has been used for hundreds, if not thousands,  of years, a cohesive approach to the
design and use of biomonitoring programs is a recent development.  This chapter discusses
biomonitoring programs, emphasizing program designs that coordinate data collection and facilitate
information retrieval.  The role of biomonitoring is highlighted in the context of environmental
management and regulation.  The authors suggest that both  control theory and decision  science can be
used to refine  biomonitoring programs to optimize the use of data in the environmental sciences,
management,  and regulation.

198.Herrmann, R., and R. Stottlemyer. 1991. Long-term monitoring for environmental change in
United States  National  Parks — A watershed approach. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 17(1):51-65.
                                              62

-------
The U.S. National Park Service (NPS) is faced with direct questions about the condition of National
Park natural resources.  The watershed approach to long-term monitoring of natural and remote areas
within the National Parks has provided important data for detecting both spatial and temporal changes
in environmental conditions.  These data collections allow the partitioning of cause and effect
relationships of ecological change within a given watershed.  They also serve to meet both reference
and early warning objectives. Success in advancing a number of "acid precipitation" goals has
demonstrated the usefulness of these integrated watershed data for inter-ecosystem comparison and
for analogy between watersheds.  Because of the NPS experience, the watershed program is proposed
as a model for focusing the National Park Service's inventory and  monitoring program initiative.  This
approach provides to park researchers and resource managers the needed tools for dealing with
today's complex local, regional, and global natural resources issues.

199.Hildebrand, S.G., L.W. Barnthouse,, and G.W. Suter II. 1987. The role of basic ecological
knowledge in environmental assessment.  Pages 51-67. In: S. Draggan, J. Cohrssen, and R. Morrison,
eds. Preserving Ecological Systems: The Agenda for Long-term Research and Development. Praeger,
New York.

This chapter primarily discusses local environmental impacts and the NEPA procedure, using some
case studies as examples of environmental impacts assessment of power projects, etc.  However, the
authors also summarize the arguments for ecosystem-level assessment and discuss the National Acid
Precipitation Assessment Program as an integrated assessment of the impact of acid rain on
ecosystems.  Suggestions for further research include long-term studies of the response of ecosystems
to criteria concentrations of pollutants and their subsequent recovery or adaptation.

200.Hilden, M., and D. Rapport. 1993. In Press. Four centuries of cumulative cultural impact on a
Finnish river and its estuary: An ecosystem health approach. J. Mar. Sci.

201.HIM,  A. 1975. Ecosystem stability in relation to stresses caused by human activities. Can. Geogr.
19:206-220.

The increasing size of the human population, together with rising technological levels, is imposing
substantial pressures on the  biosphere. The intensity  of human exploitation of the earth's surface  is
producing serious conflicts between short-term benefits to human's and the biosphere's capacity to
provide benefits in perpetuity.  In these circumstances, it is crucial  that a greater understanding of  the
levels of manipulation be developed that can be imposed on  ecosystems without producing serious and
often harmful transformations.  The ability of ecosystems to withstand human-induced stresses is an
aspect of system stability that urgently requires research. Current  generalizations regarding the
vulnerability of major biomes, such as the tundra or tropical rainforest, to human impacts are not
supported by precise data on the reactions of ecosystems to various types of human activity.
Moreover, there is an absence of knowledge on how many aspects of ecosystem structure and
functioning influence stability.

The objective of this paper is to evaluate the current status of research on ecosystem stability.  The
major portion of this research has  been undertaken by ecologists, and there have been comparatively
few contributions from disciplines with a traditional interest in the human-environment theme, such as
geography. However, there is some evidence of a recent revival of interest in environmental issues
among geographers. The literature on ecosystem stability reveals  a number of areas in which the
knowledge and techniques of geographers could be particularly important. The current review places
some emphasis on the role of spatial organization and abiotic aspects of ecosystems in relation to
stability in the hope that geographers may be encouraged to  contribute more actively to these and
other aspects of this important research theme.

202.Hinds, F. 1984. Towards monitoring of long-term trends  in terrestrial ecosystems. Environ.
Conserv. 11:11-18.

Ecological monitoring designs have at least three identifiable  difficulties that must be overcome If the
design is to be successful:
                                              63

-------
1. The major ecological difficulty is in selecting and quantifying specific biotic conditions or activities
       within the continuous spatial and temporal flux that characterizes life.
2. The major statistical difficulty is specifying appropriate replication-standards in a world that is full of
       unique places.
3. The major difficulty with monitoring in general is that it is expensive.

This tripartite requirement for ecologically relevant, statistically credible, and cost-effective monitoring
methods is very stringent, and failure to meet one or more of these requisites is at the root of many
problems in ecological monitoring. A particularly clear example surfaced in the Organization for
Economic Cooperation and Development (OECD) monitoring programs, where a reviewer remarked
that none of the national  programs seemed to have had statistical analysis  in mind.

In this paper, some important ecological and statistical considerations are outlined. These suggestions
are the result of several years  of research aimed at developing cost-effective methods that are in
principle capable of detecting slowly paced ecological change.

203.Hlrvonen, H. 1992. The development of regional scale ecological indicators: A Canadian
Approach. Pages  901-916.  In:  D. McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds.  Ecological Indicators.
Proceedings of the International Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL,  16-19
October  1990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

This paper briefly describes the background to the instigation of national-scale ecological indicators in
Canada and puts  these into context with local to continental planning scales.  Discussion then  focuses
on the need for and development of a national-scale ecological framework within which ecological
indicators can be  presented and communicated to the intended audience.

The federal government,  through a major review of its environmental agenda (The Green Plan), is
forging a strategy to move Canada toward sustainable development by integrating environmental
considerations into decision making.  In addition, Canada has embarked  on two major initiatives aimed
at informing the public of the current state and trend of the health of the country's environment: the
production  of a national State of the Environment Report every 5 years and a National Environmental
Indicators Project useful for planning for major resource sectors as well as  general communication.
The development of broad national-scale ecological indicators is pivotal to all these activities.

National- and large-scale regional planning are discussed in terms of regional environmental problems
rather than from a local or global environmental perspective. Stress, exposure, and response indicators
are put in the context of the spatial ecological framework of the 15 ecozones that comprise Canada.
Rationale for the use of ecozones is given. The qualitative procedure used to roll up ecozone-level
indicators from more-detailed data bases is illustrated. Discussion centers on desired characteristics of
these indicators.  An argument is presented that perhaps adherence to statistically valid indicators at
these general levels is not prudent.

The position presented is that  the primary function of broad scale indicators is to communicate, at a
general level, the health of the nation's major ecological zones. These indicators do not direct or
assess ecological research; they may serve to measure the relative success or failure of policy and
program initiatives.  In most instances,  their scientific credibility is based  on derivation from more-
detailed data bases. Thus, caveats associated with collation and synthesis are vital.

Emphasis is placed on the  need to determine the "critical level of communication" of regional-  and
national-scale indicators.  If environmental science cannot be communicated with clarity to an informed
public the value of that science should  be questioned.

204.Hodson, P.V. 1990.  Indicators of ecosystem health at the species level and the example of
selenium effects on fish.  Environ.  Monitor. Assess.  15:241-254.

Chemical monitoring of aquatic ecosystems describes the chemical exposures of aquatic biota and
measures the success of pollution control.  However, meeting water quality criteria cannot ensure that
                                               64

-------
aquatic biota are protected from the effects of unexpected chemicals, mixtures, and interactions
between toxicity and environmental stressors.

Biological monitoring is an obvious solution because aquatic biota integrate spatial and temporal
variations in exposure to many simultaneous stressors.  Top predators, typical of specific ecosystems
(e.g., lake trout in cold-water oligotrophic lakes) indicate whether environmental criteria have been met.
The presence of naturally reproducing, self-sustaining, and productive stocks of edible fish
demonstrates a high-quality environment.  If these conditions are not met, there is a clear sign of
environmental degradation.  Specific changes in population structure and performance may also
diagnose which life stage is affected and the nature of the stressor.

Unfortunately, environmental managers cannot rely solely on  populations, communities,  or ecosystems
to indicate chemical effects. The lag between identifying a problem and finding a cause may destroy
the resource that we wish to protect, particularly where chemicals are persistent.

A solution to this dilemma is the measurement of primary or secondary responses of individual
organisms to chemical exposure.  Because toxicity at any level of organization must start with a
reaction between a chemical and a biological substrate, these responses are the  most sensitive and
earliest sign of chemical exposure and effect.

Application of this idea requires research on molecular mechanisms of chemical toxicity in aquatic biota
and adaptation of existing mammalian diagnostic tools.  Because relevance of biochemical responses
to populations and ecosystems is not obvious, there  is a need to study the links between chemical
exposure and responses of individuals, populations, and  ecosystems.

The recognition of  chemical problems and  cause-effect relationships requires the  integration of chemical
and biological monitoring, using the principles of epidemiology to test the strength of relationships and
to identify specific research needs.  The  contamination of a reservoir with selenium and the resulting
impacts on fish populations provide an excellent example of this approach.

205.Hoffman, R. 1992. Technological barriers: A commentary. Environ. Monit. Assess. 20:185-187.

This note is an attempt to establish a framework for linking the technologies of measurement and the
technologies for representing an understanding of human/environment systems and making the
understanding accessible to stakeholders in environmental issues.  The author describes a systems
model and discusses system indicators which are observations of the state of the system. The author
also stresses that the systems model plays a crucial  role in providing the linkage  between observations
of state variables (indicators) and the understanding  needed for effective interpretation of the
observations.  The systems model serves to define a set of state of the environment indicators.

206.Hofstra, J.J., and L. Van Liere. 1992. The state of the environment of the Loosdrecht Lakes.
Hydrobiologia 233:11-20.

The Loosdrecht Lakes are a system of shallow, interconnected peat lakes in the center of The
Netherlands. The main environmental functions of the Loosdrecht lakes are nature and recreation.
From the point of view of Dutch policy, a Specific Environmental Quality should be set for these lakes.
The most serious environmental problem of the area is eutrophication.  The Loosdrecht lakes have, by
increasing external phosphorous loading, undergone  changes, from clear lakes with few macrophytes,
followed by a period of abundant characean growth, to turbid  lakes dominated by cyanobacteria and
detrital matter. Eutrophication was counteracted by use of sewerage systems and dephosphorization of
the supply water.  The resultant decrease in external phosphorus loading did not  result in a decrease in
turbidity caused by suspended particles.

The eutrophication of the lake ecosystems  was described as occurring in phases.  One of those
phases, occurring around 1940, has been used as an ecological reference.  By means of a graphical
presentation technique, the so-called "AMOEBE-approach," the state of the environment of the
Loosdrecht lakes has been  visualized. Thirty-two ecological parameters, including both biotic and
                                              65

-------
abiotic factors, have been selected and quantified.  Concrete target values for these parameters have
been derived from historical reports and from Lake Western Loenderveen, a less eutrophic lake located
close to the Loosdrecht lakes.

The general conclusion is that the state of the environment of the Loosdrecht lakes is far from what is
required with respect to a Specific Environmental Quality, because many of the selected parameters,
such as water transparency, total phosphorous, mineral nitrogen, cyanobacteria, bream, pike,
macrophytes, birds, and otter, deviate by over an order of magnitude from their desired levels.

Key Words: Eutrophication, Loosdrecht Lakes, Amoebe-approach,  Water quality, Ecological assessment

207.Holling, C. 1973. Resilience and stability of ecological systems. Annu. Rev. Ecol. Syst. 4:1-24.

The purpose of this review is to explore both ecological theory and the behavior of natural systems to
see if various perspectives of behavior can yield various insights useful for both theory and practice.

208.Holling, C., ed. 1978. Adaptive Environmental Assessment and Management. Wiley, Chichester,
England.

This book is a report on efforts to develop an adaptive approach to environmental impact assessment
and management.  It is written for policymakers and managers  who are dissatisfied with the traditional
procedures and principles and who seek some effective and realistic alternatives.

The study was initiated by a workshop convened in early 1974  by SCOPE (Scientific Committee on
Problems of the Environment). The workshop was attended by individuals with an often bewildering
range of experience,  concerns, and styles—precisely those ingredients that are so useful at the
beginning of an analysis in defining the full range of issues and possibilities. Three particularly relevant
questions emerged:

1. What, if anything, does our understanding of the nature and  behavior of ecological systems have to
        say about the issues, limitations, and potential of environmental assessment?
2. What can be done to bridge the abyss currently separating technical impact assessment studies from
        actual environmental planning and decision making?
3. To  what extent, and under what circumstances, do present methods provide useful predictions of
        impact?

Although the focus of this book is environmental assessment, its central message is that the process
itself should be replaced. It attacks myths of environmental management  and assessment, and
discusses among other topics, development of contemporary assessment  techniques and the issue of
uncertainty.  The book is divided into two parts: (1) the approach and (2) case studies.

209.Holling, C. 1986. The resilience of terrestrial ecosystems: Local surprise and global change.
Pages 292-317. In: W. Clark and R.  Munn, eds. Sustainable Development of the Biosphere. Cambridge
University Press, Cambridge, England.

Adequate explanations of long-term global changes in the biosphere often require an understanding  of
how ecological  systems function and of how they respond to human activities at local levels.  Outlined
in this chapter is one possible approach to the essential task of linking physical, biological, and social
phenomena across a wide range of spatial and temporal scales.  It focuses on the dynamics of
ecological systems, including processes responsible for both increasing organization and for occasional
disruption.  Special attention is given to the prevalence of discontinuous change in ecological systems,
and to its origins in specific nonlinear processes interacting on  multiple time and space scales. This
ecological scale of analysis is linked "upward" to the global scale of biogeochemical relationships and
the "Gaia" hypothesis, and "downward" to the local scale of human activities and institutions.
                                              66

-------
210.Holmberg, T. and S. Karlsson. 1992. On designing socioecological indicators. Pages 89-106. In:
U. Svedin and B.H.  Aniansson, eds. Society and the Environment: A Swedish Research Perspective.
Series: Ecology, Economy, & Environment 2. Kluwer Academic Publishers, Dordrecht, The Netherlands.

There is a need for  indicators which capture the essential parts of society in the maladjustments of its
physical relations to nature.  The socio-ecological indicators should contribute to the control
mechanisms that are urgently needed if society is to be able to redirect itself to a path of development
which is subordinated to sustainable interactions with nature.  An analysis of various factors  important
to the design of socio-ecologic indicators is performed here.  An important aspect of the socio-
ecological indicators is that they will focus on parts situated early in the cause-effect chain. This
implies better possibilities for foresight when dealing with the global, complex or diffuse problems in
connection to sustainability.  The indicators can be useful in many situations: as a support for
discussions among decision  makers and the general public, as part of environmental impact analysis,
and as a tool in evaluation of various plans or projects.

211.Hope,  C., and J.  Parker. 1990. Environmental information for all: The need for a monthly index.
Energy Policy 18(4):312-319.

Society is not well served by existing sources  of environmental information.  Although reasonably
comprehensive, they are not easy to use.  Several recent reports have highlighted the need to devise
new ways of reporting the state of the environment.  This article introduces a monthly Environmental
Index, similar in form to the Retail Price Index, which is designed to compete with economic statistics
for attention in the media.  It gives some suggestions for  the components of the Index, and proposes a
weighting method, as a basis for discussion.

Key Words: Environment, Statistics, Index

212.Hope,  C., J. Parker, and S.  Peake. 1992. A pilot environmental index for the U.K. in the 1980s.
Energy Policy 20(4):335-343.

A pilot environmental index with nine components is constructed for the United Kingdom. Public opinion
poll results are used to assign weights to the components in the overall index.  The index remains
roughly constant for the period 1980 to 1988.  Different sets of opinion poll results produce very similar
index values, suggesting that this may be a feasible weighting method.  Implications for policymaking
are discussed.

213.House, M. 1989. A water quality index for use in the operational management of river water quality
in  Europe. Pages 159-168. In: D. Wheeler, M.  Richardson, and J. Bridges, eds. Watershed 89: The
Future for Water Quality in Europe. [Series: Advances in Water Pollution Control (1989)].

214.House, M. 1990. Water  quality indices as  indicators of ecosystem change. Environ. Monitor.
Assess. 15:255-263.

The operational management of water quality requires a methodology that can provide precise
information on cycles and trends  in water quality objectively and reproducibly.  Such information can be
provided by the adoption of a water quality indexing system.  The continuous scale afforded by a water
quality index (WQI) allows changes in river water quality to be highlighted. At the same time, the
subdivision of this scale into  a series of water  quality and water use categories provides an easy means
of  relating information  to the  government and to the public.  The development of four WQIs is outlined.
These have been applied to  data for a number of river reaches in the United Kingdom. The results of
these applications indicate the utility of these indices in the classification of water quality and the
monitoring of ecosystem change.

215.Hren, J., C. Obllnger-Chlldress, J. Norrls, T. Chaney, and D. Myers.  1990. Regional water
quality: Evaluation of data for assessing conditions and trends. Environ. Sd. Technol. 24(8):1122-1127.
                                              67

-------
Although large amounts of water quality data have been collected, the problems of aggregating them
Into one data base lor broad water quality assessments are unknown. The U.S. Geological Survey in
1984 undertook a study in Colorado and Ohio to determine how well these data could be used to
address such questions as "What are existing water quality conditions?", "How have they changed?",
and "How do these conditions and changes relate to natural and human-induced activities?".

The major finding of this study was that few areas in either state had  adequate  numbers of samples or
sampling sites for the constituents evaluated. This was because the benefits of aggregating data
collected by various agencies were limited because of either the nature (e.g., effluent samples) or
quality of the data with respect to regional assessments.  Furthermore, more data were collected for
gross indicators of water quality  (e.g., dissolved solids) than for constituents specifically related to toxic
contamination (e.g., organic compounds).

216.Huffman, E.  1990. Workgroup issue paper: Indicators and assessment of agricultural sustainability.
Environ. Monitor.  Assess. 15:303-305.

Sustainability is emerging as one of the most fundamental concepts for assessing the overall state of
an agricultural production system.  Essentially, this concept assumes  that if a production system is
sustainable indefinitely, then it is acceptable.  However, almost any system is sustainable if sufficient
resources are committed to itl Thus,  it's obvious that an uncritical adoption of the idea is not
acceptable.

217.Hunsaker, C.T. 1993. In Press. New concepts in environmental monitoring: The question of
indicators.  Sci. Total Environ.

Current environmental issues such as declining biodiversity, sustainability of ecosystems, and global
atmospheric change are manifestations of multiple stresses.  The need to establish baseline ecological
conditions as a reference for assessing future change has grown more acute with the increasing
complexity and scale of environmental issues.  In the United States the Environmental Monitoring and
Assessment Program is an interagency effort to provide a long-term monitoring program to determine
status and trends in ecological resources at regional and national scales.  This  paper discusses the
indicator framework for this monitoring program, the linkage between  indicator selection and successful
assessment, and  the current status of indicator selection.

218.Hunsaker, C.T., and D.E. Carpenter, eds. 1990. Ecological indicators for the Environmental
Monitoring and Assessment Program. EPA/600/3-90/060, Office of Research and Development. U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency, Research Triangle Park, NC.

The purpose of this document is threefold: (1) to inform potential EMAP data users of the approach
proposed to describe ecological condition; (2) to define a strategy for  evaluating, prioritizing, and
selecting indicators that will facilitate coordination and integration among each of six EMAP resource
categories; and (3) to seek expert advice and environmental data sets from the scientific community
that are needed to better characterize the spatial and temporal variability of the proposed indicators  on
a regional scale.

219.Hunsaker, C.T., D.E. Carpenter, and J.J. Messer. 1990. Ecological indicators for regional
monitoring. Bull. Ecol. Soc. Am. 71(3):165-172.

Because we currently lack an integrated approach to monitoring indicators of ecological condition and
exposure to pollutants, we cannot determine whether the frequency and extent  of the  problems are
increasing on a regional scale, whether such patterns are warning indicators of significant long-term
changes in ecosystem structure or function,  or whether they are associated with changes in ambient
pollution levels. The need to establish baseline conditions against which future changes can be
documented with  confidence has grown more acute with the increasing complexity, scale, and social
importance of environmental issues such as acid deposition, global atmospheric change, and declining
biodiversity.  In 1988 the  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Science Advisory Board
recommended that a program be implemented within the EPA to monitor ecological status and trends,
                                               68

-------
 as well as to develop innovative methods for anticipating emerging problems before they reach crisis
 proportions. A recent report from the National Research Council (1990) confirms the need for
 strengthening regional and national monitoring.

 220.Hunsaker, C., R. Graham, G. Suter II,  R. O'Neill, et al. 1989.  Regional ecological risk
 assessment: Theory and demonstration. Environmental Science Division. ORNL Publication No. 3273.
 Oak Ridge National Laboratory, Oak Ridge,  TN.

 221.Hunsaker, C.T., R.L. Graham, and R.V. O'Neill.  1990. Assessing ecological risk on a regional
 scale.  Environ.  Manage. 14(3):325-332.

 Society needs a quantitative and  systematic way to estimate and compare the impacts of environmental
 problems that affect large geographic areas. This paper presents an approach for regional risk
 assessment that combines regional assessment methods and landscape ecology theory with an
 existing framework for ecological  risk assessment.  Risk assessment evaluates the effects of an
 environmental change on a valued natural resource and interprets the significance of those effects in
 light of the uncertainties identified in each component of the assessment process.  Unique and
 important issues for regional risk  assessment are emphasized; these include the definition of the
 disturbance, the assessment boundary definition, and the spatial heterogeneity of the landscape.

 Key Words: Regional risk, Landscape ecology, Impact analysis, Environmental  assessment

 222.Huntley, B.J., E. Ezcurra, E. Fuentes,  K. Fujli, P. Grubb, W. Haber, J. Harger, M. Holland, S.
 Levin, J. Lubchenco, H. Mooney,  V. Nerenov,  I. Noble, H. Pulliam, P. Ramakrishnan, P. Risser, O.
 Sala, J. Sarukhan, and W. Sombroek. 1992.  A sustainable biosphere: The global imperative. Bull.
 Ecol. Soc. Am.  73(1):7-13.

 This commentary addresses research priorities for establishing sustainability. Among the research
 priorities  are areas related to ecological indicators, ecosystem response to stress, and documentation of
 the state of Earth's biotic systems.

 223.Hutchinson, T., and  K. Meema, eds. 1986. Effects of Acid Deposition on  Forests, Wetlands, and
 Agricultural Ecosystems. Proceedings of a workshop. Springer Veriag, New York.

 224.Hutton, M. 1982. The role of wildlife species in the assessment of biological impact from chronic
 exposure to persistent chemicals. Ecotoxicol. Environ.  Saf.  6:471-478.

 Assessments of chemical toxicity have regularly placed reliance on experimental studies that employ
 environmentally unrealistic exposure regimes. This approach ignores the long-term low-level nature of
 environmental exposure that facilitates the development of factors that modify the toxicity of such
 chemicals.  Examples of such  adaptive mechanisms will be taken from the author's own studies.
 Factors discussed include the  development of protective trace element interactions in target organs, the
 induction of specific metal-binding proteins, and the alteration of the distribution of chemicals at the
 organ and organelle levels. Exposure-response investigations in wildlife are not restricted to the
 organism level; the impact of an environmentally  released chemical on breeding success and
 population dynamics can also  be  investigated.  Disadvantages and problems associated with this kind
 of study,  such as multiple pollutant exposure and variability in response, will also be considered.

 225.Hytteborn, H., ed.  1979. The Use of Ecological Variables in Environmental Monitoring. Report PM
 1151. National Swedish Environmental Protection Board, Stockholm.

 226.lnhaber, H. 1974. Environmental quality: Outline for a national index for Canada. Science 186:798-
 805.
 In 1972, a small working group was set up in the Canadian Federal  Department of the Environment to
try to devise an overall environmental  quality index (EQI).  To take account of as many viewpoints as
possible,  more than 50 scientists, engineers, and administrators dealing in environmental matters were
 consulted.  It was decided to express all data in the form of an index, defined as a unitless number that
                                              69

-------
ranged from 0 (best possible environmental condition) to increasing numbers for progressively worse
environmental quality. In this way, several indices could be combined to give an overall picture of
environmental quality. With this index, a value of 1 generally means that (1) an objective (or standard)
is being met, (2) the index is at its highest level according to a particular scale of values, or (3) a
certain environmental condition is equal to a national average. It was  not possible to be consistent with
respect to the criteria throughout the entire EQI because of the wide variety of data and the general
lack of official standards.

227.lnhaber, H. 1976. Environmental Indices. John Wiley  & Sons,  Inc., New York.

This book provides an overview of environmental quality indices and is written in popular style. An
introductory chapter gives an overview on environmental indices that discusses how an index works,
how much is background, and  a national vs an international index.  Other chapters  include: Economic
indices; "What's been done so far?"; Air quality indices; Water indices; Land indices (recreation,
forestry, etc.); Biological indices; Aesthetic indices and; Other environmental indices.

228.lvanovici, A.M., and W. Wiebe. 1981. Towards a working definition of stress: A review and
critique. Pages 13-27. In: G.W. Barrett and R. Rosenberg, eds. Stress Effects on Natural Ecosystems.
John Wiley & Sons, Chichester, England.

The impact of human activity on the natural environment and methods of assessing such impact have
been widely discussed in recent years.  However, the difficulties in assessing impact—especially rapidly
and at sublethal levels—have not been resolved. Despite widespread recognition that an accurate
assessment of detrimental environmental impact or "stress" is difficult without consideration of different
levels  of organization (including ecosystem, physiological, and biochemical responses), much research
has concentrated on ecosystem response alone (e.g., changes in community structure), in  spite of the
need for long periods of time before changes can be detected.  Much  faster response times have been
found at physiological and behavioral levels than at the ecosystem level.  Although  several workers
have shown that responses at the biochemical level are detectable even earlier, many studies of
organisms in perturbed environments have shown that a number of biochemical techniques have not
been as successful as hoped.

This paper reviews and  critiques the concept of stress and also discusses one biochemical variable that
is felt to warrant closer study, the adenylate energy charge (AEC).  The authors examine the potential
application of AEC to impact assessment at organism level within a population and  at the community
group level.

229.lzrael, Y.A., L. Fillpova, G. Insarov, F. Semevsky, and S. Semenov. 1988. Disturbance of
terrestrial ecosystems stability  due to global-scale anthropogenic impacts.  Environ.  Monitor. Assess.
11:239-246.
Intact natural ecosystems are fairly stable objects.  In the  course of natural selection proceeding against
the background of synecological interactions  (trophic, competitive, symbiotic, etc.), a respective complex
of coadapted species forms, each being maximally accommodated to  its habitat. Such a complex is of
specific composition and possesses stable structural characteristics.  Fairly regular  processes of
changes in these characteristics, specific to the given type of environmental conditions, are observed in
non-stationary cases.

The authors analyze probable  causes of the loss of stability in natural systems exposed to human-
made impacts of a global scale, in particular  structural instability, landscape (disruptive) instability, and
conductive instability.

The study of the mechanisms ensuring biosphere sustainability and stability of its elements is a vital
ecological problem. There are applied aspects in the problem solution since identification of human-
induced instability is feasible only on the basis of precise knowledge of the natural mechanisms of weak
points of the relevant natural process. This circumstance  makes the problem of stability one of the
focal questions of applied ecology.
                                               70

-------
230.lzrael, Y.A., and R. Munn. 1986.  Monitoring the environment and renewable resources. Pages
360-375. In: W. Clark and R. Munn, eds. Sustainable Development of the Biosphere. Cambridge
University Press, Cambridge, England.

Reliable knowledge about how the biosphere has actually responded to human actions is a prerequisite
for effective social  responses to environmental problems.  Lack of such knowledge is a major
impediment to the  design of sustainable development strategies.  In this chapter the authors explore
how environmental monitoring systems can be made more useful for the management of long-term
interactions between development and environment. They begin  with a review of objectives for
integrated monitoring of the physical, chemical, and biological components of the biosphere. The
problems of linking local and global scales of observations are discussed, as are issues on the
optimization of monitoring systems. Special attention is devoted to how monitoring systems can be
designed to help address the problems of timely  detection of potentially irreversible trends and the
identification of unexpected environmental impact.

231.lzrael, Y.A., and F.Y. Rovinski. 1988. Integrated background monitoring in the USSR. Environ.
Monitor. Assess. 11 -.225-238.

The whole biosphere of the earth is faced with an increasing anthropogenic pressure. Humankind uses
natural resources for its physical and spiritual demands so widely that undesirable effects appear not
only in separate regions but embrace the whole biosphere  as well. As a rule, such processes develop
slowly.  They have an irreversible character and to avoid them, preventive decisions are  needed. For
that purpose, comprehensive and systematic information on the state of the biosphere is needed.

The integrated background monitoring system has been implemented and is in operation in the USSR.
Structurally, the integrated background monitoring system is divided into three groups: background
stations on land; background stations on fresh water and; background stations on inland  and periphery
seas.

All of the data received from these stations are analyzed and correlated at the Natural Environment and
Climate Monitoring Laboratory of the USSR State Committee for Hydrometeorology and Control of the
Natural  Environment, the USSR Academy of Sciences, and in other scientific institutes of the State
Committee. The information serves for the assessment of the state of the environment, prediction of
anthropogenic effects, and for evaluation of the measures taken to prevent pollution of the biosphere at
national and international levels.

The information is shared in a wide international exchange within  the framework of several international
organizations (UNEP, WMO,  UNES, ECE, CMEA, and others) and of the bilateral agreements  on
cooperation in the field of environmental protection (USA, France, Sweden, FRG, CMEA  Member
Countries).

232.Jacobs, J. 1975. Diversity, stability and maturity in ecosystems influenced by human activities.
Pages 187-207. In: W. van Dobben and R.  Lowe-McConnell, eds. Unifying Concepts in Ecology. Dr. W.
Junk B.V.  Publishers, The Hague, The Netherlands.

In discussions of the human impact on ecosystems, it is usually argued that man interferes with mature
equilibrated situations, thereby  reducing diversity and destroying inherent mechanisms of stability.  In
this argument, it is  tacitly assumed that (1) the majority of ecosystems are  undisturbed and more or
less mature prior to human intervention, (2) mature systems are more complex and stable than
immature systems, and (3) humans act as an external, unnatural force on natural ecosystems. The
author attempts to  show that these implications are not necessarily correct or at least are very  one-
sided.  Selected evidence is presented that human impact affects diversity, stability, maturity, and
organization in all possible directions and quantities and that humans, though unique, are to be
regarded as an integrated, natural component of ecosystems if their role is to be fully understood.

The article  includes a subsection on major effects of man in ecosystems in which effects  are divided
into four categories: 1) transient perturbations, (2) chronic shifts of environmental conditions, (3) energy
                                              71

-------
and nutrient relations, and (4) manipulation of species. Regarding chronic changes, the author points
out that no general statement is possible regarding how such chronic human-made developments
influence diversity, stability, etc. The author then gives examples of the effects of chronic pollution by a
small city on stream benthic organisms and the study of bird fauna along  a city-to-country gradient.

233.Janlkowski, R. 1991. Method for evaluating noneconomic effects of air pollution. Environ. Monitor.
Assess. 16(2):151-161.

The basic premise underlying the approach presented in the paper is the  assumption that humans are
unique beings that can evaluate. The environment is described as a system of resources satisfying
human needs. The assessment of the effects of environmental pollution derives from the fact that there
is, or will be, non-satisfaction of needs resulting from a reduction in environmental resources.

234.Jassby, A.D., and T.M. Powell. 1990. Detecting changes in ecological time series. Ecology
71:2044-2052.

Some practical techniques are discussed for  analyzing time series whose statistical properties change
with time.  The authors consider how principal component analysis can reduce the multidimensional
nature  of certain series and, in particular, apply this technique to the analysis of changing seasonal
patterns.  Discussions of trends, changes in oscillatory behavior, and "unusual" events follow. The
problem of making inferences regarding causation is briefly considered. A call for flexibility in approach
concludes the article.

235.Jeffrey, D. 1990. Biomonitoring of catastrophes. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 14:131-137.

The time seems appropriate to try to couple the technical literature, attitudes, and behavior associated
with large scale potential accidents with what we  now know of bioindicator systems. Some good case
histories exist, for example, with respect to oil pollution events and unplanned releases of radioactivity.
In other situations, there is work to be done,  much of which should be commissioned by industry or
government.

236.Jeffrey, D., and B. Madden.  1991. Bioindicators and Environmental  Management. Academic
Press,  San Diego, CA.

This book is a compilation of conference papers.   Major topics covered in the book are: bioindicators,
industry, and administration; biomonitoring  of the  Chernobyl accident; monitoring long-term/large-scale
environmental trends; and basic research problems.

237.Jennings, M.D., and J.P. Reganold. 1991. A theoretical basis for managing  environmentally
sensitive areas. Environ. Conserv.  18(3):211-218.

A three-step approach of different geographical scales (i.e. watershed, state, and  region) was used in a
series  of studies to facilitate examination of the relationship between political structure and ecological
theory. When viewed collectively, these studies showed that, although there is a  political basis for
regulating sensitive areas, attempts at regulation  lack a theoretical and applied basis in "systems-
thinking" and ecological science. To begin forging a stronger link between political and scientific bases
for environmentally sensitive are (ESA) planning, two major ecological theories relevant to sensitive
area management—hierarchy and subsidy/stress—were reviewed. These theories, when used in
concert, were shown to be applicable in making objective choices concerning privately held ESAs  in the
Pacific Northwest. They can be used as a theoretical scientific basis for  ESA planning, providing both
qualitative and quantitative models. Hierarchy theory can provide guidelines for ESA planning by
linking biophysical processes and patterns  directly to appropriate scales of political jurisdiction.
Subsidy-stress theory can be used to set specific  performance standards that are needed in regulation
of sensitive areas.

238.Jernelov, A., and R. Rosenberg. 1976. Stress tolerance of ecosystems. Environ. Conserv. 3:43-
46.
                                               72

-------
Ecosystem sensitivity to stress is one of many questions that are of fundamental importance when
predicting ecosystem response through the use of analogy.  It is also a question of leading importance
in fundamental ecological considerations. The authors raise it here because scientists disagree about
the answer, and because this disagreement discloses a basic lack  of understanding that must be
overcome.

Following the concept of stability, together with the assertion that species living under extreme
conditions are already subject to severe stress and consequently are more vulnerable to additional
stress factors, it is frequently argued that, for example, the Baltic must be regarded as more susceptible
than, for example, the North Sea, and thus requires stricter rules for protection.  This argument is partly
based on the idea that a system with high stability is less sensitive to additional stress than an unstable
system.  By examining the logic and content of the word stability and using examples from different
ecosystems, the authors put forward conclusions that are drawn from their experience with regard to
stress tolerance of ecosystems.

239.Johnson, A.R. 1988. Evaluating ecosystem response to toxicant stress: A state space approach.
Pages 275-285.  In: Aquatic Toxicology and Hazard Assessment: 10th Volume. ASTPM STP 971.
American Society for Testing and Materials, Philadelphia.

Ecosystems can be regarded as complex biogeochemical systems  maintained in a state of
thermodynamic nonequilibrium by the flow of materials and energy. The state of such a system at any
given time is generally assumed to be characterized  by a finite set  of measurable quantities.  If these
variables are taken to be the components of a vector, the instantaneous state of an ecosystem can be
represented by a single point in an abstract multidimensional space. As an  ecosystem undergoes
changes in state, changes in the position of the corresponding vector will result, tracing out a state
trajectory over time.

Within a state space representation, the response  of an ecosystem to a perturbing influence,  such as a
toxicant, can be viewed as a displacement of the state vector away from its  unperturbed trajectory.
Such an approach was used to analyze data from  a study of the response of experimental ponds and
microcosms to chronic additions of a coal-derived synthetic oil.  Ecosystem-level response surfaces and
dose-response curves were derived based upon the average separation  (distance of displacement) of
exposed ecosystems relative to controls.  The results exhibited patterns analogous to those observed in
classical toxicology based on organismal response and could be used to define acceptable exposure
conditions. The state space approach described here provides a coherent and objective framework for
summarizing a large multivariate data set and should be of general use in providing both qualitative
and quantitative  descriptions of the behavior of perturbed ecosystems.

Key Words: State space analysis,  Ecotoxicology, Microcosms, Ponds, Synthetic oil

240.Johnson, A.R. 1988. Diagnostic variables as predictors of ecological risk. Environ.  Manage.
12(4):515-523.

The state of an ecosystem may be represented by a multidimensional state  record, x.  The goal  of
ecosystem management is to ensure that the ecosystem remains within some set of X of acceptable
states, such that x is a part of X. Because ecosystem management decisions must be based on limited
knowledge, a small number of diagnostic variables must be found that accurately reflect ecosystem
state. If the vector of diagnostic variables w is found to be within a specified set, the state vector x is
predicted to be within X. The selection  and use of such diagnostic variables is examined in the context
of an aquatic ecosystem simulation model. Techniques used in searching for diagnostic criteria include
multiple linear regression, discriminant analysis, and  visual inspection of graphical data displays.  The
adequacy of a diagnostic criterion as a predictor of ecological risk is demonstrated to be a function of
the associated rates of type I and type II statistical errors.  A simple cost-benefit analysis  is undertaken
to illustrate one approach for choosing an optimal balance between these error rates.

Key Words: Diagnostic variables, Risk, Error rates, Cost-benefit, Multiple regression, Discriminant
analysis
                                              73

-------
241.Johnson, M.L., D.G. Muggins, and F. DeNoyelles, Jr. 1991. Ecosystem modeling with LISREL: A
new approach for measuring direct and indirect effects. Ecol. Appl. 1(4):383-398.

Evaluating the effects of toxicants in ecosystems is difficult despite numerous attempts to develop field
and laboratory tests.  The problem appears to be lack of an analytical methodology capable of taking
advantage of the available experimental designs. Therefore, the authors propose a technique for
modeling ecosystems-linear structural modeling with LISREL.  LISREL is a path analytical technique
that is more flexible than classical path analysis.  Modeling with LISREL involves placing ecosystem
structure and function into a framework of concepts and indicator variables.  Concepts are theoretical
constructs that are  placed into a cause-and-effect network to reflect true ecosystem structure.
Concepts are "indicated" by indicator variables; these are the measured variables in the ecosystem.
LISREL incorporates measurement  error into the modeling process by establishing a portion of the
variance of each indicator variable as measurement error.  The framework of concepts and indicators in
a cause-and-effect  network becomes a hypothesis that is tested using LISREL.  LISREL also provides
a determination of the total, direct, and indirect effects of the variables on each other.  A measure of
ecosystem stability is provided as part of the modeling process.

Key Words:  Causal processes, Disturbance, Ecosystem, Ecotoxicology,  LISREL, Modeling, Path
analysis

242.Jones, K. 1990. The Environmental Monitoring Program—An ecological monitoring program for the
1990's and beyond. Pages 669-681. In: GIS/LIS 90 -  Technical Papers.  Geographic Information
Systems/Land Information Systems  Annual Conference, November 5-10, Anaheim,  CA. American
Congress on Surveying and Mapping, Falls Church, VA.

Over the past several years we have become increasingly concerned about the condition of the
environment. However,  recently the focus in concern has shifted from local scales (e.g., condition in
individual wetlands) to regional, continental, and global scales (e.g. global climate change), and from
individual resources (e.g., timber) to a more holistic ecological approach. Although  data are available
that allow for local  (e.g. effluent compliance by an individual factory)  and gross, large scale (e.g. global
circulation and climate models) assessments, data necessary to make regional scale assessments are
generally lacking. This results from deployment of sampling designs that optimize assessments at
these scales.  Of those monitoring projects designed  to make assessments at regional scales, the focus
has been on answering questions about specific resources (e.g. timber production in forests); none
have a holistic ecological approach.  The Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP),
a program being coordinated by the Environmental Protection Agency, but developed by a number of
Federal agencies, institutes, and universities, will focus on regional and  national scale assessment of
ecological resources over periods of years to decades.

243.Jorgensen, S.E. 1992. Ecological indicators and ecosystem modelling. Pages 201-211. In: D.
McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the International
Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL,  16-19  October 1990. Elsevier, Essex,
England.

Useful models are  currently available in the field of environmental management.  However, up to now, it
has not been possible to develop models to cope with the problem of changes in species composition.
A few examples of how important species composition is as ecological indicators are given as a basis
for the modeling effort.

Results of a recently developed modeling  approach that is able to make predictions on species
composition, are presented and four case studies (i.e., four different  lakes where this approach has
been used) are presented.  However, the application  of the approach may be applied more generally.

244.Karlen, D., N.  Eash, and P. Linger. 1992. Soil and crop management effects on soil quality
indicators. Am. J. Altern. Agric. 7(1-2):48-55.
                                              74

-------
People are becoming more aware that our soil resources are as vulnerable to degradation as air or
water, but criteria are needed to learn how soil quality is changing. The objectives in this review are:
(1) to illustrate that interactions between human and natural factors determine soil quality, (2) to identify
indicators that can be used to evaluate human-induced effects on soil quality; and (3) to suggest soil
and crop management strategies that will sustain or improve soil quality.  The physical, chemical, and
biological processes and interactions within the soil are critical factors affecting all indicators of soil
quality. The biological processes are especially important because they provide much of the resiliency
or buffering  capacity to ameliorate stress.

Key Words: Soil tilth, Conservation tillage, Cover crops, Crop rotations

245.Karr, J.R. 1981. Assessment of biotic integrity using  fish communities.  Fisheries 6(6):21-27.

Human activities have had profound, and usually negative, influences on freshwater fishes from the
smallest streams to the largest  rivers. To assess negative effects of  human activities on fishes, some
studies have attempted to use water quality as a surrogate for a more comprehensive biotic
assessment. A more refined biotic assessment program is required for effective protection of
freshwater fish resources. The assessment system proposed here uses a series of fish community
attributes related to species composition and ecological structure to evaluate the quality of an aquatic
biota.  In preliminary trials this system accurately reflected the status  of fish communities and the
environment supporting them.

246.Karr, J.R. 1987. Biological monitoring and environmental assessment: A conceptual framework.
Environ. Manage. 11:249-256.

Direct biological  monitoring is essential for effective environmental assessment.  Past approaches to
biomonitoring are too simplistic (e.g., toxicity testing and indicator species) or conceptually invalid
(diversity indexes), whereas assessments that use  ecological guilds integrate ecological principles to a
greater extent.  The  best long-term approach  is development of suites of metrics, like those used in the
index of biotic integrity (IBI), to  reflect individual, population, community, and ecosystem attributes in an
integrative framework.  Efforts to use the conceptual content of IBI in  a wider diversity of habitats
should be encouraged and followed up with effective control  action.

Key Words:  Biological monitoring, Biotic integrity, Bird communities, Environmental assessments, Fish
communities, Guilds, Indicator species, Water resources

247.Karr, J.R. 1991. Biological  integrity—A long-neglected aspect of  water resource management.
Ecol.  Appl. 1(1):66-84.

Water of sufficient quality and quantity is critical to  all life.  Increasing human population and growth of
technology require human society to devote more and more attention to protection of adequate supplies
of water. Although perception of biological degradation stimulated current state and federal legislation
on the quality of water resources, that biological focus was lost in the search for easily measured
physical and chemical surrogates.  The "feasible and swimmable" goal of the Water Pollution Control
Act of 1972  (PL 92-500) and its charge to "restore  and maintain" biotic integrity illustrate that law's
biological underpinning.  Further, the need for operational definitions of terms like "biological integrity"
and "unreasonable degradation" and for ecologically sound tools to measure divergence from societal
goals has increased  interest in  biological monitoring.  Assessment of  water resource quality  by
sampling biological communities in the field (ambient biological monitoring) is a promising  approach that
requires use of ecological expertise.  One such approach, the Index of Biotic Integrity (IBI), provides a
broadly based multiparameter tool for the assessment of biotic integrity in running waters.   IBI based on
fish community attributes has now been applied widely in North America.  The success of IBI has
stimulated the development of similar approaches using other aquatic taxa.  Expanded use of
ecological expertise in ambient  biological monitoring is essential to the protection of water resources.
Ecologists have the expertise to contribute significantly to those programs.
                                               75

-------
Key Words: Biological integrity, Biological monitoring, Fish community,  Index of Biotic Integrity (IBI),
Indexes of degradation, Indicators, Water pollution, Water resources

248.Kay, D. 1990. Book review: Environmental monitoring assessment and management—The agenda
for long-term research and development. J. Rural Stud. 6(4):450-451.

This is a positive review for a book that points to some of the pitfalls of past monitoring programs. The
reviewer agrees with most of the problems that the book identifies and supports the author's notion of
where future research should be headed, such as synergistic effects of toxins and effects of pollutants
on non-target species.

249.Kay, J.J. 1991 a. A nonequilibrium thermodynamic framework for discussing ecosystem integrity.
Environ. Manage. 15(4):483-495.

During the last 20 years, our understanding of the development of complex systems has changed
significantly. Two major advancements are catastrophe theory and nonequilibrium thermodynamics
with its associated theory of self-organization. These theories indicate that complex system
development is nonlinear, discontinuous (catastrophes), not predictable (bifurcations), and multivalued
(multiple development pathways).  Ecosystem development should be expected to exhibit these
characteristics.

Traditional ecological theory has attempted to describe ecosystem stress response by using some
simple notions such as stability and resiliency. In fact stress-response must be characterized by a
richer set of concepts.  The ability of the system  to maintain its current operating point in the face of the
stress must be ascertained.  11 the system changes operating points, there are several questions to be
considered: Is the change along the original  developmental  pathway or a new one? Is the change
organizing or disorganizing? Will the system return to its original state?  Will the system flip to some
new state in a catastrophic way?  Is the change  acceptable to humans?

The integrity of an ecosystem does not reflect a single characteristic of an ecosystem.  The concept of
integrity must be seen as multidimensional and encompassing a rich set  of ecosystem behaviors. A
framework of concepts for discussing integrity is  presented  in this article.

Key Words: Integrity, Stress-response, Nonequilibrium, Stability, Thermodynamics

250.Kay, J.J. 1991b. The concept of ecological integrity, alternative theories of ecology, and
implications for decision-support indicators.  Pages 23-58. In: P. Victor, J. Kay, and  H. Ruitenbeek.
Economic, Ecological, and Decision Theories: Indicators of  Ecologically Sustainable Development.
Canadian Environmental Advisory Council, Environment Canada, Ottawa.

The subject of this paper is indicators of ecological sustainability. To discuss this subject, an
appreciation of the state of ecology is required.   Ecology as a science  is  at a formative stage, in much
the same state as physics at the time of Galileo.  We  await the insight of a Newton.  There is little
consensus in theoretical ecology about what the important characteristics of ecosystems are. In spite
of this, there is the beginning of an empirical understanding of the effects of environmental change on
ecosystem development and hence sustainability. This paper will explore some recent advances in our
understanding of the development of complex systems, their implications for our understanding  of how
ecosystems develop, a framework for discussing ecosystem integrity, and current theories related to
integrity and the measures they suggest. A basic premise of this discussion is that if economic
development is to be sustainable then  it should enhance the integrity of ecosystems, or at the very
least not erode ecosystem integrity.

251.Kay, J.J. 1992. Thermodynamics and measures of ecological integrity. Pages 159-182. In:  D.
McKenzie,  D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the International
Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in  Fort Lauderdale, FL, 16-19,  October 1990. Elsevier, Essex,
England.
                                               76

-------
 Integrity of an ecosystem refers to its ability to maintain its organization.  Measures of integrity should
 reflect the organizational state of an ecosystem. Ecosystem organization has two distinct aspects,
 functional and structural. Function refers to the overall activities of the ecosystem. Structure refers to
 the interconnection between the components of the system.  Measures of both these aspects of
 organization will be presented in this paper.

 Recent work suggests that self-organization in biological systems is necessitated by the second law of
 thermodynamics. Thus, organization tends to increase ecosystem degradation of energy.  Measures of
 ecosystem organization should,  therefore, reflect energy usage and degradation in ecosystems.
 Measures of energy utilization in the ecosystem food web and by the ecosystem will be presented.

 Measures of function would indicate the amount of energy being captured by the system and the way in
 which it is being degraded (for example respiration vs evapotranspiration).  Measures of structure would
 indicate the way in which energy is moving through the system. For example, measures of the amount
 of recycling in the system, the effective trophic levels of species, and the average specialization of the
 resource niche all reveal something about how energy is being used in the ecosystem.

 Examples of the application of these measures to the development of ecosystems and the examination
 of stress effects will be presented.  How these measurements can be used to assess ecosystem
 integrity will be discussed.

 252.Keddy, C., and T. McCrae. 1989. Environmental databases for state of the environment reporting:
 Conservation and protection headquarters. Report No. 9, Strategies and Scientific Methods, SOE
 Reporting Branch. Canadian Wildlife Services, Environment Canada, Ottawa.

 253.Keddy, P.A. 1991. Biological monitoring and ecological prediction: From nature reserve
 management to national state of the environment indicators.  Pages 249-267. In: B. Goldsmith, ed.
 Monitoring for Conservation and Ecology.  Chapman and Hall, London.

 The techniques for biological monitoring are well-developed,  as shown by examples in the preceding
 chapters.  This chapter will explore two further issues: first, How do we decide what to  measure? and,
 second, What do we do with the data once it is collected? By examining these questions, we may
 make modifications to our biological  monitoring programs and growing computer data bases.  The
 issues addressed are the following.

 1.  The selection of the state variables to be monitored. With more than a million species on the planet,
 we cannot possibly monitor  each one.  Moreover, given predictions that a quarter of these species may
 be extinct by the end of the next century, we cannot possibly monitor even the threatened  ones.  How
 do we choose what to monitor?  The author suggests that a greater emphasis be placed on macro-
 scale state variables.

 2.  The interaction between monitoring and decision-making. Monitoring is by its very nature post hoc
 (i.e., it can only tell us what has already happened).  However,  to wisely manage the biosphere, we
 need to predict future events. What is the relationship between biological monitoring, prediction, and
 decision making?

 254.Kelly, J.R., and M.A. Harwell. 1989.  Indicators of ecosystem response and recovery. Pages 9-39.
 In: S. Levin, M. Harwell, J. Kelly, and K. Kimball, eds. Ecotoxicology:  Problems and Approaches.
 Springer-Verlag, New York.  547 pp.

The authors focus on the fundamental  issue of how to characterize an ecosystem's response to
disturbance and its subsequent recovery when the stress is removed. Thus, the role of this chapter is
 partially introductory for the  book as a whole. It presents the basic aspects on which the body of an
adequate ecological risk assessment would rest for any given ecological disturbance.  Initially, principal
characterization of ecosystem exposure, response, and recovery are discussed in depth; the scope of
characterization examined here contrasts with that actually conducted for ecosystem and/or stress-
specific problems addressed in succeeding book chapters. The reality is that characterization of these
                                              77

-------
elementary aspects rarely has been achieved to a desired level for a risk assessment.  Yet, critically,
the three basic concerns — exposure, response, and recovery — fundamentally affect the choice of
parameters and methods to measure  ecological change.  From these considerations, the final focus is
on the qualities of indicators of ecological effects from anthropogenic and chemical stress.

255.Kelly, J.R., and M.A. Harwell. 1990. Indicators of ecosystem recovery. Environ. Manage.
14(5):527-545.
Assessment of ecological changes relative to disturbance, either  natural or human-induced, confronts a
fundamental problem.  Ecosystems are complex, variable, and diverse; consequently, the need for
simplification to essential features that would characterize ecosystems adequately is generally
acknowledged. Yet there is no firm prescription of what to measure to describe the response and
recovery of ecosystems to stress. Initial focus is provided by identifying relevant ecological endpoints
(i.e., ecological changes of particular relevance to humans).  Furthermore, the authors suggest generic
purposes and criteria to be considered in making  choices of ecological indicators that relate to those
endpoints.  Suites of indicators, with a variety of purposes, are required to assess response and
recovery of most ecosystems and most stresses.  The authors suggest that measures of certain
ecosystem processes may provide special insight on the early stages of recovery; the use of functional
indicators to complement other biotic  indicators is highlighted  in an extended example for lotic
ecosystems.

Key Words: Ecological indicators, Stress, Scale, Recovery, Ecosystem processes

256.Kelly, J., T.  Duke, M. Harwell, and  C. Harwell. 1987. An ecosystem perspective on potential
impacts of drilling fluid discharges on  seagrasses. Environ. Manage. 11(4):537-562.

Potential effects of oil drilling fluid discharges on Thalassia seagrass ecosystems were examined using
seagrass core microcosms. Observed experimental effects, summarized in this article, included
changes in both autotrophic (Thalassia and epiphyte) and heterotrophic (dominant benthic
macroinvertebrates) species and the processes of primary productivity and decomposition.  The
physical  disturbance related to greater turbidity and sedimentation caused some effects; other effects
seemed to be  a direct response to the toxic constituents of drilling fluids.  Using these experimental
results and the case of Thalassia and drilling fluids as a case study, the authors explore  general
methodological and philosophical issues  for ecotoxicology and, furthermore, focus on the challenge of
providing a scientific basis for judging acceptability of environmental changes likely to ensue from
human activities.

Key Words: Seagrass, Drilling fluids,  Ecotoxicology, Risk assessment

257.Keough, M., and G. Quinn. 1991. Causality  and the choice of measurements for detecting human
impacts in marine environments. Aust. J. Mar. Freshwater Res. 42(5):539-554.

The choice of  biological indicator variables to be measured in detecting human impacts on the
environment is a critical one.  The usual  community-level measures (species richness and diversity)
generally have questionable theoretical justification, have no demonstrable causal links to the impact,
and are dependent on the taxonomic expertise available.  Results from trampling experiments  on an
intertidal rocky shore demonstrate that these measures  are also  insensitive in detecting impacts that
clearly affect populations of individual species. The need for experimental work that identifies which
indicator variables are causally linked to  human impacts and, therefore, which will be useful in
monitoring is emphasized.

258.Kerekes,  J.J. 1992. Aquatic research and long-term monitoring in Atlantic Canada's national
parks. Pages 411-416. In: J. Willison, S.  Bondrup-Nieslen, C. Drysdale, T. Herman, N. Munro, and T.
Pollock,  eds. Science and the Management of Protected Areas. Elsevier, Amsterdam.

Relatively pristine waters resources, protected from direct human influence within national parks offer a
unique opportunity for scientific research. One type of research  is the comparison of limnological data
obtained in a large number of waterbodies.  Such measurement  may explain cause and  effect
                                               78

-------
relationships concerning the condition of these waters.  Another approach is the continuous monitoring
of selected waterbodies that describes "average" conditions, annual and temporal variations of physical,
chemical and biological features allowing the detection of long-term changes.  Both strategies have
been used by the Canadian Wildlife Service in National Parks in the Atlantic Region.

259.Kerr, A. 1990. Canada's National Environmental Indicators Project: Background Report.
Environment Canada, Sustainable Development and State of the Environment Reporting Branch,
Ottawa, Ontario.

260.Kerr, S., and L. Dickie. 1984. Measuring the health of aquatic ecosystems. Pages 279-284. In: V.
Cairns, J. Nriagu, and P. Hodson, eds. Contaminant Effects on Fisheries. John Wiley & Sons, Inc., New
York.

The authors deal with the feasibility of assessing ecological health at the community level of biological
organization. In particular, they demonstrate that a theoretical basis exists to support the possibility of
deriving useful indices of community health and that both theoretical and empirical support exists for the
criterion chosen.

261.Kickert, R., and P.Miller. 1979. Responses of ecological systems. Pages 1-45. In: W. Heck, S.
Krupa, and S. Linzon, eds. Handbook for the Assessment of Air Pollution Effects on Vegetation. Air
Pollution Control Association (APCA), Pittsburgh, PA.

262.Kimball, K., and S. Levin. 1985. Limitations of laboratory bioassays: The need for ecosystem level
testing. Bioscience 35(3):165-171.

Laboratory bioassays provide a first step in testing for chemical effects on ecosystems but are
inadequate for predicting effects on natural populations and on ecosystem-level features.  For these
purposes we need microcosm studies,  controlled experimental manipulations of whole ecosystems, and
a sound theoretical basis for extrapolation.

263.Kimmins, J. 1990. Interpreting the long-term significance of short-term environmental monitoring
data — The need for ecosystem management models like Forcyte and Forecast. Pages 1063-1071. In:
H. Lund and G. Preto, eds.  Global Natural Resource Monitoring  and Assessments: Preparing for the
21st Century. American Society for Photogrammetry and Remote Sensing, Bethesda, MD.

Short term monitoring and assessment data provide a "snapshot" of ecosystem condition. For many
aquatic ecosystems,  in which "natural"  directional change is normally slow, a series of such "snapshots"
can provide an ecologically  meaningful measure of anthropogenically-induced change.  In contrast,
most forest ecosystems are changing more or less continuously as they recover from some earlier
disturbance. Monitoring of forests should therefore be based on comparisons between the temporal
patterns of expected ecosystem change, and the actual condition as revealed by monitoring.

Patterns of expected change can be inferred from long-term monitoring data, if appropriate data exist.
In the absence of such empirical evidence, ecosystem-level models can be used to simulate these
"temporal fingerprints" of recovery from disturbance. Because most forest ecosystems are subject to
both anthropogenic and natural disturbances, such models should simulate the impacts of both forest
management and a variety of natural perturbations.  The FORCYTE (FORest Nutrient Cycling and Yield
Trend ^valuator) model can simulate such "temporal fingerprints" associated with a wide variety,
frequency, and intensity of management disturbance factors.  A new model, FORECAST (FORestry and
Environmental Change ASsessmenT), will, in addition, simulate the effects of acid rain, climate change,
and physical damage to soils.

264.Klmmins, J. 1990. Monitoring the condition of the Canadian forest environment: The relevance of
the concept of "ecological indicators." Environ. Monitor.  Assess.  15:231-240.

The Canadian forest environment is characterized by high spatial and temporal variability, especially in
the west.  Our forests vary according to climate, landform, and surficial geology and according to type
                                              79

-------
of, Intensity of, extent of, and the time since the last disturbance.  Most Canadian forests have had a
history of repeated acute, episodic disturbance from fire, insects, wind, diseases, and/or logging, with a
frequency of disturbance varying from a few decades to many centuries.  These sources of variability
have resulted in a complex and continually changing mosaic of forest conditions and stages of
successional development.

Monitoring the "quality" of this dynamic forested landscape mosaic is extremely difficult, and in most
cases the concept of a relatively simple index of forest ecosystem quality or condition (i.e., an
"ecological indicator") is probably inappropriate.  Such ecological indicators are better suited for
monitoring chronic anthropogenically  induced disturbances that have continuous effect (e.g., acid rain,
heavy metal pollution, air pollution, and the greenhouse effect) in ecosystems that, in the absence of
such chronic disturbance, exhibit very slow directional change (e.g., lakes, higher-order streams, and
rivers).

Monitoring the effects of a chronic anthropogenic disturbance to forest ecosystems to determine if a
sustained, directional alteration of environmental "quality" results will require a definition of the expected
pattern of episodic disturbance and subsequent recovery therefrom  (i.e., patterns of secondary
succession in the absence of chronic disturbance).  Only when we have such a "temporal fingerprint" of
forest ecosystem condition for "normal" patterns of disturbance and recovery can we determine if the
ecosystem condition is being degraded by chronic human-induced alteration of the environment.  Thus,
degradation is assessed in terms of deviations from the expected temporal pattern of conditions rather
than in terms of an instantaneous assessment of any particular condition.  The concept of  "ecological '
rotation" (the time for a given ecosystem to recover from a given disturbance  back to some defined
successional condition) is useful for the definition of "temporal fingerprints". This requires information
on the intensity of disturbance, the frequency of disturbance,  and the rate of recessional recovery. Only
when all three of these are known or estimated can statements be made as to whether the ecosystem
is in a long-term sustainable condition or not.

The somewhat overwhelming complexity of this task has  led forest ecologists  to use ecosystem-level
computer  simulation models. Appropriately structured and calibrated models of this type can provide
predictions of the overall temporal patterns of ecosystem structure and functions that can  be expected
to accompany a given frequency and character of episodic disturbance.  Such models can also be used
to examine the long-term consequences of chronic disturbances such as acid rain and climatic change.
Predictive ecosystem-level models should be used in conjunction with some method of satisfying the
inherent spatial biophysical variability of the forest environment, such as the biogeoclimatic classification
system of British Columbia.

265.Kimmlns, J. 1990. Workgroup issue paper: Indicators and assessment of the state of forests.
Environ. Monitor. Assess. 15:297-299.

This article briefly addresses the factors affecting the condition of forest ecosystems and the use of
models to assess forests.

266.Klopatek, J., J. Kitchings, R. Olsen, K.  Kumar, and L. Mann. 1981. A  hierarchical  system for
evaluating regional ecological resources. Biol. Conserv. 20:271-290.

A methodology has been developed to measure the ecological quality of potential wilderness areas
under the U.S. Department of Agriculture (USDA) Forest Service's Roadless Area Review and
Evaluation (RARE-II) Program.  Four major parameters were chosen to  quantify land areas located
anywhere in the conterminous  United States.  These are (1) vegetation, (2) avian communities and the
quality of habitat provided  by an area, (3) mammal communities, and (4) endangered or threatened
species.  The  results are shown for the Douglas-fir ecoregion of the United States and are used in a
conflict matrix  to segregate identified tracts according to their ecological ratings and energy and mineral
resource ratings.

267.Koeman,  J. 1991. From comparative physiology to lexicological risk assessment.  Comp. Biochem.
Physiol. 100C(1/2):7-10.
                                               80

-------
Comparative physiology may help to improve lexicologists' ability to assess and predict toxicological
risks of chemicals.  Three main lines of approach have been distinguished (1) comparative research
concerning the toxicokinetics of chemicals in different species, (2) research concerning ecophysiological
characteristics, and (3) studies aimed at the identification of biological markers that can be used to
signal toxic effects in both experimental and free-living populations of organisms.

Some limiting conditions have to be fulfilled in order to make comparative physiology valuable from a
toxicological point of view.

268.Kolasa, J., and S.T.A. Pickett. 1992. Ecosystem stress and health: An expansion of the
conceptual basis. J. Aquat. Ecosyst. Health 1(1):7-14.

The assessment of the ecosystem health and departures from it requires clarity of what the system, its
structure, dynamics, and healthy conditions are. Available definitions provide inadequate tools to
acquire this clarity and may lead to arbitrary diagnoses of ecosystem health  but such diagnoses can be
overturned on a variety of scientific, philosophical, or political grounds.

Nested  hierarchy  of ecosystem structure compounds the difficulty in the assessment of stress and
health because both states may occur simultaneously at different hierarchical levels: with stress at one
level being a necessary condition of health at another.

An approach based on a formal definition of system change is advanced.  First, a conceptual model
identifies a self-maintaining minimum interactive structure (MIS) at each level of ecosystem
organization.  Components of MIS are complementary, coordinated, and exchanging information — they
are integrated. Function is defined as a contribution of a component to the maintenance of the whole.
In this context health is viewed as persistence of the system at a given temporal and spatial scale.
Impairment of the function is stress and is contrasted with change of system structure (loss, addition, or
replacement of components of MIS) which is disturbance.  Stress can be measured directly by changes
of function or indirectly by changes in integration.  Even though undesirable from the human point of
view, a  changed system may again be considered healthy.

Key Words: Definition (of stress), Ecosystem function, General theory, System organization

269.Koonce, J.F. 1990. Commentary on fish community health: Monitoring and assessment in large
lakes. J. Great Lakes Res. 16(4):631-634.

Although ecosystem models have often been applied to fish communities, these communities are more
loosely  organized than are entire ecosystems, therefore, are subject to different criteria of system
health.  Indicators of ecosystem health, such as lake trout, have frequently been identified, but the end
use of information about ecosystem health based on these indicators is not always specified.  Thus
management actions are not always specified.

270.Kosklmles, P. 1989. Birds as a tool in environmental monitoring. Ann.  Zool. Fennici 26(3): 153-
166.

This paper reviews the use of birds as a tool in environmental monitoring by discussing the value of
birds as biological indicators and by describing the integrated bird monitoring program in Finland. The
paper emphasizes the central role of the interpretation of data.  It is important that environmental
authorities are aware of this interpretation.

Birds are useful biological  indicators of, for example, broad-scale habitat changes and environmental
contaminants.  Birds are especially suitable for detecting unexpected changes that cannot be observed
by measuring preselected  physical and chemical parameters and for monitoring biological, often
cumulative and nonlinear consequences of many environmental changes acting simultaneously.

In Finland, about 15 study projects that monitor the regional population ecology of birds have been
integrated to give maximal opportunity for data record linkage across projects. The breeding and
                                               81

-------
wintering resident species are the most important populations for monitoring. The interpretation of
results, the most important part of monitoring, tries to confirm cause-effect relationships between birds
and their environment.  Useful  approaches to find the reasons for bird population changes include use
of indicator species, comparison of species with similar ecologies, and partitioning the total population
change into different population processes. Knowing the reasons for changes is necessary to prevent
negative  environmental changes that influence both nature and human well-being.

271.Krantzberg, G. 1990. Rapporteur's report of work group: Indicators at community or systems level.
Environ.  Monitor. Assess. 15:283-284.

This summary of a conference workgroup briefly reports on aspects of monitoring and approaches to
identifying indicators.

272.Kreisel, W. 1984. Representation of the environmental quality profile of a metropolitan area.
Environ.  Monitor. Assess. 4(1 ):15-33.

The spatially and temporally varying environmental quality of a metropolitan area is described by means
of empirically derived environmental indices.  The approach  is based on the principles of benefit
analysis  and consists of a number of logical steps, including the selection, the measurement  and
determination of the spatial distribution, and the normalization  (scaling) of the selected environmental
indicators.  To derive composite indices, the  normalized indicators are weighted, based on the  Delphi
technique, and subsequently aggregated.  The  results are given by means of isopleths, including single
and composite index isopleths  plotted  by computer on common maps.

273.Kremen, C. 1992. Assessing the indicator properties of species assemblages for natural areas
monitoring. Ecol. Appl. 2(2):203-217.

The diversity of organisms and complexity of ecosystems prevent thorough inventory and monitoring of
protected areas, yet sound databases  are needed to manage ecosystems for long-term persistence.
One strategy is therefore to focus monitoring on indicator organisms, but guidelines are lacking for
selecting appropriate species or groups. This paper presents  a simple protocol based on ordination
techniques for establishing the indicator properties of a group of organisms and for selecting  an
indicator species subset for more  intensive monitoring.  Use of ordination allows inclusion of many more
taxa than have been traditionally used for natural areas monitoring, and need not rely on detailed
knowledge of species biology.  As an example, the author studied the indicator properties of  a  butterfly
taxocene in a rain forest in Madagascar.  Butterflies  have been suggested as particularly good
environmental indicators due to their sensitivity to micro-climate and light level  changes, and  their
interactions as larvae and adults with different sets of host plants.  The indicator properties of butterfly
assemblages were evaluated in this study with  respect to a known pattern of environmental
heterogeneity along topographic/moisture and disturbance gradients. Butterfly  assemblages were found
to be excellent integrators of heterogeneity due to the topographic/moisture gradient, limited indicators
of heterogeneity due to anthropogenic disturbance, and poor indicators of plant diversity.  The protocol
defined in this study is widely applicable to other groups of organisms, spatial scales, and
environmental gradients.  By examining the environmental correlates of the distribution of species
assemblages,  this protocol can assess the indicator  properties of  target species groups.

Key  Words: Diversity, Dominance, Ecological monitoring, Indicator species assemblage, Madagascar,
Natural areas conservation, Ordination, Rarity,  Satyrinae, Tropical butterflies

274.Kuchenberg, T. 1985. IJC Conference:  Measuring the health of the ecosystem. Environment
27(2):32-37.

This article summarizes some  of the issues raised at the October 1984 workshop sponsored by the
International Joint Commission Transboundary  Monitoring Network. Concepts  surrounding
environmental and ecosystem  monitoring and definitions of monitoring terms are also discussed.
                                               82

-------
275.Kutz, F., and R. Linthurst. 1990. A systems-level approach to environmental assessment. Toxicol.
Environ. Chem. 28:105-114.

This paper presents an overview of the rationale, goals, and primary elements of the Environmental
Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP), which represents a long-term commitment to periodically
assess and document the condition of the ecological resources of the United States. EMAP is being
designed by the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency's (EPA) Office of Research and Development.
The program will serve a spectrum of decision makers who require information to set environmental
policy, program managers who require an objective basis for allocating research and monitoring funds,
scientists who desire a broader understanding of ecosystems, and those interested in evaluating the
effectiveness of the U.S. environmental policy.

Key Words: Ecological resources, Environmental assessment, Status and trends, Ecological  indicators
and endpoints, Geographic  information system

276.Kutz, F., R.A. Linthurst, C. Rlordan, M. Sllmak, and R. Frederick. 1992. Ecological research at
EPA: New directions. Environ. Sci. Technol. 26(5):860-866.

This article describes the development of strategies for ecological research within the EPA's  Office of
Research and Development.  The Ecological Risk Assessment Program, EMAP, and the use of
indicators are overviewed.

277.Landres, P.B. 1983. Use of the guild concept  in environmental impact assessment. Environ.
Manage. 7(5):393-398.

This paper attempts to clarify and expand several ideas concerning use of the guild concept  in
environmental impact assessment. Background  material on the concept and examples of its use are
given. For purposes of environmental assessment a resource-based guild approach is suggested to be
preferable to a taxonomic-based approach.  Validity of the guild concept, problems in classifying
species into guilds, implications of guild membership, and usefulness of guild analyses are discussed.
The author concludes that a thorough knowledge of both its limitations and benefits will enable
researchers to fully use the  guild concept for understanding organizational processes in communities
and ecosystems and for assessing environmental impacts.

Key Words: Guild concept, Environmental assessment

278.Landres, P. 1992. Ecological indicators: Panacea or liability? Pages 1295-1318. In: D. McKenzie,
D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the International Symposium
on Ecological Indicators, held in Fort Lauderdale, Fl_, 16-19 October 1990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

This paper examines two ecological uses of indicator species: to  assess population trends for other
species of interest and to monitor habitat "quality" or the "health"  of an ecosystem.  Several U.S. federal
agencies are currently using ecological indicators, and eminent scholars advocate their use.  These
applications of ecological indicators are based on two assumptions.  First, assessing one or several
indicator species is a cost-effective alternative to monitoring all the species in an ecosystem. Second,
indicator species provide a sufficiently precise  and  accurate assessment of other species, an entire
community, or an  ecosystem.

Analysis of current uses of ecological indicators refutes both assumptions.  For a single conspicuous,
easily recognized, and currently used indicator species, the cost of determining yearly population
change is shown to be over $1 million.  In addition, neither conceptual nor empirical studies support
extrapolating the population trend of an indicator species to other species.

Several problems arise in using an indicator species to monitor or assess habitat quality.  First,
population density of an indicator is a tenuous index of habitat quality.  Second, usefulness of an
indicator in one geographic  area cannot be extrapolated to other areas.  Third, managing an  area for
an indicator probably maintains only those resources needed by that species, ignoring resources
                                              83

-------
needed by other species.  In particular, problems with high trophic-level mammalian and avian
"umbrella" species are discussed. Fourth, indicators chosen by arbitrary or confounded criteria destroy
any effectiveness and credibility of an  indicator.  Fifth, with no clear and agreed upon definition for the
phrase "habitat quality," it is difficult or impossible to judge the efficacy of an ecological indicator.

As currently used, ecological indicators are not adequate to assess population trends of other species
or habitat quality of natural systems.  Despite this conclusion, ecological indicators will continue to be
used; eight recommendations are offered to make their use more rigorous, credible, and effective.

Finally, an ecosystem-based approach to monitoring and assessment that relies on ecosystem
indicators is presented as an alternative to the use of status quo ecological indicators.  Concepts of
ecosystem "health" and "stress," defining  and selecting ecosystem indicators, and problems with this
approach are all discussed.

279.Landres, P.B., J. Verner, and J.  Thomas. 1988. Ecological uses of vertebrate indicator species: A
critique. Conserv. Biol. 2:316-328.

Plant and animal species have been used for decades as indicators of air and water quality and
agricultural and range conditions. Increasingly, vertebrates are used to assess population trends and
habitat quality for other species.  This  paper  reviews the conceptual bases, assumptions, and published
guidelines for selection and use of vertebrates as ecological indicators. The authors conclude that an
absence  of precise definitions and procedures, confounded criteria used to select species, and
discordance with ecological literature severely weaken the effectiveness and credibility of using
vertebrates as ecological indicators.  In many cases,  the use of ecological indicator species is
inappropriate, but when their use is necessary, the following recommendations will make their
application more rigorous:  (1) clearly state assessment goals; (2) use indicators only when other
assessment options are unavailable; (3) choose indicator  species by explicitly defined criteria  that are in
accord with assessment goals; (4) include all species that fulfill stated selection criteria; (5) know the
biology of the indicator in detail, and treat the indicator as a formal estimator in conceptual and
statistical models; (6) identify and define sources of subjectivity when selecting, monitoring, and
interpreting indicator species; (7) submit assessment design, methods of data collection and statistical
analysis, interpretations, and recommendations to peer review and; (8) direct research toward
developing overall strategy for monitoring wildlife that accounts for natural variability in population
attributes and incorporates concepts from landscape ecology.

280.Langlots, C., M. Levellle, and L. Lapierre. 1990. Assessment of St. Lawrence ecosystem quality:
Use of biochemical, histological, chemical and ecological indicators. In: Physiological and Biochemical
Approaches to the Toxicological Assessment of Environmental Pollution. Annual Conference on
Physiological Approaches  to the Toxicological Assessment of Environmental Pollution, August 27-31,
1990. Royal Netherlands Chemical Society, Utrecht, The Netherlands.

The Ecosystem Assessment Program  of the  St. Lawrence Action  Plan has two major objectives: to
assess the current state of health of the aquatic ecosystems in the  St. Lawrence River and to establish
a monitoring network on a long-term basis. The study area in 1989 comprised the three major riverine
lakes: Lake St.  Francois downstream of the international (US-Canada) section of the river and of  the
Great Lakes basin, Lake St. Louise at the confluence of the Ottawa River and the St. Lawrence, and
Lake St.  Pierre, downstream of the Montreal metropolitan area. Fish and benthic communities were
studied to identify potential effects of toxic inputs on their  integrity.  This assessment was made by
using ecological, biochemical, histological, and chemical indicators.

281.Larson, D.P., D.L. Stevens, A.R. Selle, and S.G. Paulsen. 1991. Environmental Monitoring and
Assessment Program - Surface Waters: A northeast lakes pilot. Lake Reserv. Manage. 7(1):1-11.

282.Leak, W.B. 1992. Vegetative change as an index of forest environmental impact. J. For. 90(9): 32-
35.
                                               84

-------
This article focuses on monitoring change in site productivity to detect stress on forests. Site change is
a likely consequence of many sources of stress, and represents a long-term effect that is not easily
remedied.  The discussion suggests that environmental influences that alter forest site conditions can
best be detected by the same methods and measures that have proven useful in site evaluation. In
other words, measures currently used to detect important spatial differences in forest sites will also be
the measures most likely to detect site changes over time resulting from environmental effects.  After a
review of site evaluation approaches, vegetative community and height growth are presented as
methods to measure site-related impact. Data on vegetative change on the  Bartlett Experimental
Forest are examined as an example of how vegetative change could, with further analysis, be used to
assess environmental impact.

283.Leatherland, J., and R. Sonstegard.  1984. Great Lakes  coho salmon as an  indicator organism for
ecosystem health.  Mar. Environ. Res. (abstract only) 14(1-4):480.

The Great Lakes are annually stocked with a common genetic strain of coho salmon (Oncorhynchus
kisutch). In the lake environments, the coho has a defined life cycle and food  source and as such is an
ideal sentinel animal for monitoring for the  presence of bioaccumulable xenobiotics and the
pathobiological effects of environmental toxicants.  Annual synchronized collections of sexually mature
coho indicate that each lake has its own pathobiological signature (i.e., thyroid function, liver pathology,
serum ion levels, growth, gonadal somatic  indices, and fecundity). Field epizootiological studies were
summarized with specific reference to pathobiological responses in feral coho, relay studies (fish to fish,
fish to rat), and point chemical toxicity assays.  These investigations  have led to cohort epidemiological
studies of people who consume Lake Ontario coho salmon. Strategies for environmental monitoring of
aquatic organisms, laboratory cause-effect studies, and human epidemiology are being developed.

284.Lefohn, A.S.,  and D.S.  Shadwlck. 1991. Ozone, sulfur dioxide, and nitrogen dioxide trends at
rural sites located in the United States. Atmos. Environ. 25:491-501.

The authors have investigated the existence of trends for ozone, sulfur dioxide, and nitrogen dioxide at
rural sites in the U.S.  For the ozone analysis, at 54 of the  77  sites (70%) for the 10-year analysis
(1979-1988) and at 118 of 147 sites (80%), there was  no indication of trends, either positive  or
negative.  For the 10-year analysis, ozone  sites in the  Southern and  Midwestern forestry regions
showed more positive than negative significant slope estimates.  For the 5-year analysis, similar results
were obtained, except that the mid-Atlantic region also experienced  more positive than negative
significant slope estimates.  In most of the  agricultural regions, there were not  many significant trends in
either the 10- or 5-year analysis.  However, for the agricultural Appalachian region, 50% and 34% of
the trends,  respectively, were significant and there were more  positive than negative significant ozone
trends for both the 10- and 5- year periods.  For sulfur dioxide, there was an indication of trends at 37
of 64 sites (58%) for the  10-year analysis (1978-1987).  For the 5-year analysis (1983-1987), with at
least 4 years of data, there was no indication of trends at 115  of 137 sites (84%).  For sites in some
regions of the U.S., there is an indication that sulfur dioxide concentrations have declined for both the 5-
 and 10- year periods, but the rate of decline on an aggregate basis  has slowed in the 5-year period.
There is a strong indication that the sulfur dioxide level decreased at many sites in the Midwest forestry
and the Corn Belt agricultural regions for the 10-year period. In the Southern forestry and Appalachian
agricultural regions, many sites showed a decrease in the index for the 10-year, but not the 5-year,
period.  The lack of monitoring data for nitrogen dioxide made any conclusion extremely tenuous.

Key Words: Trends, Ozone, Sulfur Dioxide, Nitrogen dioxide, Cumulative exposure, Agriculture,
Forestry.

285.Letourneau, C., and J.  Castonguay.  1988. Use of biological indicators  for evaluating
environmental stress. Report No. INFO-0248(E), NTIS No.  DE90629986/HDM. Atomic Energy Control
Board, Ottawa, Ontario.  68 pp.

This report examines the usefulness of biological analyses  for evaluating environmental stress.  All
forms of stress are addressed; particular attention, however, is paid  to the use of biological analyses to
evaluate the impact on the environment from radioactive releases of  the nuclear industry.  First, the
                                               85

-------
authors review different biological analyses that are grouped into two approaches: the holistic approach
(biotic and diversity indices) and the reductionist approach ("biological indicators" per se). Second, they
compare the usefulness of plants and animals as indicators based on the established criteria  This
report ends with a compilation of letters received from different organizations that outline the present
use of  biological indicators in Canada for evaluating environmental stress.

286.Levin, S. 1983. Ecological factors and the selection of indicator and test species for impact
assessment.  ERC Rep. No. 12. Ecosystems Research Center, Cornell University, Ithaca, NY. 11 pp.

In this  report, the  author acknowledges the increased attention on examining ecological impacts on
ecosystem structure and function, but still thinks there is value in identifying particular species or groups
of species for intensive laboratory or field testing, and as indicators for monitoring.  The report focuses
on acceptable criteria for selection of such species, and stresses the importance of such criteria.

287.Levin, S. 1992. Orchestrating environmental research and assessment. Ecol. Appl. 2(2):103-116.

When pressing  national environmental problems must be solved, and serve as the justification for large
infusions of public funds, mechanisms must be found to assure that the requisite research and
assessment are performed. Large, managed programs seem to offer a way to direct energies in the
needed directions, but individual creativity and intellectual curiosity must also be fostered through
investigator-initiated studies. Research results cannot be achieved to meet imposed deadlines,  and
assessment in the face of uncertainty must be given due attention.  This paper introduces five
subsequent papers, four of which present perspectives on the National Acid Precipitation Assessment
Program, as a model for coordinated research and assessment programs, and one that presents plans
for a national and international research effort on biodiversity.

Key Words: Acid deposition, Acid precipitation, Acid rain, Biodiversity, Environmental  assessment,
Environmental research, Global change, NAPAP, Pollution

288.Levfn, S., M. Harwell, J. Kelly, and K. Kimball, eds. 1989. Ecotoxicology: Problems and
Approaches. Columbia University Press, New York. 547 pp.

Ecotoxicology is the science that seeks to predict the impacts of chemicals on ecosystems.  This
involves describing and predicting ecological changes ensuing from  a variety of human activities that
involve release of xenobiotic and other chemicals to the environment. A fundamental principle of
ecotoxicology is the notion of change.  Ecosystems themselves are  constantly changing as a result of
natural processes, and it is a challenge to distinguish the effects of anthropogenic activities against this
background of fluctuations in the natural world.  With the frustratingly large, diverse, and ever-emerging
sphere of environmental problems that ecotoxicology must address, the approaches to individual
problems also must vary.  In part, as a consequence, there is no established protocol for application of
the science to environmental problem solving.

The book contains chapters on problems and approaches to ecotoxicology, indicators of ecosystem
response and recovery, responses of ecosystems to chemical stress, biomonitoring, decision making,
and regulatory frameworks for ecotoxicology.

289.Levin, S., K. Kimball, W. McDowell, and S.  Kimball. 1984.  New perspectives in ecotoxicology.
Environ.  Manage. 8(5):375-442.

The task of regulating potentially harmful chemicals in the environment is currently hindered by the lack
of appropriate concepts and methods for evaluating the effects of anthropogenic chemicals on
ecosystems.  Toxicity tests at the molecular and physiological levels have been used successfully as
indicators of adverse effects on test organisms and have been extrapolated to humans to establish a
basis for risk assessment.  However, laboratory measurements of effects on individuals do not translate
readily into potential effects on natural populations, in part because  natural populations interact with
other populations and with the physical environment.  Even more difficult to assess are the deleterious
                                               86

-------
impacts of anthropogenic chemicals on ecosystems because of effects on species interactions diversity,
nutrient cycling, productivity, climatic changes, and other processes.

Effects on ecosystems resulting from chemical stresses are outside the realm of classical toxicology,
and an ecosystem-level perspective is essential for the consideration of such effects; however, the
science that deals with ecosystem-level effects,  ecotoxicology, is still developing. This article
synthesizes the topics discussed at a workshop on ecotoxicology held by the Ecosystems Research
Center at Cornell University.  Topics covered include: the regulatory framework in which
ecotoxicological research must be applied; ecosystem modification of toxicant fate and transport; how
ecosystem composition, structure, and function are influenced by chemicals; methods currently
available for predicting the effects of chemicals at the ecosystem level; and recommendations on
research needs to enhance the state of the science of ecotoxicology.

Key Words: Ecotoxicology, Environmental regulation,  Fate and transport of anthropogenic chemicals,
Keystone and critical species

290.Lewis, J. 1976. Long-term ecological surveillance: Practical realities in the rocky littoral. Oceanogr.
Mar. Biol. Annu.  Rev.  14:371-390.

In spite of the existence of several papers, the general paucity of time-series data for the littoral is such
that if chronic effects are henceforth to  be assessed we need to measure the degree of change taking
place from natural baselines whose levels and stability have themselves, for the most part, still to be
determined. The progressive attainment of these objectives, and those of interpretation that will surely
follow, will demand much manpower and time.  Neither is in abundant supply, and it becomes
imperative, therefore, to find strategies of investigation that maximize limited resources by directing
them in those areas in which the most information can be gained.  The details of any strategy will vary
with the habitat and its populations, the potential for using different methods  and criteria, and the type
and level of existing knowledge.  This paper attempts to evolve a low-cost strategy for the rocky littoral,
but before considering that habitat in particular, there  remain, in the context of aims and resources,
some further essential points of general applicability that should weigh heavily whenever a program of
biological monitoring is contemplated.  At the very least, these considerations indicate that such work
should not be undertaken lightly.

291.Linthurst, R., L. Jackson,  K. Thornton, and J. Messer. 1992. Integrated monitoring for ecological
condition: Issues of scale, complexity, and future change. Pages 1421-1442. In: D.  McKenzie, D.E.
Hyatt, and J. McDonald. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the International Symposium On
Ecological Indicators, held in Fort Lauderdale, FL,  16-19 October 1990. Elsevier, Essex,  England.

The Environmental  Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP) is part of the Office of Research and
Development's (ORD) response to both the SAB recommendations and agency theme of "Managing for
Results." EMAP represents the foundation for ORD's Ecological Risk Assessment Program.  This paper
will briefly describe  EMAP, highlighting some of the design features that make it unique for addressing
large-scale environmental problems and discuss three issues or concerns raised about the EMAP:
scale of resolution, assessing complex ecological problems,  and anticipating  future ecological problems.


292.Llverman, D., M.  Hanson,  B. Brown,  and R. Merideth. 1989. Global sustainability: Towards
measurement. Environ. Manage. 11:133-143.

The widespread interest in the concept  of sustainable environment and development has been
accompanied by  the need to develop useful systems of measurement.  This  paper discusses the use of
indicators which might be used to assess such conditions. Our characteristics or criteria for desirable
global sustainability indicators are (1) sensitivity to change in time, (2) sensitivity to change across
space or within groups, (3) predictive ability, (4) availability of reference or threshold values,  (5) ability
to measure reversibility or controllability, (6) appropriate data transformation,  (7) integrative ability,  and
(8) relative ease  of collection and use. The authors discuss the basis of these characteristics and
examine two categories of indicators (soil erosion and population) and two specific indicators (physical
                                               87

-------
quality of life index and energy imports as a percentage of consumption) for their value as sustainability
measures.

Key Words: Global sustainability, Indicators, Measurement

293.Loehle, C.  1991. Managing and monitoring ecosystems in the face of heterogeneity. Pages 144-
159. In: J. Kolasa and S. Pickett, eds. Ecological Heterogeneity.  (Series: Ecological Studies: Analysis
and Synthesis 86). Springer-Verlag, New York.

Problems of air  and water pollution have become sufficiently acute and extensive that piecemeal
solution of the problems is no longer adequate.  It has become clear that even if each city meets clean
air and water standards for human health, regional ecosystems may be degraded.  It is thus necessary
to monitor and manage the environment on a regional or even global basis.  At this scale, however,
heterogeneity of all types becomes almost overwhelming.  Spatial heterogeneity, multi-level
phenomena, multiple  management activities, and multiple time scales interfere with the abilities of
managers and regulatory agencies to detect and prevent environmental deterioration.  This chapter
addresses strategies for dealing with complexity and heterogeneity, largely in the context of
environmental protection.

294.Loehle, C., J. Gladden, and E. Smith. 1990. An assessment methodology for successional
systems.  I. Null  models and the regulatory framework. Environ. Manage. 14(2):249-258.

Standard procedures  for evaluating  environmental impact involve comparison between before and after
conditions or scenarios, or between treatment and control site pairs.  In many cases, however,
endogenous directional change (natural succession) is expected  to occur at a significant rate over the
period of concern, particularly for human-made systems such as impoundments.  Static evaluations do
not provide an adequate approach to such problems.  A new evaluation frame is proposed.  Nominal
system behavior over time is characterized by a stochastic envelope around  a nominal trajectory.  The
authors show that both the state variance and the sampling variance can change over time. In this
context, environmental regulations can be framed as constraints, targets, or conformance to ideal
trajectories.  Statistical tests for determining noncompliance are explored relative to process variance,
sample error, and sample size. Criteria are elucidated for choosing properties to monitor, sample size,
and sampling interval.

Key Words: Stochastic models, Monitoring, Statistical tests, Experimental design

295.Loehle, C., and E.P. Smith. 1988. An assessment methodology for successional systems. II.
Statistical tests  and specific examples. Environ. Manage. 14(2):259-268.

This paper presents a dynamic framework for environmental assessment when the system under study
is undergoing successional change.  Successional differences between sites for which one wishes to
detect a difference because of a treatment are essentially confounding factors.  The authors show how
successional changes over this study period or resulting from differences in study site plot ages can be
factored out by  developing a null model of expected behavior over time.  The null model for change in
state with time is characterized in terms of a stochastic envelope around a nominal trajectory.  Specific
tests for the detection of trends associated with succession are described and illustrated on example
data.  It is concluded that the methods developed work particularly well for laboratory microcosm data.

Key Words:  Monitoring, Statistical analysis, Null models, Stochastic models,  Hypothesis testing

296.Loehr, R. 1991. Assessing and managing environmental risk. Environ. Prog. 10(2):M2.

This editorial briefly addresses the emergence of environmental  risk assessment to improve
environmental management and environmental decision-making.

297.Loftls, J.C., G.B. McBride, and J.C. Ellis. 1991. Considerations of scale in water quality
monitoring and  data analysis. Water Resour. Bull. 27(2):255-264.
                                              88

-------
An assumption of scale is inherent in any environmental monitoring exercise.  The temporal or spatial
scale of interest defines the statistical model that would be most appropriate for a given system and
thus affects both sampling design and data analysis. Two monitoring objectives that are strongly tied to
scale are the estimation of average conditions and the  evaluation of trends. For both of these
objectives,  the time or spatial scale of interest strongly  influences whether a given  set of  observations
should be regarded as independent or serially correlated and affects the importance of serial
correlation  in choosing  statistical methods. In particular, serial correlation has a much different effect
on the estimation of specific period-means.  For estimating trends, a distinction between serial
correlation  and trend is scale-dependent.  An explicit consideration of scale in monitoring system design
and data analysis is, therefore, most important for producing meaningful statistical  consideration.

Key Words: Water quality, Monitoring, Statistics, Trends

298.Loftls, J.C., C.H. Taylor, and P.L. Chapman. 1991. Multivariate tests for trends in water quality.
Water Resour. Res. 27:1419-1429.

Several methods of testing for multivariate trend have been discussed in the statistical and water quality
literature. The authors review both parametric and nonparametric approaches and compare their
performance using synthetic data.  A new method, based on a robust estimation and testing approach
suggested by Sen and  Puri,  performed very well for serially independent observations. A modified
version of the covariance inversion approach presented by Dietz and Killeen also performed well for
serially independent observations.  For serially correlated observations, the covariance eigenvalue
method suggested by Lettenmaier was the best performer.

299.Long,  E.R., and M.R. Buchman.  1989. An evaluation of candidate measures  of biological effects
for the National Status and Trends program.  National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration (NOAA)
Technical Memo.  NOS  OMA 45. U.S. Department of Commerce, Rockville, MD.

The National  Status and Trends Program  analyzes three media-sediments, bottomfish, and bivalves-
routinely at sites nationwide. The present evaluation included biological tests of two of those media:
sediments and fish. Data from the various biological tests were compared with each other and with the
chemical data in various statistical procedures. The study concluded that no  single measure of
biological effects can suffice for determining the biological effects of pollution.  The measures evaluated
in this document are: chemical analyses of surficial sediments; solid phase sediment toxicity test with
an amphipod; sediment elutriate toxicity test with the larvae of mussels and sea urchins; sediment pore
water toxicity test with a polychaete; taxonomic analyses of benthic community structure; analyses of
sedimentological and biological characteristics with sediment profiling photography; fish collection,
tissue chemical analyses, aryl hydrocarbon hydroxylase analyses,  and plasma steroid hormone
analyses; fish blood micronucleated erythrocyte analyses and; fish liver cytochrome P-450 and
ethoyresorufinn-O-deethylase (EROD) enzyme analyses.

SOO.Loucks,  O.L. 1985. Looking for surprise in managing stressed ecosystems. Bioscience 35(7):428-
432.

Both natural and anthropogenic sources of stress can produce unanticipated and unprecedented
ecosystem  responses, such as a new equilibrium with long-term effects. Ecosystem models that
simulate the prospective outcomes of management help to analyze responses to stress mitigation but
cannot usually anticipate surprises—the emergence of new stable  states. In managing stressed
systems, we should therefore consider both what we predict and what we cannot predict.

301.Lubchenco, J., A. Olsen, L.  Brubaker, S. Carpenter,  M. Holland, S. Hubbell, S. Levin, J.
MacMahon, P. Matson, J. Melillo, H.  Mooney, C. Peterson, H. Pulliam, L.  Real, P. Regal, P.RIsser.
1991. The sustainable biosphere initiative: An ecological research agenda. A  report from  the Ecological
Society of America. Ecology  72(2):371-412.

In this document, the Ecological Society of America proposes the Sustainable Biosphere  Initiative (SBI),
an Initiative that focuses on the necessary role of ecological science in the wise management of Earth's
                                              89

-------
resources and the maintenance of Earth's life support systems.  This document is intended as a call-to-
arms for all ecologists, but it also will serve as a means to communicate with individuals in other
disciplines with whom ecologists must join forces to address our common predicament.

Portions of the document address responses to stress, the effects of scale, and ecological indicators.

Key Words: Biological diversity, Biosphere, Ecological research,  Environmental decision-making, Global
change, Research agenda, Research funding,  Research priorities, Sustainability, Sustainable ecological
systems

302.Lugo, A. 1978. Stress and ecosystems. Pages 62-101. In: J. Thorp and J. Gibbons, eds. Energy
and Environmental Stress in Aquatic Systems. Department of Energy Symposium Series,  CONF
771114. Technical Information Service, Department of Energy, Oak Ridge, TN.

The literature dealing with  issues of stress as it affects ecosystems  is reviewed.  Definitions of stress
are discussed. Models and literature examples are presented to illustrate the push-pull (positive-
negative) effects of most stressors and to suggest that the point of attack and the type of stressor
determine the rate of response of the ecosystem.  Stressors with high-quality energy (highly
concentrated energy sources) that divert low-quality in a system appear to have a greater impact than
stressors with low-quality energy (diluted energy sources) that impact high-quality energy flows.  It is
suggested that ecosystem complexity (including species diversity, physiognomy, three-dimensional
organization,  etc.) is a function of the balance  between energies that contribute to growth and
organization and those that contribute to disorder.  The classification of environments by their "energy
signatures" (the sum of all incoming energy flows into a system and the pattern of their delivery
expressed on equal energy-quality basis) is presented as the best way to arrange and analyze
ecosystems hierarchically according to their capacity to develop  complexity and to tolerate stress.  The
patterns of ecosystems response to stressors, including positive, steady-state, and declining responses
and possible  extinction, are discussed. It is argued that, to solve the problems of ecosystem
management and the issues of environmental  impact, studies and analyses must be done at the level
of the ecosystem and care should be taken to quantify both the stressor and the stress with units of
comparable energy  quality.

303.Lund, H. 1986. A primer on integrating resource inventories. General Technical Report WO-49.
U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service, Washington, DC.

This document provides a comprehensive overview of how to perform an integrated resource
assessment.  It contains sections on the four levels of assessment: multilocation, multilevel (agency),
multiresource, and temporal. The section on temporal integration discusses how inventories can
provide trend data and eventually the validation of  predictions and assumptions.  It describes how
resource inventories can be used as foundations for monitoring, which serves to determine if planning
objectives are being met or to detect unplanned changes in the resource base.  The document also
lists the criteria for determining what should be monitored and gives options and recommendations for
identifying information needs for temporal integration.

304.Lund, H., and G. Preto, eds. 1990. Global Natural Resource Monitoring and Assessments:
Preparing for the 21st Century. American Society for Photogrammetry and Remote Sensing, Bethesda,
MD.

305.Macdonald, G., and L. Sertorio, eds. 1990. Global Climate and Ecosystem Change. [Series:
NATO Advanced Science  Institute Series, Series B, Physics 240 (1990)]. Plenum Publishing, New York.


306.MacDonald, I.A.W. 1992. Vertebrate populations as indicators  of environmental change in southern
Africa. Trans. R. Soc. S. Africa 48(P1):87-122.

Two categories of historical change in vertebrate populations are analyzed: species decline resulting in
inclusion in local Red Data Books and changes in distribution and abundance of what are often
                                              90

-------
common species, as revealed by regional surveys.  The former category of change tends to reflect
radical anthropogenic influences (e.g., habitat transformation, persecution,  and overuse). The latter
generally reflects the more widespread forms of habitat modification (e.g., bush encroachment, the
spread of alien trees into formerly treeless biomes, and desertification through overgrazing of semiarid
rangelands).  Destruction of vleis and marshes has been important throughout the region. Any long-
term climatic change that might have occurred over the last two centuries is not reflected by changes in
vertebrate populations. Several vertebrate changes do,  however, indicate a general tendency for
increased density of the woody plant component of savanna communities.  This trend is consistent with
the predicted response of these communities to the observed global increase in the atmospheric
concentration of global carbon  dioxide.  Short-term variations in annual rainfall have given rise to
significant fluctuations in vertebrate populations. Vertebrates could be particularly useful in  monitoring
future climatic change in which the effects of such change can be predicted in terms of  alterations in
the relative abundance of woody and herbaceous vegetation. Continuous monitoring of bird
populations would probably be the most effective  approach to detecting such changes.  The effects  of a
wide range of other factors, as detailed in this analysis, must be filtered out before variations in
vertebrate populations can be attributed to climatic change.

307. Mace, T. 1991. Multistage remote sensing for a national environmental monitoring program
database. Pages 691-700. In: GIS/LIS '90 - Technical Papers. Geographic Information Systems/Land
Information Systems Annual Conference, Anaheim, Ca. American Congress on Surveying and Mapping,
Falls Church, VA.

308.Machlis, G. 1992. The contribution of sociology research to biodiversity research and
management. Biol. Conserv. 62:161-170.

This article discusses in general the contribution of sociology to biodiversity issues, but also  includes a
short section describing its inputs to monitoring and assessment techniques such as social indicators as
anticipators of ecosystem change.

309.Magurran, A. 1988. Ecological Diversity and  Its Measurement. Princeton University Press,
Princeton, NJ.

This book is a comprehensive analysis of the different types  of diversity indices.  Chapters cover the
following topics: diversity indices and species abundance models; sampling; choosing and interpreting
diversity  measures;  a variety of diversities; and the empirical value of diversity measures.

310.Maher, W., and R. Morris. 1990. Water quality assessment programs  in Australia: Deciding what
to measure, and how and where to use bioindicators. Environ. Monit. Assess. 14:115-130.

Effective water quality assessment programs require the formulation of common objectives between
managers who are making decisions and scientists who  are obtaining the information on which those
decisions are to be made. The data collected must be appropriate for use in the decision-making
process.  After the objectives have been formulated, a number of testable hypotheses can be proposed
and evaluated in terms of what information is required for decision making.

From a management perspective,  it is important to know if an impact occurs and what management
strategy to adopt to  reduce or eliminate the impact.  When bioaccumulators are to be used to indicate
environmental quality, the organisms proposed need to be fully evaluated ahead of time. Communities,
which are often used to asses level of impact, have the capacity to assimilate pollutants and will
function under pollutant stress.  Thus, managers should make value judgments about when a
community structure or function has  shifted from acceptable to adverse.  Bioassays in which the effects
of pollutants on growth, biochemistry, and behavior are measured give an indication of the sublethal
effects of a pollutant, but it is difficult to set limits that managers can use.

Difficulties in using chemical and biological data mainly arise from a  lack of appreciation of
environmental heterogeneity. The data obtained must meet the needs for statistically testing certain
hypotheses. Before programs can be designed to meet statistical needs, the potential sources of
                                              91

-------
variability must be considered.  Once the minimum differences that are seen to be important have been
determined, the number of replicates needed can be calculated.  Data verification is also needed
because if the validity of data is questioned, any decisions that have been made based on those data
will also be suspect.  Finally, programs should be designed to minimize the sampling effort/cost to meet
the objectives.

31 LMaher, W., ed. 1990. Workshop on ecological indicators of the state of the environment held at the
international symposium on biomonitoring of the state of the environment, Canberra, Australia. Environ.
Monitor. Assess. 14(2-3): 107-399.

Papers presented at the Workshop on Ecological Indicators of the State of the Environment held in
Canberra, Australia, are organized into three sections: (1) protocols and programs; (2) biological
assessment of impact and; (3)  use and relevance of toxicity data. The majority of the papers deal with
organisms or physiology as environmental indicators and on a relatively small scale of study.

312.Makarewlcz, J.C. 1991. Photosynthetic parameters as indicators of ecosystem health. J. Great
Lakes Res. 17(3):333-343.

Thirty-three limnological variables, including the photosynthesis parameters Pmax and Alpha, were
monitored for 2 years in the nearshore and offshore of Lake Ontario.  In the nearshore, Pmax and Alpha
varied seasonally and were higher during the summer and early autumn and lowest in the winter and
spring of 1986-1987. No seasonal variability of the photosynthetic parameters were observed in the
offshore and nearshore in 1987-1988.  Pmax varied during the winter, a period of decreased  biological
activity and, ostensibly, less variability. Multiple regression analysis suggested that over 25% of the
variability in Pmax was predicted by temperature.  Both the large number of variables that are either
correlated or have been experimentally determined to affect Pmax  and Alpha and the similarity of the
photosynthetic parameters within the various Great Lakes of differing trophic status suggests that the
use of the photosynthetic parameters as  indicators of "ecosystem health" is weak at best.

Key Words: Indicators,  Bioindicators, Photosynthesis, Lake Ontario

313.Malatini, S., and G. Pinchera. 1986. Environmental indicators: A comparison of international
trends, (in Italian; summary in English, French,  Italian).  Ing. Ambientale 15(5):247-272.

In order to preserve, maintain and reclaim environmental quality,  and to assess the results of past
actions, on an international as  well as on a national or local level, a tested environmental accounting
system is  required.  Usually, unlike economics or energy surveys, environment accounting,  where
performed, does not rely on tested sets of indicators, in  a single country, or standardized, and thus
comparable, at an international level. Some international agencies (OCSE, UNECE, CEE, and so on),
at different degrees of advancement, are devoting great efforts to develop sets of indicators and similar
systems.  This article reviews achievements and trends  to this aim, in some industrialized countries, as
well as formulations and selected sets of indicators  provided by some international agencies to assess
both state and changes over time of environmental quality.

314.Man and the Biosphere.  1979. Long-term Monitoring in Biosphere Reserves. U.S.  Man and the
Biosphere Program. Washington, DC.

315.Margalef, R. 1975. Human impact on transportation and diversity in  ecosystems: How far is
extrapolation valid? Pages 237-241. In: Proceedings of the First International Congress of Ecology:
Structure, Functioning and Management  of Ecosystems. The Hague, 8-14 September, 1974. Centre for
Agricultural Publishing and Documentation, Wageningen, The Netherlands.

This article briefly outlines generalized responses of ecosystems  and communities to resource
exploitation, organic pollution, thermal pollution, radioactivity, and chemical pollution. Also, the idea of
stress in homeostatic ecosystems using an aquatic ecosystem as an example is discussed.
                                               92

-------
316.Marshall, T., R.A. Ryder, C.J. Edwards, and G.R. Spangler. 1987. Using the lake trout as an
indicator of ecosystem health: Application of the dichotomous key. Great Lakes Fishery Commission
Technical Report. No. 49. Ann Arbor, Ml.

The lake trout, Salvalinus namaycush (Walbaum), has been proposed for use as an indicator of
ecosystem quality for the Great Lakes basin.  To apply the concept for the effective management of
aquatic systems, a dichotomous key has been devised, which is designed to pose critical questions
pertaining to the lake trout, its aquatic community associates,  and its environment. Specifically, the
questions refer to the niche characteristics and habitat requirements of healthy lake trout stocks.
Responses to these questions provide the requisite information from which the current state of
ecosystem health is assessed. It was assumed that the lake trout, with its rigorous environmental
requirements, would serve as an apposite surrogate for a health oligotrophic system.

The dichotomous key has been designed  as a menu-driven computer program that may be
implemented  easily by the ecosystem manager and layman alike.  It is an interactive  program in that
the users may revise their inputs as new information becomes available. The program also provides
the rationale behind each of the questions in the key as well as bibliographic documentation for the
rationale.

Use of the dichotomous key program should provide a greater perception of which particular stresses
are adversely affecting ecosystem "health." In addition, the program tends to draw low profile stresses
to the user's attention, that may be critical to the persistence of a healthy ecosystem.

317.McCallum, D.B., and V.T. Covello. 1989. What the public thinks about environmental data. EPA J.
May/June:22-23.

This article briefly discusses which professional groups are the most trusted sources of information
about environmental risk, and also covers the issue of communicating risk to the public.

318.McCarthy, J., S. Adams, B.D. Jimlnez, and L.R. Shugart. 1989. Environmental monitoring of
biological markers in  animals and plants.  Pages 187-196. In:  R. Noble, J. Martin, and K. Jensen, eds.
Air Pollution Effects on Vegetation.  U.S. Forest Service Northeastern Experiment Station, Broomall, PA.

In an environmental monitoring plan, a suite of biomarkers is measured in wild animal or plant species
sampled  from areas of suspected contamination and from pristine reference areas. Based on the
magnitude and pattern of the biomarker responses, the environmental species offer the potential of
serving as sentinels that demonstrate the presence of bioavailable contaminants, and as surrogates
that indicate potential human exposure and effects, and predictors of long-term ecological effects.

319.McCracken, R.J. 1989. Indicators for assessing changes in natural resources in  developing
countries. AID-PN-ABB-193, NTIS No. PB89-202782/HDM. Report presented at Impact Indicators
Workshop, Arlington,  VA., June 20, 1988.  Agency for International Development, Washington, DC. 59
PP-

The sustainability of the natural resource base is being seriously threatened in many developing
countries by local efforts to meet basic needs for food, fiber, and fuelwood.  The paper suggests eight
illustrative indicators for assessing the impact of AID agricultural and forestry projects on natural
resources: soil productivity maintenance, land use and management, vegetative cover and plant health,
agroforestry and  fuelwood supply, rangeland condition and trends, water supply, environmental quality,
and accelerated general  degradation processes.  Appendices  cover procedures, data items, and costs
for natural resource inventories in the United States; Geographic Information Systems with digitized
map Information; costs of soil surveys, digitized maps, and GISs; estimated costs for  remote sensing of
natural resources; and a U.S.  Department of Agriculture water erosion prediction project being
developed to  replace the universal soil loss equation. The report includes a 5-page bibliography.

320.McKenzie, D.H., D.E. Hyatt, and J.V. McDonald. 1992. Ecological Indicators. Elsevier, Essex,
England.
                                              93

-------
An international symposium on ecological indicators was developed to explore both the potential of
ecological indicators and the issues surrounding their development and implementation.  The
symposium presented state-of-the-art science information on the identification, application, research,
and development of appropriate indicators to describe and evaluate ecological status. The use of
ecological indicators is crucial to providing improved information on the condition of the environment
and to the success of the Environmental Monitoring and Assessment  Program (EMAP).  The
symposium was designed to help ensure that the indicators used in the program have the strongest
possible basis of technical information from the international body  of knowledge.

Keywords: Biological indicators, Ecosystems, Environmental monitoring, Research and development

321.Mclntyre, A. 1984. What happened to biological effects monitoring?  Mar. Poll. Bull.  15(11):391-
392.

There seems to be a feeling in some quarters that  biological effects monitoring has not lived up to its
early promise and, indeed, that, in spite of significant efforts in recent years, it has not even gotten
properly off the ground.  This view perhaps arises from the fact that, although a number of large-scale
national and international programs are in operation, these do not usually have effective biological
components.  This editorial attempts to put the topic into perspective.

322.Menzel, D. 1987. Summary of experimental results: Controlled ecosystem pollution experiment.
Bull. Mar. Sci. 27:142-145.

This article provides a summary of results from ecosystem pollution experiments describing effects on
heterotrophy, phytoplankton, zooplankton, and chemistry.

323.Messer, J.J. 1989. Keeping a closer watch on ecological risk. EPA J. May/June:34-36.

This article addresses the questions that need to be posed in order to asses current environmental
problems and the status of ecological resources. The application  of environmental risk assessment to
this problem is discussed, as well as a brief summary of EMAP's role.

324.Messer, J.J.1992. Indicators in  regional ecological monitoring and risk assessment. Pages 135-
146. In: D.  McKenzie, D.E.  Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the
International Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October 1990.
Elsevier, Essex,  England.

325.Messer, J.J., R. Linthurst, and W. Overton. 1991. An EPA program for monitoring ecological
status and trends. Environ. Monitor.  Assess. 17(1):67-78.

Despite hundreds of millions of dollars spent annually in the United States on environmental monitoring,
policy makers and decision makers seldom have ready access to  the monitoring data they need to
prioritize research and assessment efforts or to assess the extent to which current policies are meeting
the desired objectives. EPA is currently conducting research to evaluate options for establishing an
integrated cooperative monitoring program, with participation by federal, state, and private entities.
Such a program could result in annual statistical reports and interpretive  summaries on the status and
trends in indicators of adverse disturbance and corresponding "health" of the nation's ecosystems on
the regional and national scale.

326.Messer, J.J., R.A. Linthurst, and C. Riordan. 1989.  A national  program for environmental
monitoring and assessment. Pages 211-215. In: R.D. Noble, J.L  Martin,  and K.F. Jensen, eds. Air
Pollution Effects on Vegetation: Including Forest Ecosystems. Proceedings of the Second  US-USSR
Symposium. U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service, Northeastern Forest Experiment Station,
Broomall, PA.

This article provides background on the need for a national level monitoring program and describes the
formation of EMAP and describes the approach it should take.
                                               94

-------
327.Meybeck, M., D. Chapman, and R. Helmer. Global Freshwater Quality — A 1st Assessment. 360
pp. Basil Blackwell, Cambridge, MA.

This book contains chapters on anthropogenic impacts on water quality, lake sediments as indicators of
anthropogenic impact, and global water quality assessment.

328.Michener, W., R. Feller, and D. Edwards. 1987. Development, management, and analysis of a
long-term ecological research information base: Example for marine macrobenthos. Pages 173-188. In:
T. Boyle, ed.  New Approaches to Monitoring Aquatic Ecosystems. ASTM STP  940. American Society
for Testing and Materials, Philadelphia.

As one of eleven Long-Term Ecological Research Program sites in the nation (designated by the
National Science Foundation), the Belle W.  Baruch Institute for Marine Biology and Coastal Research
has developed a flexible system for the management and analysis of ecological data.  The Baruch Data
Management System (BDMS) contains over 4 years of data collected from ecological research on
coastal and estuarine habitats.  Important design features of information bases for long-term monitoring
are described.

Because temporal variability is an inherent part of ecological data sets, it is important to delineate those
periods when sampling must be intensified and periods when sampling can be decreased without
compromising documentation of the processes under question. Examples of analyses of temporal
variability for one of the biological data sets (macrobenthos) are presented, and a case is made for the
importance of long-term monitoring efforts to the generation of process-related experiments.

Key Words: Benthic invertebrates, Database management, Ecology, Estuarine  systems, Information
base, Statistical methods, Temporal variation

329.Middleton, J. 1987. Measures of ecosystem disturbance and stress in landscapes dominated by
human activities. Pages 177-181. In: M.R. Moss, ed.  Landscape Ecology and Management.
Proceedings of the First Symposium of the Canadian Society for Landscape Ecology and Management,
held at the University of Guelph, May  1987. Polyscience Publications, Inc., Montreal.

From the point of view of an ecosystem ecologist, human activity  affects landscapes by imposing on
them a new regime of stress and disturbance. Thus by studying stress and disturbance in landscapes,
we may learn how our activities will affect any given landscape.  Ecologists have studied disturbance
for a long time, but there is no consensus on how such studies should proceed.  A recent compilation
of work in the field includes the following statement: "...although there is much  scattered information on
the subject of disturbance ... there is no compilation and synthesis of this information; nor is there any
work which develops a broad framework for theory incorporating disturbance and its effect".

This paper is  one illustration of a piece of research aimed at developing a theoretical framework for
understanding disturbance in ecosystems and is directed toward a practical method for measuring it.
The author discusses the need for a quantitative method for measuring ecosystem disturbance, and the
development of such an index is described.

330.Mlllard, S. 1987. Environmental monitoring, statistics, and the law: Room for improvement. Am.
Stat. 41:249-253.

Concerns over environmental degradation have led to legislation such as the Clean Water Act, the
Clean Air Act, the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act, and the Comprehensive Environmental
Response, Compensation, and Liability Act.  Federal and state laws have mandated the creation of
numerous monitoring  programs to ensure or determine the integrity of the environment. Unfortunately,
many of the resulting  monitoring programs shed little light on the questions that they were meant to
help answer because they are based on  poor environmental designs and a superficial knowledge of
statistics.  This article briefly discusses some past environmental monitoring designs and current
regulations for monitoring at hazardous waste sites. The deficiencies of many  monitoring  programs are
                                             95

-------
linked to the need to improve the status of the career category "statistician" in the sphere of the
environmental sciences.

Key Words: Environmental Protection Agency, Groundwater monitoring, Power, Sampling design,
Statistician, Type I error, Type II error

331.Miller, D.R. 1984. Distinguishing ecotoxic effects.  Pages 15-22. In: P. Sheehan, D. Miller, G. Butler,
and P. Bourdeau, eds. Effects of Pollutants at the Ecosystem Level. John Wiley & Sons, New York.

This chapter discusses the subjects related to ecotoxic effects: (1) nature of the problem, (2) identifying
parameters to monitor, (3) mathematical background, (4) estimating baseline level, and (5) detecting
change.

332.Miller, S.  1978. Federal environmental monitoring: Will the bubble burst? Environ. Sci. Technol.
12(12):1264-1269.

This article discusses the environmental monitoring situation  (primarily in reference to the U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency) as of the late 1970s.  It covers issues such as deficiencies in
monitoring, and quality assurance.

333.MIIIS, K., and D.  Schindler. 1986. Biological  indicators of lake acidification. Water Air  Soil Pollut.
30:779-789.

Indicator taxa are identified, based on both synoptic surveys  and whole lake  acidification experiments,
for lake acidification in the pH 6.0 to 5.0 range.  Acidobiontic diatoms (e.g., Asterionella ralfsii,
Fragillaria acidobiontica), periphyton (Mougeotia and related species), macroinvertebrates (e.g., Hyalella
azteca, Orconectes sp.), leeches and cyprinid fishes (e.g., Pimephales promelas and Notropis cornutus)
are identified as target organisms during early phases of lake acidification.

334.Milne, B.T.  1992. Indications of landscape condition at many scales. Pages 883-897. In: D.
McKenzie, D.E.  Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the International
Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in Ft. Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October 1990. Elsevier, Essex,
England.

Erosion, the birth and death of plants, and habitat selection by animals create patch shapes and spatial
distributions of mass,  density, and patch area that often lack characteristic length scales and therefore
display power-law behavior as a function of scale.  In such cases, fractal geometry provides a
mathematical framework for relating the finely detailed patterns of landscapes to coarse levels of
resolution. Variation in the fractal geometry of landscapes throughout the eastern United States is
related to  land use practices.  Measures of the fractal  aggregation of landscape cover types (1) are
used to detect disturbance or change at specified levels of resolution, (2) are used to map the
contribution that each point makes to the statistical properties of the entire pattern, (3) provide a basis
for simulation studies  of foraging in  complex landscapes,  and (4) imply  that source-sink relationships
are also scale-dependent. The measures indicate that each  point occurs in a unique scale-dependent
context. Consequently, species that have similar habitat requirements but that operate at different
scales (by virtue of differences in home range area) are likely to occupy different places in the
landscape. Multiple levels of resolution may be needed to assess the condition of landscapes in an
ecologically meaningful way.

335.Minns, C.K. 1992. Using technology to assess  regional environmental information. Environ. Monit.
Assess. 20:141-158.

Distinctions between holistic and prescriptive  technologies, and holistic and reductionist science are a
backdrop  to examination of two widespread environmental problems: eutrophication  of the  Bay of
Quinte, Lake Ontario, and acidification  of lakes in eastern Canada.  Evidence is presented on a shift
from prescriptive toward holistic approaches.  Holistic solutions to technological limitations  are
discussed with emphasis on the interactive procedures people use to solve problems, rather than on
                                               96

-------
the physical tools which are often employed in a prescriptive manner.  Local gathering and integration
of environmental information is presented as the key to macro-environmental assessments.
Recommendations stress (1) the need for ecologists in every ecosystem, (2) training with emphasis on
problem-solving techniques, (3) wide-spread use of microcomputers, a potent holistic technology, to
transfer information and concepts, and (4) local selection of indicators with the advice that they be
simple and biotic.

336.Mooney, H. 1991.  Biological response to climate change: An agenda for research. Ecol. Appl.
Our knowledge of the structure and the functioning of terrestrial ecosystems on a global scale is not
developed to a sufficient degree to understand — much less predict — the consequences of climate
change either on the systems themselves or on subsequent atmospheric interactions.  In many regards,
we have lagged behind the atmospheric scientists, and to a certain degree the oceanographers, in
establishing a global understanding of the dynamics of our respective systems.  This is partly because
of the inherently greater complexity of biotic systems, and the lack of appropriate tools to measure
regional biotic processes.  These tools are now becoming available and with them a better
understanding of terrestrial and atmospheric interactions  is developing.  Even  as these capabilities
become a reality, we must be realistic in recognizing that we have so far to go along the road to
understanding that useful predictive capacity may  elude us for a long time to come.

What we now need to do is act on the recommendations that have been emerging over the past few
years and develop a global program to document  more precisely the distribution, structure, and quantity
of the earth's biotic systems, their principal functional properties, and — most difficult of all — their
changing nature.  To do this we will have to (1) perfect some of the emerging new tools for assessing
these properties, (2) fill  some of the gaps in our knowledge about the relevant processes, and (3)
establish an international  network of long-term observations and large-scale ecosystem manipulations.
We have been aware of these needs and shortcomings for some time,  and we must move from plans
to concerted international action.

Key Words: Atmospheric  CO2, Global climate change, Large-scale experiments,  Plant productivity,
Species distribution, Terrestrial carbon exchange

337.Mooney, H., B. Drake, R. Luxmoore, W. Oechel, and L. Pitelka.  1991.  Predicting ecosystem
responses to elevated CO2 concentrations. Bioscience 41(2):96-104.

In this article, the authors indicate what can be predicted about the CO2 response of plants from
physiological measurements and what  has been learned  from field observations. They then show
results from direct tests of the CO2 response of whole ecosystems and  indicate the promise and
problems of these approaches, discuss the need for new ecosystem-level experiments and identify
some of the challenges. The response of plants and ecosystems to rising  atmospheric CO2 have been
reviewed previously.

338.Morgenstern, R., and S. Sessions.  1988. Weighing environmental risks: EPA's unfinished
business. Environment 30(6):14-17, 34-39.

This articles summarizes some of the issues in the Environmental Protection Agency report "Unfinished
business: A comparative assessment of environmental problems". It lists obstacles to priority setting,
describes in-house improvements regarding priority setting, and compares  how the public vs the
experts rate the severity of various environmental  problems.

339.Moriarty, F. 1988.  Ecotoxicology. Academic Press, New York.

This book contains chapters on population dynamics, communities, genetics of populations, effects on
individual organisms, prediction of ecological effects, and monitoring. Although the book generally
focuses on the lower levels of organization, a small section (pages 157-164) covers effects on
ecosystems.
                                              97

-------
340.Morrison, M. 1986. Bird populations as indicators of environmental change. Curr. Ornithol. 3:429-
451.

341.Mukhopadhyay, N., R.B. Bendel, N.P. Nikolaidas, and S. Chattopadhyay. 1992. Efficient
sequential sampling strategies for environmental monitoring. Water Resour. Res. 28(9):2245-2256.

Assessments of resources at risk to anthropogenic pollution require extensive environmental monitoring.
In addition, such assessments are required to have a long-term monitoring component in order to
evaluate not only the status but also the trend of the resources at risk to ecological stresses. There is
a need to identify statistical methodologies that would provide effective and cost-saving environmental
monitoring designs, since such monitoring surveys are very expensive. In this paper the purely
sequential,  accelerated sequential, and  three-stage procedures are evaluated as effective
fixed-precision sampling procedures for environmental monitoring. Current monitoring designs utilize a
sampling methodology where each resource is assigned a population inclusion probability, with the
intent of describing the distribution of the whole population  of resources at risk to anthropogenic
environmental stresses. This study assumes that existing designs accurately describe the population
distribution.  A simultaneous fixed-precision estimation procedure is developed as an efficient method
of estimating practically relevant percentiles of the cumulative distribution function, using water quality
data from the Eastern Lake Survey as a lake population distribution.  Accelerated sequential and
three-stage procedures are shown to be better alternatives to the purely sequential procedure,
requiring fewer sampling operations without any substantial loss of efficiency.  Depending upon the
precision required,  all procedures showed potential  reductions in sample size by as much as 60%.
These types of designs for environmental monitoring are expected to be advantageous in national
monitoring efforts toward the assessment of the status and trends of various ecological indicators.

342.Munkittrick, K. R.,  and D.G.  Dixon. 1989. A holistic approach to ecosystem health assessment
using fish population characteristics. Hydrobiologia 188/189:123-135.

The status of a fish population is a reflection of the  overall  condition of the aquatic environment in
which that population resides.  As such, fish population  characteristics can be used as indicators of
environmental health. Simple and inexpensive methods to follow fish population responses to
environmental degradation are lacking.  This paper outlines a protocol whereby environmental impacts
on fish populations are classified by five patterns based on characteristics such as mean age, fecundity,
and condition factor. The  patterns summarize population changes and describe responses  to
exploitation, recruitment failure, the presence of multiple stressors, food limitations, and niche shifts.
Classification is best based on the selection, and appropriate sampling, of a comparable reference
population.  Population characteristics can be used to examine ecosystems exposed to stressors for
evidence of long-term damage and, when used with biochemical indicators, can be a powerful tool for
ecosystem health assessment.  The five responses are  illustrated by using published data on a number
of species challenged by increased predation pressure,  acidification, eutrophication, mine waste, and
reservoir impoundment. Application of this scheme will  aid in directing and focusing research  efforts on
crucial aspects  affected by changing conditions.

Key Words: Ecosystem stress, Fish populations, Growth, Fecundity, Condition factor

343.Munn, R. 1988. The design of integrated monitoring systems to provide early indications of
environmental/ecological changes. Environ.  Monitor. Assess. 11:203-217.

One of the important goals of the next several decades  is to achieve and maintain ecologically
sustainable development of the biosphere. However, the management of ecological systems is rather
difficult, largely because of uncertainties in long-term predictions of environmental and ecological
behavior.  Thus, one of the objectives for integrated monitoring should be to provide early indications of
impending changes so that mitigative actions can be taken.

This paper includes a discussion of the factors to be considered in the design of early-warning
monitoring  systems, and gives some examples. One approach that appears to be particularly
                                               98

-------
promising is that of identifying, quantifying and monitoring the stresses, feedbacks and component lags
in the environmental/ecological system being studied.

344.Munn, R. 1992. Towards sustainable development. Atmos. Environ. 26A(15):2725-2731.

Sustainable development is a difficult phrase to define, particularly in the context of human ecosystems.
This article examines some of the notions behind sustainability. In rapidly changing environmental and
socio-economic situations, policies must be adopted that strengthen resilience and ecosystem integrity.
Some suggestions on appropriate indicators of ecosystem integrity are given in this paper but the
author states that these need considerable refinement.

Key Words: Sustainable development, Environmental policy, Resilience, Sustainability indicators

345.Nash, S. 1991. What price nature? — Future ecological risk assessments may chart the values,
and the odds. Bioscience 41(10):677-680.

Ecological risk assessment boils down to a scientific methodology for characterizing health or changes
in health in an ecological system.  This article provides a background on ecological risk assessment.
Subtopics are: Risk assessment as a political concern; Paradigm shifts; Valuation is vexing; How
economists value ecosystems; Contingent valuation problems; Science or money  criteria and; Valuation
projects under consideration.

346.National Academy of Sciences (NAS).  1975. Planning for environmental indices: A report to the
planning committee on environmental indices. NTIS No. PB 240971 (Available from National Technical
Information Service, Springfield, VA.). National Academy of  Sciences, Washington, DC.

This study examines the important multidisciplinary considerations related to environmental indices and
makes recommendations regarding their development.  The report includes examples of indices and a
short bibliography.

347.National Academy of Sciences (NAS).  1979. Animals as Monitors of Environmental Pollutants.
National Academy of Sciences, Washington, DC.

The Symposium on Pathobiology of Environmental Pollutants: Animal Models and Wildlife as Monitors
had the following goals: (1) to determine the extent to which environmental pollution can be
documented in wildlife, (2) to provide a common forum for pathologists, wildlife biologists, and
ecologists, who are studying environmental pollution from different perspectives, (3) to develop an
informational and bibliographic resource on this important aspect of animal biology, and (4) to generate
information that may be useful for legislators involved in fashioning contemporary  policy decisions
concerning the control of environmental pollution.

The proceedings are divided into sections on overview methodology, aquatic pollutants, heavy metals,
air pollution, and pesticide toxicity.

348.National Research Council. 1981. Testing for effects of chemicals on ecosystems.  Committee to
Review Methods for Ecotoxicology, National Research Council. NTIS No. PB 82127200 (Available from
National Technical Information Service, Springfield, VAJNational Academy Press, Washington, DC.

The discussion focuses primarily on chemical effects, although other stressors are considered,
especially when impacts are similar. This document is  an excellent source of references.  The authors
review chemical toxicity, various testing systems, assessment strategies, vulnerable ecological
parameters, and external factors. This book is aimed at identifying characteristics of  ecological systems
that would indicate hazardous effects of chemicals beyond the single species,  establishing criteria for
suitable testing schemes, and evaluating the effectiveness of available  test systems in assessing  effects
of chemicals within ecosystems.

(Note: This summary taken from American Management Systems, Inc., 1987)
                                              99

-------
349.Natlonal Research Council. 1990. Managing Troubled Waters: The Role of Marine Environmental
Monitoring. National Academy Press, Washington, DC. 125pp.

Although focusing on marine resources, this report contains significant information on general aspects
of environmental monitoring.  The committee for this report sought to: review the current status of
monitoring systems and technology, assess marine environmental monitoring as a component of sound
environmental management,  and identify needed improvements in monitoring strategies and practices.
Chapters include: The role of monitoring in environmental management, Strengthening regional and
national monitoring and, Designing and implementing monitoring programs.

350.National Science Foundation. 1979. Long-term ecological research — concept statement and
measurement needs: Summary of a workshop. June 25-27, 1979, Indianapolis. National Science
Foundation, Washington, DC. 27 pp.

351.National Science Foundation. 1977. Long-term ecological measurements: Report of a
conference. Woods Hole,  Massachusetts, March 16-18, 1977. National Science Foundation, Directorate
for Biological, Behavioral and Social Sciences, Division of Environmental Biology. Washington, DC.

352.Needham, R.D., ed. 1992. Special issue: Breaking the barriers to environmental information.
Environ. Monit. Assess. 20(2-3):83-271.

This special issue contains papers from a workshop held March 5-6, 1990 by the Institute for Research
on Environment and Economy, University of Ottawa.  The themes of the workshop were scientific,
technological, political, social, and institutional barriers to information in an era of mounting concern for
the health condition of the earth's ecosystems and biotic resources. Some papers briefly touch on the
concepts of indicators and environmental assessments while others covered topics ranging from the
impact of geographic information systems to making environmental information useful to the public to
the connections between environmental science and society.

353.Newman, J.R. 1975.  Animal Indicators of Air pollution: A Review and  Recommendations. Rep.
CERL-0006, Corvallis Environmental Research Laboratory. Environmental  Protection Agency, Corvallis,
OR.

354.Newman, J. 1979. Effects of industrial air pollution on wildlife. Biol. Conserv. 15:181-190.

Air pollution is a recognized health hazard for humans and domestic animals. Although industrial air
pollutants have  been known  to cause sickness and death of domestic animals for over  100 years,  little
attention has been paid to the importance of these contaminants in the decline of wildlife.  This paper
reviews the existing information  on the effects of industrial air pollutants on vertebrate wildlife. Air
pollutants have  had a worldwide effect on both wild birds and wild mammals, often causing marked
decreases in local animal populations. The major effects on industrial air pollution on wildlife include
direct mortality,  debilitating industrial-related injury and disease, physiological stress, anaemia, and
bioaccumulation.  Some air pollutants have caused a change in the distribution of certain wildlife
species.

355.Newman, J.R., and K.R. Schreiber. 1984. Animals  as indicators  of ecosystem responses to air
emissions. Environ.  Manage. 8(4):309-324.

With existing and proposed air quality regulations, ecological disasters resulting from air emissions such
as those observed at Copperhill, Tennessee, and Sudbury, Ontario, are unlikely.  Current air-quality
standards,  however, may not protect ecosystems from subacute and chronic exposure to air emissions.
The encouragement of the use of coal for energy production and the development of the fossil-fuel
industries, including oil shales, tar sands, and coal liquification, point to an increase and spread of
fossil-fuel emissions and the potential to influence a number  of natural ecosystems.  This  paper reviews
the reported responses of ecosystems to airborne pollutants  and discusses the use of animals as
indicators of ecosystem responses to these pollutants. Animal species and populations can act as
important indicators of biotic  and abiotic responses of aquatic and terrestrial ecosystems.  These
                                              100

-------
responses can indicate long-term trends in ecosystem health and productivity, chemical cycling,
genetics, and regulation. For short-term trends, fish and wildlife also serve as monitors of changes in
community structure, signaling food-web contamination as well as providing a measure of ecosystem
vitality.  Information is presented to show not only the importance of animals as indicators of ecosystem
responses to air-quality degradation, but also their value as air-pollution indices, that is, as air-quality-
related values (AQRV), which are required in current air-pollution regulation.

Key Words: Animals, Indicators, Air pollution, Ecosystem responses

356.Nielsen, N.O. 1992. Ecosystem health and veterinary medicine.  Can. Vet. J. 33:23-26.

Application of the health paradigm to the environment immediately suggests an  array of approaches
and mechanisms that have proven successful in promoting human, animal, and plant health. It also
provides a logical framework in which veterinary medicine's interest in wildlife, toxicology, and
epidemiology can be more effective. The article begins by defining "health" and environmental health.
Subtopics are: ecosystems and the health paradigm; animals as monitors of ecosystem health;
sustainable agriculture, farming systems, and epidemiology; toxicology; and veterinarians and the need
for an ecosystem health professional.

357.Nllsson, J. 1980. Early warning signals of acidification. Page 344. In: D. Drablos and A. Tollan,
eds. Ecological Impact of Acid Precipitation: Proceedings of an  International Conference. Sandefjord,
Norway, March 11-14, 1980. SNSF Project, Oslo.

358.Nilsson, J., and E. Cowling. 1992. A comparison of some national assessments. Pages 463-517.
In: T. Schneider, ed. Acidification Research: Evaluation and Policy Applications. Elsevier Science
Publishers, Amsterdam.

359.Norton, B. 1991. Ecological health and sustainable resource management. Pages 102-117. In: R.
Costanza, ed. Ecological Economics: The Science and Management  of Sustainability. Columbia
University Press, New York.

A contextual approach to environmental management requires a distinction between "resource
management," the management of a resource-producing cell  such  as a field or fishery, and
"environmental management," which involves concern for the larger systems which environ those cells.
Mainstream natural resource economics defines sustainability mainly  by reference to undiminished
outputs of economically marketable products and emphasizes productivity criteria in judging
management regimes.  This approach  is appropriate in many cases for guiding "resource management"
but, taken alone, it provides no guidance regarding  the protection of the larger, environmental context
of resource-producing activities.

Aldo Leopold, and most environmentalists following him, have applied a contextual approach in which
resource-producing cells are understood as larger, slower-changing (but still dynamic) ecological
systems.  According to this approach, "resource management" should be limited when resource-
producing activities approach a threshold beyond which they  alter larger systems and instigate  rapid
change in environing systems. Metaphorically, this  result is referred to as "illness"  in the ecological
community, but the rules and criteria for describing  these limits have never been stated precisely in
ecological terms. A definition of "ecosystem health," based on biologically formulated criteria for
judging larger ecological systems, will be proposed  and integrated  into a hierarchical approach  to
environmental management.

360.Norton, B. 1992. In Press. Sustainability,  human welfare, and ecosystem health. Environ. Values.

This article discusses the need for environmentalists, scientists, and philosophers to develop, explain,
and justify a theory of environmental practice that gives form  and specificity to the goal of sustainability.
The author sketches two approaches to understanding sustainability.  The article is divided into four
sections: Sustainability and Human Welfare; A Classification of Risk; Scientific Contextualism; and
Health, Integrity, and Sustainability.
                                              101

-------
361.Norton, D., D. Muchoney, and E. Slonecker. 1990. Ecological monitoring using remote sensing
supported GIS. In: Technical Papers—1990 ACSM-ASPRS Annual Convention, Volume 4. American
Congress on Surveying and Mapping, Falls Church, VA.

362.Norton, D.J., and E.T. Slonecker. 1990. Landscape characterization: The ecological geography of
EMAP. Geolnfo Syst. 1(0): 32-43.

The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has initiated the Environmental Monitoring and
Assessment Program (EMAP), a long-range program to monitor status and trends in the condition of
our nation's  major ecological resources.  EMAP's spatial design borrows from classical geographic
thought, past and present, and the program will use geographic information systems (GIS) technology
to characterize ecological resources and  assess environmental problems.  EMAP will collect data using
a national, systematic sampling grid and a hierarchical approach of monitoring conditions concurrently
at multiple scales of detail.  EMAP will apply the concept of landscape characterization to document, at
coarse levels,  the composition and pattern of land cover, land use, and other attributes of surficial
terrain structure.   These data will be compiled using multistage remote sensing and will be stored  and
analyzed in a GIS data base along with a variety of existing spatial data sets.  Concurrently, field
monitoring groups will measure indicators of ecological condition for wetlands, forests, arid lands,
surface waters, near-coastal  waters, and  agroecosystems.

This article describes EMAP's landscape characterization approach and discusses  the growing role of
GIS technology in national ecological  monitoring.

363.Norton, D., and E. Slonecker. 1990. The Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program's
landscape characterization database — New opportunities in spatial analysis. Pages 682-690. In:
GIS/LIS '90  - Technical Papers.  Geographic Information Systems/Land Information Systems Annual
Conference, Anaheim, Ca. American Congress  on  Surveying and Mapping, Falls Church, VA.

364.Norton, S., D. Rodier, J. Gentile W. Van  der Schalie, W. Wood, and M. Slimak. 1992. A
framework for  ecological risk assessment at the EPA. Environ. Toxicol. Chem. 11(12):1663-1672.

Ecological risk assessments  evaluate the likelihood of adverse ecological effects caused by stressors
related to human activities such as draining of wetlands or release of chemicals. The term stressor is
used to describe any chemical, physical,  or biological entity that can induce adverse effects on
ecological components (i.e., individuals, populations, communities, or ecosystems).  In this review
article, a historical perspective on ecological risk assessment activities at the U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency (EPA)  is followed by a discussion of the EPA's "Framework Report", which describes
the basic elements for conducting an  ecological risk assessment.  The "Framework Report" is neither a
procedural guide  nor a regulatory requirement within the EPA. Rather, it is intended to foster a
consistent approach to ecological risk assessments within the agency, identify key  issues and define
terminology.

365,Noss, R.F. 1990.  Indicators for monitoring  biodiversity—a hierarchical approach. Conserv. Biol.
4(4):355-364.

Biodiversity  is  currently only  a minor consideration in environmental policy. It has been regarded as too
broad  and vague a concept to be applied to real-world regulatory and management problems.  This
problem  can be corrected if biodiversity is recognized as an end in itself, and if measurable indicators
can be selected to assess the status of biodiversity over time.  Biodiversity, as currently understood,
encompasses  multiple levels of  biological organization.  In this paper, the author expands the three
primary attributes of biodiversity recognized by  Jerry Franklin - composition, structure, and function -
into a  nested hierarchy that incorporates elements of each attribute at four levels of organization:
regional  landscape, community-ecosystem, population-species,  and genetic.  Indicators of each attribute
in terrestrial ecosystems,  at the  four levels of organization, are identified for environmental monitoring
purposes.  Projects to monitor biodiversity will benefit from a direct linkage to long-term ecological
research and a commitment to test hypotheses relevant to biodiversity conservation.  A general
guideline is  to proceed from  the top down,  beginning with a coarse-scale inventory of landscape-
                                              102

-------
pattern, vegetation, habitat structure, and species distributions, and overlaying data on stress levels to
identify biologically significant areas at high risk of impoverishment. Intensive research and monitoring
can be directed to high-risk ecosystems and elements of biodiversity, while less intensive monitoring is
directed to the total landscape (or samples thereof).  In any monitoring program, particular attention
should be paid to specifying the questions that monitoring is intended to answer and validating the
relationships between indicators and the components of biodiversity they represent.

366.Novak, E., D. Porcella, K. Johnson, and E. Herricks. 1985. Selection of test methods to assess
ecological effects of mixed aerosols. Ecotoxicol. Environ. Saf.  10:361-381.

Components of mixed aerosols generated during military training are known to be of toxicological
and/or ecological significance. There are few studies, however, that quantify mixed aerosol effects
and/or ecological significance. Prompted by the finding that one or more of the compounds in the
mixed  aerosols commonly encountered in military training areas showed mutagenic effects in several
species, a multiyear effort is under way to evaluate the use of ecotoxicity testing methods to assess
mixed  aerosol ecological impacts. Selection of test methods for ecoepidemiology begins with the
identification of the data required to meet defined environmental quality objectives. The data
requirements are then matched with appropriate test methods, and testing results are related to
important ecological effects resulting from aerosol exposure. The critical element of test system
selection is to ensure that toxicity testing results relate to important ecological effects.  The procedures
developed for identifying test methods to asses  mixed aerosols are also applicable to a range of
environmental contaminants regulated by air, water, and solid waste regulations.

367.NSEPB.  1985. The National  Swedish Environmental Monitoring Programme (PMK). Research and
Development Department, Environmental Monitoring Section. National Environmental Protection Board,
Solna,  Sweden.

368.O'Conner, J.S.,  and D. Flemer. 1987. Monitoring, research, and management: Integration for
decision making in coastal marine environments. Pages 70-90. In: T. Boyle, ed. New Approaches to
Monitoring Aquatic Ecosystems. ASTM STP 940. American Society for Testing and Materials,
Philadelphia.

A rationale is presented for making  research and monitoring interdependent to maximize the
contributions of both  activities to environmental management.  Emphasis is placed on making better
choices of temporal and spatial scales of marine assessments, thereby improving managerial guidance
from monitoring and research. Although the choice of appropriate scales is a function of particular
environmental issues, the most useful scales "in the mean"  appear to be long-term (including truly
historical) and regional. The likelihood in the near-term of only limited incremental advances in
understanding ecosystem processes, with marginal improvements in predictability, leads to an argument
for more emphasis on the use of managerially helpful, necessarily simple models.  One such model is
presented to characterize the geographical prevalence of fin erosion in winter flounder
(Pseudopleuronectes americanus), relative to sources of probable causes, from Canada to Delaware
Bay. Changing emphasis from laboratory  bioassays to field population-level effects is an important and
essential step toward integrating ecosystem-level knowledge into the managerial and regulatory milieu.

It is now possible to quantify the geographic and,  at least recent, temporal associations among human
waste sources and some  of their biological effects. Further elaboration of the current understanding of
source-fate-effects with the  help of simple models (for example,  indices) is often more useful to
managers than  is detailed piecemeal quantification of seemingly intractable ecosystem dynamics.

Key Words: Chesapeake  Bay, New York region, Monitoring, Waste management, Marine ecosystems,
Marine resources, Indices, Environmental quality

369.Odemerno, F., and B.  Chokor. 1991. An aggregate index of environmental-quality. Appl. Geogr.
                                              103

-------
In recent times, conflicts have arisen over how the quality of an environment may be appropriately
assessed.  In particular, the dichotomy between professional and lay assessments of environmental
quality has posed a major problem, not only to the interpretation of quality but also to environmental
management practices, especially in the third world. This study, therefore, seeks to present a more
balanced assessment of quality by combining both professional and lay viewpoints to produce an
aggregate index of environmental quality by using the example of Benin City, Nigeria.  Data sets
reflecting both viewpoints were factor analyzed, and the major dimensions of judgement by each group
were weighted and combined into an aggregate index. The findings of the study show a spatial
disparity of quality in  Benin City between the urban core districts and the suburbs that seems to reflect
local environmental problems facing the people of typical third-world cities. It is argued that the
neighborhood aggregate index provides a meaningful guide to planners in allocating resources to reflect
spatial disparities existing between neighborhoods.  Furthermore, real estate businesses and
developers, as well as those relocating, may benefit from a more accurate and balanced quality picture
of the neighborhoods.
370.Odum, E.P. 1981.  The effects of stress on the trajectory of ecological succession. Pages 43-47. In:
G.W. Barrett and R. Rosenberg, eds. Stress Effects on Natural Ecosystems. John Wiley & Sons,
Chichester, England.

It is well known that the response of biotic communities to  perturbations varies with the stage in their
development  (i.e., the stage in ecological succession). For example, Miller and McNaughton found that
an application of commercial fertilizer resulted in an  increase in net productivity in a 7-year-old-field but
not in seventeen-year-old-field, which proved to be resistant to this particular perturbation.  Woodwell
has reported that the various stages of succession, specifically old fields  and forests, differ in their
capacity to assimilate treated sewage wastes. Other examples could be cited.  The purpose of this
article is to suggest a working hypothesis for predicting the response of the sere (i.e.,  the successional
sequence as  a whole) to stress.

Subtopics covered in this article include: definitions,  a systems approach, optimality, and allogenic vs
autogenic causes.

371.Odum, E. 1985.  Trends expected  in stressed ecosystems. Bioscience 35:419-422.

When certain ecosystems are not suffering from unusual external perturbations, we observe certain
well-defined developmental trends.  Because disturbance tends to arrest, or even reverse, these
autogenic developments, we can anticipate some ecosystem responses to stress. Trends expected in
stressed ecosystems include changes in energetics, nutrient cycling, and community structure and
function.

372.Odum, E., and J. Cooley. 1980. Ecosystem profile analysis and performance curves as tools for
assessing environmental impact.  Pages 94-102. In: Biological Evaluation of Environmental Impacts.
Proceedings of a symposium at the 1976 meeting of the Ecological Society of  America. Biological
Services Program, FWS/OBS-80/26, June 1980. U.S. Department of the  Interior, Washington, DC.

The authors suggest that pictorial and  graphic models provide the logical procedure intermediary
between the piecemeal and holistic assessments of environmental impact. A table showing five general
areas of aquatic condition is also presented comparing factor-level measurements (standing states) with
ecosystem-level measurements (dynamic states).

373.Odum, E. P., J.T.  Finn, and E.H.  Franz. 1979. Perturbation theory and the subsidy-stress
gradient. Bioscience  29(6):349-352.

Human impact on the environment often involves a gradient of subsidy and stress effects, which vary
along nutrient, climatic, developmental (successional), and other important ecological gradients.
Because performance curves that simulate subsidy-stress  responses are unimodal,  the zone of
optimality can be determined on the basis of relatively few experiments in which specific input  factors
are of concern. The authors emphasize the importance of assessing the response of the perturbed
system at different levels of organization. In practice, at least two levels, the ecosystem and the
                                              104

-------
population (species) level, are necessary for a complete impact evaluation.  The authors stress the
need for judicious use of terms and the desirability of sticking as closely as  possible to basic definitions
if one expects to communicate with large numbers of people.

374.Offlce of Health and Environmental Research (OHER). 1988. Terrestrial biosphere response to
large-scale environmental change. Proposed initiative, OHER, Ecological Research Division. United
States Department of Energy, Washington, DC. October.

375.Ojima, D., T. Klttel, and T. Ross wall. 1991. Critical issues for understanding global change effects
on terrestrial  ecosystems. Ecol. Appl. 1(3):316-325.

Marked alterations in Earth's environment have already been observed, and these presage even
greater changes as the impact of human activities (i.e. land use and industrial) increases. Direct and
indirect feedbacks link terrestrial ecosystems with  global change and include interaction affecting fluxes
of water, energy, nutrients, and "greenhouse" gases and ecosystem structure and composition.
Community development can affect ecosystem dynamics by altering resource partitioning among biotic
components and through changes in structural characteristics, thereby affecting feedbacks to global
change. The response of terrestrial ecosystems to the climate-weather system is dependent on the
spatial scale  of the interactions between these systems and the temporal scale that links the various
components.

The International Geosphere-Biosphere Program (IGBP), which was initiated by the International
Council of Scientific Unions (ICSU) in 1986, has undertaken to develop a research plan to address a
predictive understanding of how terrestrial ecosystems will  be affected by global changes in  the
environment and possible feedbacks. The IGBP science plan, which incorporates established  Core
Projects and  activities related to research on terrestrial ecosystem linkages  to global change, includes
the International Global Atmospheric Chemistry Project (IGAC); the Biosphere Aspects of the
Hydrological Cycle (BAHC); the Global  Change and Terrestrial Ecosystems  (GCTE); Global Analysis,
Integration, and Modelling (GAIM); IGBP Data and Information System (DIS); and  IGBP Regional
Research Centers (RRC).  The coupling of research and policy communities for the purpose of
developing mechanisms to adapt to these impending changes urgently needs to be established.

Key Words: Global change, IGBP (International Geosphere-Biosphere Program), Terrestrial ecosystems

376.Olsen, A.R., ed. 1992. The Indicator Development Strategy for the Environmental Monitoring and
Assessment Program.  EPA/600/3-91/023. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency Environmental
Research Laboratory, Corvallis, OR.

This document provides an overview of EMAP, discusses the role of indicators in EMAP, and outlines a
strategy for indicator development and  evaluation within EMAP. Its objectives are twofold: (1) to
present general guidelines, criteria, and procedures for indicator selection and evaluation, and  (2) to
establish an organizational framework for coordinating and  integrating indicator development and use
within EMAP.  It should serve both to promote internal consistency among EMAP resource groups and
to provide a basis for internal and external review  of proposed EMAP indicators.

377.Omernlk, J.M., and G.E. Griffith.  1991. Ecological regions versus  hydrologic units: Frameworks
for managing water quality. J. Soil Water Conserv.  46(5):334-340.

By using inappropriate spatial frameworks, some assessments may actually do more to obscure the
nature and extent of a water quality problem than to clarify  it. Spatial frameworks  based on  ecological
regions often  can be more useful for assessing the health of aquatic ecosystems than can frameworks
based only on hydrologic units, drainage basins, or administrative or political units.  Methods of defining
the spatial extent of specific water quality problems or components require a similar, although specially
tailored, synoptic approach.

This article reviews the  background of frameworks, provides a comparison of frameworks (national
scale, state/regional scale), and proposes a more logical framework.
                                             105

-------
378.O'Neill, R., D. DeAngelis, J. Waide, and T. Allen.  1986. A Hierarchical Concept of Ecosystems.
Princeton University Press, Princeton, NJ. 253 pp.

This book reassesses and critiques current concepts of ecosystems and provides a historical view of
how ecologists have viewed ecosystems.  Chapters discuss functional vs structural analyses and the
application of hierarchy theory to ecological analysis. The book thus provides a discourse on the
problems associated with comparing effects on "state variables" (indicators) at lower ecological levels
with higher ecological  levels.

379.O'Neill, R., B. Ausmus, D. Jackson, R. Van Hook, P. Van Vorls, C.  Washburne, and A.
Watson. 1977. Monitoring terrestrial ecosystems by analysis of nutrient export. Water Air Soil Poll.
8:271-277.

Current methodology for environmental impact assessment relies heavily on population parameters to
detect ecological effects of perturbation. The authors believe that recent advances in ecosystem
analysis permit the identification of monitoring points that reflect changes in the total system.  Focusing
on mechanisms of ecosystem homeostasis, the authors  suggest soil nutrient loss as a sensitive, holistic
measure of ecological effects.  In three separate studies, attempts were made to detect the effects of
toxic substances by monitoring relevant population parameters.  In each case, disturbance could be
detected in nutrient cycling, but no significant change was evident in the population/community
parameters. These results indicate that indices of total ecosystem function may be feasible.

380.O'Neill, R., R. Gardner, L.W. Barnthouse, G.W. Suter II, S.G. Hildebrand,  and C.W. Gehrs.
1982. Ecosystem risk  assessment: A new methodology. Environ. Toxicol. Chem. 1:167-177.

A method is presented for extrapolating laboratory toxicity data to aquatic ecosystem effects such as
decreased productivity or reduction in gamefish biomass. The extrapolation requires translating
laboratory data into changes in the parameters of an ecosystem model, the Standard  Water Column
Model (SWACOM). The translation is effected through knowledge of lexicological modes of action.
The uncertainties associated with both laboratory measurements and extrapolations are explicitly
retained, and risk estimates are given in the form of probabilities that an effect could occur.  The
approach is illustrated by scenarios in which effects of toxic substances are distributed across different
trophic levels.  Each scenario affects different population interactions in different ways and alters both
the level and the nature of the risks to the ecosystem processes.  Particular attention  is paid to
analyzing the interaction between toxicity and the uncertainties associated  with extrapolation.

Key Words: Gamefish Biomass, SWACOM, Aquatic ecosystems, Risk analysis, Organic

381.O'Neill, R., C. Hunsaker, and D. Levine. 1992. Monitoring challenges and innovative ideas. Pages
1443-1460. In: D. McKenzie, D.E.  Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of
the International  Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October.
Elsevier, Essex,  England.

Monitoring programs are difficult to design even when they focus on specific problems, such as water
quality in a particular body of water. Ecosystems are complex, and it is difficult to predetermine what
aspects of system structure or dynamics will respond to a particular insult.   It is equally difficult to
interpret whether a response is a stabilizing compensatory mechanism or a real loss of capacity to
maintain the ecosystem.  The problems are compounded in broad monitoring programs designed to
assess ecosystem "health" at regional and continental scales.  It is challenging in the extreme to
monitor ecosystem response, at any scale, to past insults, as well as to an unknown future array of
impacts.

The challenge can be illustrated by problems in data interpretation.  When  indicators are remeasured
after 5 to 10 years, some values will have changes.  Does the change indicate a trend or normal
fluctuations? Stochastic fluctuations in weather can account for many short-term changes.  A number of
ecological phenomena, such as predator-prey cycles, are known to fluctuate normally over 3- to 100-
year cycles.  Reliable evidence of trends requires monitoring over a long period of time.  Likens showed
                                              106

-------
that 20 years of continuous records were needed at Hubbard Brook to determine statistically significant
trends in watershed geochemistry.  Goldman showed that 15 years of secchi disc readings were
needed at Lake Tahoe to establish a statistically significant reduction in transparency.  Only these
extended data sets allow unambiguous association of a change in an indicator measurement to an
ecosystem trend.

However, in spite of the challenge, systematic monitoring is critically needed to balance anecdotal
information. Every warm summer,  everyone is sure that global warming has started.  However, it is
clear that we have not been measuring weather long enough to be able to characterize all of the
normal trends.  Nevertheless, the newspaper and television media jump on every short-term trend as
evidence of monotonic change. Systematic monitoring with statistically valid designs is needed to
produce reliable indicators of trends.

The present paper will examine some of the fundamental issues and challenges raised by large-scale
monitoring efforts. The challenges will serve as a framework and as an excuse to discuss several
important topics in more detail.  Following the discussion of challenges, the author suggests some basic
innovations that could be important across a broad scope of monitoring programs. The innovations
include holistic  measures, innovative  methodology, and creative analysis.

382.Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development. 1991. Environmental indicators.
Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development, Paris.

This publication provides a preliminary set  of environmental indicators by which to measure
environmental performance.  Twenty-five indicators are described along side statistics and tables. The
indicators are: CO2 emissions, greenhouse gas emissions, SOX emissions, NOX emissions, use of water
resources, river quality, wastewater treatment, land use changes, protected areas, use of nitrogenous
fertilizers, use of forest resources, trade in  tropical wood, threatened species, fish catches, waste
generation, municipal  generation, industrial accidents, public opinion, growth of economic activity,
energy intensity, energy supply, industrial production, transport trends, private final consumption, and
population.

383.Orians, G.H. 1990. Ecological  concepts of sustainability. Environment 32(9):10-15 and 34-39.

This paper discusses issues associated with different views of sustainability and includes topics such as
limits to sustainable use, valued ecosystem components, old-growth forests as a  case study, and policy
making for sustainability. Factors affecting sustainability such as predator-prey interactions, mutualistic
interactions, species richness, and aesthetic limits are also  discussed.

384.Oriordon, T.  1991. Towards a vernacular science of environmental change. Pages 149-162. In: L
Roberts and A.  Weale, eds. Innovation and Environmental Risk. Belhaven Press, London.

385.Ott, W.  1978. Environmental Indices: Theory  and Practice. Ann Arbor Science Publishers,  Ann
Arbor,  Ml.

In the 1960s and  1970s, many indices and statistical approaches for interpreting and presenting
information on the state of the environment have been developed. The author has attempted to bring
together, in a systematic fashion, all existing environmental index systems, along with principles for
their design, application, and structure.  Chapter I introduces the reader to environmental data,
presenting simple communicative approaches such as environmental quality profiles. The language
and role of indices are also discussed.  Chapter II presents a framework that is designed to embrace
nearly  all existing  environmental indices, allowing  the behavior of different index structures to be
compared and probed in detail.  Additional  chapters cover air and water pollution indices. The final
section is devoted to conceptual approaches to quality-of-life indices and also discusses other indices
involving noise,  total environment, and species diversity.

386.Ovlatt, C.,  M. Pilson, and S. Nixon. 1984. Recovery of a polluted estuarine  system: A mesocosm
experiment.  Mar. Ecol. Prog. Ser. 16:203-217.
                                              107

-------
387.Paoletti, M., M. Favretto, B. Stlnner, and F. Purrington. 1991. Invertebrates as bioindicators of
soil use. Agric. Ecosyst. Environ. 34: 341-362.

We face an increasing demand from administrative, technical, and environmental authorities to use
bioindicators—animals, plants, and community patterns that register quantitative and qualitative
environmental changes. Such monitoring can range from simple chemical and physical sampling to
quantifying the patterns of animal and plant communities.  These techniques for analyzing soil
communities were first developed for aquatic systems.  Protozoans, earthworms, woodlice, myriapods,
Acari, springtails, and other groups of invertebrates seem to respond to chemical residues and other
environmental stresses in many different ways. Although a rich literature on interactions is available,
only limited information exists on community-level responses and little is known of the food-chain level
responses in the soil. Research is needed to find appropriate  patterns that could model different
situations.

388.Parker,  J. 1991. Environmental assessment—2 conferences on environmental indicators and
Indexes. Environment 33(5):41-43.

This article briefly describes EMAP, and explains the need for environmental indicators and
assessments of the "state of the environment." The majority of the article provides brief descriptions of
the types of  papers presented at two conferences: the 1st International  Symposium on Ecological
Indicators (Ft. Lauderdale, October, 1990), and the Workshop on Indicators  and Indices for
Environmental Impact Assessment and Risk Analysis (Ispra, Italy, May, 1990). The difference between
an indicator and an index is also noted.

389.Parker,  J., and C. Hope. 1992. The state of the environment: A survey of reports from around the
world. Environment 34(1): 18-20,39-45.

This article presents a preliminary list of the current State of the Environment  Reports  (SERs) from
around the world.  SERs are comprehensive sets of statistics on the quality of a country's environment.
The article also discusses SERs and the public, the U.N. Conference on Environment  and
Development, and difficulties with SERs.

390.Parr, J., R. Papendick, S.  Hornick, and R. Meyer. 1992. Soil quality: Attributes and relationship to
alternative and sustainable  agriculture. Am. J. Altern. Agric. 7(1-2):5-11.

Different chemical, physical, and biological properties of a soil interact in complex ways that determine
its potential fitness or capacity to produce healthy and nutritious crops.  The integration of these
properties and the resulting level of productivity often is referred to as "soil quality."  Soil quality should
not be limited to soil productivity, but should encompass environmental quality, human and animal
health, and food safety and quality. There is inadequate reliable information on how changes in soil
quality directly affect food quality, or indirectly affect human and animal health.  In characterizing soil
quality, biological properties have received less emphasis than chemical and physical properties,
because their effects are difficult to measure, predict, or quantify. Improved soil quality often is
indicated by increased  infiltration, aeration, macropores, aggregate size, aggregate stability, and soil
organic  matter, and by decreased bulk density, soil resistance, erosion, and nutrient runoff.  These are
useful, but future research should seek to identify and quantify reliable and  meaningful
biological/ecological indicators of soil quality, such as total species diversity or genetic diversity of
beneficial soil microorganisms, insects, and  animals. Because these biological/ecological indexes of
soil are  dynamic, they will require effective monitoring and assessment programs to develop appropriate
databases for research and technology transfer. We need to know how such indexes are affected by
management inputs, whether they can serve as early warning indicators of soil degradation, and how
they relate to the sustainability of agricultural systems.

Key Words:  Global change, Soil erosion, Soil degradation

391.Parzyck, D.,  R. Brocksen, and W. Emanuel.  1980. Regional analysis  and environmental impact
assessment. Pages 114-121. In: Biological Evaluation of Environmental Impacts. Proceedings of a
                                               108

-------
symposium at the 1976 meeting of the Ecological Society of America. FWS/OBS-80/26. U.S.
Department of the Interior, Fish and Wildlife Service, Washington, DC.

This paper presents a number of techniques that can be used to assess environmental impacts on a
regional scale.  Regional methodologies have been developed that examine impacts on aquatic and
terrestrial biota in regions through  consideration of changes in land use, land cover, air quality, water
resource use, and water quality. Techniques used to assess long-range atmospheric transport, water
resources, effects on sensitive forest and animal species, and impacts on humans are presented in this
paper, along with an optimization approach that serves to integrate the analytical techniques in an
overall assessment framework.

This paper on assessment techniques is meant to provide a brief review of the research approach  and
certain modeling techniques used within one regional studies program. Although it is not an all-
inclusive report on regional analyses, it does illustrate the types of analyses that can be performed on a
regional scale.

392.Paul, J.,  F. Holland, K. Scott, D. Flemer, and E. Meier. 1989. An ecological status and trends
program: EPA's approach to monitoring the condition of the nation's ecosystems. Pages 579-664. In:
Oceans '89. Vol. 2. Proceedings of a conference held September 18-21, 1989 in Seattle, WA. IEEE
Pub. No. 89CH 2780-5. Ocean Engineering Society of the Institute of Electric and Electronic Engineers.


The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) is  initiating an Environmental Monitoring and
Assessment Program (EMAP) to monitor the status and trends of the nation's near-coastal waters,
forests, freshwater wetlands, surface waters, and agroecosystems. This program is also intended to
evaluate the effectiveness of Agency policies at protecting ecological resources in these systems.
Monitoring data collected for all ecosystems will be integrated for national status and trends
evaluations.

The near-coastal component of EMAP will consist of four ecosystem categories: estuaries, wetlands,
coastal waters, and Great Lakes.  Near-coastal ecosystems will be regionalized and classified, an
integrated sampling strategy designed,  and quality assurance/quality control procedures and data base
management  procedures implemented. A pilot study will be conducted in one region of the country,
followed by a full-scale national implementation.

393.Paul, J.F., A.F. Holland, J.K.  Summers, S.C. Schimmel, and K.J. Scott. 1991. EPA's
Environmental Assessment and Monitoring Program: An  ecological status and trends program. Pages
80-99. In: D. Chapman, F. Bishay,  E. Power, K. Hall, L. Harding, D. McLeay, M. Nassichuck, and W.
Knapp, eds. Proceedings of the Seventeenth Annual Aquatic Toxicity Workshop.  Held November 5-7,
1990, Vancouver, BC. Canadian Technical Report of Fisheries and Aquatic  Sciences No. 1774.

394.Peichl, L., and D. Relml. 1990.  Bioprobes: Biological-effect test systems for the early recognition
of unexpected environmental changes.  Environ. Monitor. Assess. 15:1-12.

Pre-marketing assessments of chemicals regarding their  potential environmental impacts contain
numerous sources of error and uncertainties.  Practices and methods for the evaluation of
environmental risks posed by individual pre-selected agents seem unsuitable for detecting unexpected
trends in the environment.  This is  particularly so in view of the multitude of anthropogenic assaults on
the environment and their complex interactions. Therefore, requirements for symptom-oriented
biological effect-test systems, 'bioprobes', capable of reacting sensitively to environmental changes of
unknown origin were conceived.  Bioprobes designed to detect biological effects should respond to a
broad spectrum of anthropogenic chemicals. They are environmental quality measuring devices
consisting of cultivated organisms,  cells, organelles or biomolecules in combination with recording units.
In contrast to  traditional biotests for chemical testing, bioprobes are deliberately exposed  to selected
segments of the environment for certain periods of time.  During and after such exposures, changes of
defined biological states or process rates - "observation elements" - are registered.
                                             109

-------
395.Perkins, R. 1974. Stress and its relation to the ecosystem. Int. J. Ecol. Environ. Sci. 1:119-127.

Quantification of environmental stress by using species diversity indices has had only limited success.
By using a definition of stress that is compatible with ecology and by incorporating ecosystem function
into an environmental stress index, a new measure of environmental stress is proposed. Comparison
of eight ecosystems, representing a gradient from harsh to mild environments, demonstrates the validity
of an index based on ecosystem  parameters rather than on population parameters.  A stress index may
be a useful component in ecosystem models and in evaluation of resource management practices.

396.Perry, D., and J. Borchers.  1990. Climate change and ecosystem responses. Northwest Environ.
J. 6(2):293-313.

In this paper the authors briefly review current knowledge concerning the possible consequences of a
changing climate for terrestrial ecosystems.  Forests and grasslands of western North America figure
prominently  in the discussion, but the intent  of the authors is to consider general principles rather than
specific communities.  Nevertheless, these principles are applicable to the fate and management of old-
growth forests.  First, the authors review the current climate-change scenarios and their implications for
plant growth and physiology. Next, they consider the severity and frequency of disturbances such as
fire, insect outbreaks, and windstorms. The authors then  turn to the possible net effect of climate
change on ecosystems, an effect that emerges from numerous interactions and feedback processes
and is greatly affected by the speed with which species migrate.  Finally, they discuss some
approaches  for mitigating possible impacts and for easing transitions from one community type to
another.

397.Perry, J., D. Scnaeffer, and E. Herrlcks. 1987. Innovative designs for water quality monitoring:
Are we  asking the right questions before the data are collected? Pages 28-39. In: T. Boyle, ed. New
Approaches to Monitoring Aquatic Ecosystems.  American Society for Testing and Materials,
Philadelphia.

Water quality management consists of decisions about the environment; those decisions are usually
based on data from monitoring programs. Such data are usually collected following a design that is
governed by "bureaucratic risk," that is, the perceived risk of ire by a superior. The authors propose
the application of a systematic process called the Environmental Audit as  a tool for guiding
management decision making and for designing monitoring programs.  Application of the audit is shown
to produce data that leads directly to real environmental information (in contrast to pure data). Such
information is translated into management decisions that incorporate all elements of the broad definition
of environmental risk.

Key Words:  Data management, Environmental audit, Environmental risk, Monitoring, Water quality
management

398.Perry, J.A., N. Troelstrup, Jr., M. Newsom, and B. Shelley. 1987. Whole ecosystem
manipulation experiments: The search for generality. Water Sci. Technol.  19(11):55-71.

The objective of this paper is to summarize  population and community-level responses observed during
two recent whole-ecosystem manipulations and then to examine those results in light of the literature.
The authors address the  question: "Are there generalities in the ways that structure and/or function
respond to experimentally imposed stresses?"

Based on these ideas, the authors hypothesized that there should be some  degree of generality in the
ways that ecosystems respond to stress and that the degree of generality should be quantifiable.
Specifically, they hypothesized that (1) community structure variables should be  less resistant to a
given stress than should  community function variables and (2) a given property or process should
respond with the same quality (direction of change) and the same relative quantity (order of magnitude)
of response when a similar level  of stress is applied to diverse ecosystem types (e.g., organic matter
processing in lakes vs. streams, subjected to different stresses).
                                              110

-------
399.Peters, R. 1980. Useful concepts for predictive ecology. Synthese 43:257-269.

Scientists deal with two classes of ideas. The first class consists of theories, predictive or falsifiable
statements about the universe. The second class consists of concepts which, by definition, are
unfalsifiable.  Both types of ideas are necessary for a scientist, but only theories comprise a science.
Nevertheless, in ecology, concept and theory are confused to the point that nonpredlctive ideas impede
scientific advancement. In this essay, the author distinguishes between the roles of theory and
concept, indicating the very real shortcomings of a science that is too rooted in concept.  The author
suggests that we set aside the bulk of our ecological concepts in order concentrate on theory building
and modification and I describe some small steps  towards a predictive ecology.

400.Petersen, R.C., Jr. 1992. The RCE: A riparian, channel, and environmental inventory for small
streams in the agricultural landscape. Freshwater  Biol. 27:295-306.

The Riparian, Channel, and Environmental (RCE)  Inventory has been developed to assess the
biological and physical condition of small streams  in the lowland, agricultural landscape.  It consists of
sixteen characteristics that define the structure of the riparian zone, stream channel morphology, and
the biological condition in both habitats.  The inventory is based on the view that in landscapes where
non-point-source pollution and agriculture dominate, the environmental condition of small streams can
be assessed by appraising the physical condition of the riparian zone and stream channel.  It is
assumed that disturbance of this physical structure is a major cause for reduction of stream biological
function. This assumption is supported by a case study using fifteen Italian stream locations in which
the RCE was found to be positively correlated to the benthic macroinvertebrate community as
measured by the Extended Biotic Index (r  = 0.80,  P < 0.001) and Shannon Diversity Index (r = 0.73, P
< 0.001).

The inventory is designed for quick use to cover a large number of streams in a short period. It
generates a numerical score that can be used to compare the physical and biological condition of
different streams  within a region,  the numerical score is divided into five, color-code classes to facilitate
use in stream monitoring programs and to allow comparison with biological indices.

401.Phillips, D. 1980. Quantitative Aquatic Biological Indicators. Applied Science Publishers, Ltd.,
London.

402.Phillips, D. 1986. Use of bio-indicators in monitoring conservative contaminants: Programme
design imperatives. Mar. Pollut. Bull. 17:10-17.

The general acceptance of the advantages inherent in the use of bioindicators to monitor aquatic
pollution has given rise to the establishment of national and international programs employing such
indicator species  in many parts of the world over the last decade.  The authors review the overall
design of such programs.  Some deficiencies in the studies  to date are noted,  and suggestions for
improvement in future monitoring  programs are presented.

403.Pickett, S., J. Kolasa, J. Armesto, and S. Collins. 1989. The ecological concept of disturbance
and its expression at various hierarchical levels. Oikos 54:129-136.

Current definitions of disturbance are intuitive, narrow, and only implicitly based on system structure.
This is because the concepts are based on experience at particular levels of organization or on
systems whose structure is well known.  The definitions are thus inadequate for the development of a
general theory of ecological disturbance.  A universally applicable definition would: (1) identify the
object disturbed (2) distinguish between change in the object that is disturbance and change that is not
and (3) distinguish between direct and indirect consequences of disturbance.  To meet these
requirements, the authors formally link the hierarchical organization of ecological objects and the
concept of disturbance.  Any persistent ecological  object will have a minimal structure, or system of
lower-level entities that permit  its persistence. Disturbance is a change in the minimal structure of an
object caused by a factor external to the level of interest.  Using these definitions, disturbance can be
unequivocally identified and associated with various specific ecological levels of organization.  Because
                                              111

-------
of the dependence of the concept of disturbance on recognizing the minimal structure of ecological
systems, application of the concept will advance as refined models of the hierarchical structure of
ecological systems are elaborated.
404.Plekarz, D. 1990. Editorial. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 15:iii-v.

This editorial gives introductory remarks about this particular issue's  topic, environmental indicators,
and the conference on the State of the Environment reporting for  Canada.  It discusses in general
fashion the identification of ecological indicators and the collection of the requisite monitoring data that
would ideally serve to diagnose the "health" of ecosystems.

405.Plekarz, D. 1990. Rapporteur's report of workgroup: Indicators and assessment of agricultural
sustainability. Environ.  Monitor. Assess. 15:307-308.

This article summarizes the response of the conference workgroup in answering two  issues: (1)
Identification of the most important variables to measure to ensure sustainable agriculture ecology and
(2) Identification of indicators of the resilience of soil ecosystems.

406.Plkul, R. 1974. Development of environmental indices. Pages 103-121.  In: J. Pratt, ed. Statistical
and Mathematical Aspects of Pollution Problems. Marcel Dekker,  New York.

The author has suggested there  are over 100 factors, which he ranked and grouped  into 14 categories,
for which indices of environmental quality could be constructed.  These categories are: water pollution,
hazardous substances (radioactivity levels, pesticide residues, etc.), land management (wetlands,
erosion potential, dam siltage,  urban green, etc.) solid waste disposal, recycling, resources  (timber,
agriculture, fish catch, minerals, etc.), natural phenomena (climate, solar radiation, floods, runoff, etc.),
social-aesthetic conditions (rat infestation, outdoor recreation, housing, noise, urban sprawl, traffic
congestion,  odor, etc.), population, human health,  biological health and ecological balance (endangered
species, fish kills, algal blooms, etc.), economic loss, and pollution control measures.

407.Posthumus, A. 1991. Effects of air pollution on plants and vegetations. Pages 191-198. In: J.
Rozema and J. Verkleij, eds. Ecological Responses to Environmental Stresses. [Series: Tasks for
vegetation science 22 (1991)]. Kluwer Academic Publishers, Dordrecht, The Netherlands.

408.Powell, G., and A. Powell.  1986. Reproduction by Great White Herons in Florida Bay  USA as an
indicator of habitat quality. Biol. Conserv.  36(2):101-114.

Reproduction parameters of great white herons were used to evaluate the habitat quality of eastern
Florida Bay.  Clutch size and productivity of the herons during three breeding seasons were compared
with similar data from 1923 that predated suspected human alteration of the Florida Bay ecosystem.  In
addition, because about 15% of the great white herons nesting in eastern Florida Bay supplemented
their diet with food obtained from people,  it was possible to evaluate the impact of food availability on
reproduction.  Herons that fed  naturally in Florida Bay  (unsupplemented) had significantly smaller
clutches and produced significantly fewer fledglings than those of 1923. Herons that received
supplemental food had reproductive parameters similar to those of 1923. The authors interpret these
data as indicating that  habitat quality is currently reduced from  1923 levels.  These results support the
prediction that wading bird reproduction can be sensitive to habitat quality and that these species
should be useful as biological indicators of habitat quality.

409.Pratt, J.R., and  N.J. Bowers. 1992.  Variability in community metrics:  Detecting changes  in
structure and function. Environ. Toxicol. Chem. 11:451-457.

Increased environmental realism in toxicity testing has been advocated to better predict ecological
effects of toxic chemicals, and several aquatic microcosm bioassays have been developed  that use
both natural and synthetic organism assemblages.  Additionally, greater emphasis is  being  placed on
community changes as evidence of adverse effects on aquatic ecosystems. The ability to infer
structural or functional changes in stressed vs unstressed communities is linked to statistical power that
arises from  the combination of experimental design and the underlying variability in chosen metrics.
                                               112

-------
The authors evaluated several community response variables (metrics) in aquatic laboratory microcosm
experiments and field studies to estimate metric variability.  Variability of community metrics under
laboratory conditions was similar to that observed in the field. Power curves were constructed to
estimate the detectability of significant responses with different experimental designs.  Using the
median C.V. for each measured response, the authors estimated the minimum detectable distance for
power of 0.8 (beta = 0.2) and alpha= 0.05 for each response. Community metrics with C.V.s < 30%
allow detection of differences between means of 20 to 60%, using as few as three replicates.
Structural metrics such as species richness and standing crop are expected to prove more useful in
detecting community and ecosystem changes. Process rates are affected by material supplies that
may not change under stress.

Key Words: Microcosms, Variability, Community metrics

410.Prlce, P., and T. Reeves. 1992. What we have concluded: Research and development priorities
and issues for indicators. Pages 75-82. In: A. Hamblin,  ed. Environmental Indicators for Sustainable
Agriculture. Bureau of Rural Resources, Dept. of Primary Industry and Energy, Queen Victoria Terra,
Australia.

411 .Proceedings of Symposium on Effects of Air Pollutants on Mediterranean and Temperate Forest
Ecosystems. 1980.  Forest Service Pacific SW Forest Experiment Station General Technical Report
PSW-43. U.S. Department of Agriculture, Berkeley, Ca.

This document contains papers in five categories: Natural influences of forests on local and regional air
quality; Effects of chronic exposures to gaseous pollutants on primary production processes; Secondary
and Interactive effects of chronic gaseous pollutants exposure of  producers, consumers, and
decomposers; Chronic effects of acidic precipitation and heavy metals on forest ecosystems and;
Simulation modeling of the effects of chronic pollutant stress on plant processes and plant community
dynamics.  The last category contains a paper addressing the topic of response  of plant communities to
air pollution.

412.Randall, A. 1991. The value of biodiversity. Ambio 20(2):64-68.

Qiven the current threat to biodiversity worldwide,  the article considers various philosophical
approaches to the value of biodiversity.  A clear case can be made, on instrumentalist and utilitarian
grounds, that humans have good reason to place  a high value on preserving biodiversity.  Many
conservationists and philosophers find such reasoning to be unsatisfactory, perhaps because it would
leave biodiversity unprotected in the event that people develop technologies that substitute for naturally
occurring genetic material or find substitutes for the amenity value of natural environments. The author
considers nonconsequentialist philosophical approaches that define right action as that which respects
moral duties or, alternatively, rights. Like the utilitarian  alternative, these theories provide no assurance
that biodiversity will prevail  over other valid concerns unless one  asserts at the outset that preservation
of biodiversity  is a first principle that trumps all others.  Without according first-principle status or
preeminent value to biodiversity, it is still possible  to develop appealing philosophical theories in which
biodiversity counts.  It is reasonable to argue, starting from either moral or utilitarian principles, that, in
the absence of overriding constraints, policy  may be decided on the basis of benefits and costs.
However, it is reasonable also to insist that a safe minimum standard of protection of biodiversity is an
appropriate constraint to place on the policy-decision process. The author concludes with cautious
optimism that benefit cost analysis can be applied successfully to biodiversity issues.

413.Rajagopal, R.,  U. Natarajan, and J. Wacker. 1992. Information integration for environmental
monitoring  and assessment. Environ. Prof. 14:151-177.

Annual federal  and state investments in  the collection, storage, and maintenance of resource and
environmental data are enormous (estimated in the range of a few to tens of billions of dollars).
Despite these investments,  the use of information  from these data bases for societal endpoints has
been limited.  Further research to evaluate the usefulness of large environmental data bases in the
analysis of selected scientific and regulatory  questions,  therefore, would be timely.
                                               113

-------
The primary purpose of this paper is to provide an annotated review of selected literature on the topic
of information integration in the context of environmental monitoring and assessment.  Significant
scholarly contributions to this field have been identified that fall into four categories: institutional,
resource/ecological, design, and technological.  The publications reviewed are grouped, indexed,
associated with keywords and organized  under these four major categories. Within the four first-tier
categories, the authors have identified several second-tier keywords to define more precisely the
content of the title being classified. The collection, accumulated over 2 years, is comprehensive,
although not exhaustive.  As the authors  accumulate additional literature, the classification system will
evolve to reflect the content of the new titles.

414.Rapport, D.J.  1983. The stress-response environmental statistical system and its applicability to
the Laurentian Lower Great Lakes. Stat. J. United Nations ECE 1:377-405.

415.Rapport, D.J.  1984. State of ecosystem medicine. Pages 315-324. In: V. Cairns,  P. Hodson, and
J. Nriagu, eds. Contaminant Effects on Fisheries. John Wiley & Sons, New York.

This essay explores an analogy between medicine and the study of the environment and indicates how
concepts derived from the former might provide the means  to perceive a more integrated view of
ecosystem behavior under stress. Topics covered include: symptoms of ecosystem distress, diagnosis
of ecosystem health, and treatment protocols for rehabilitation.

416.Rapport, D.J.  1989. Symptoms of pathology in the Gulf of Bothnia (Baltic Sea): Ecosystem
response to stress from human activity. Biol. J. Linnean Soc. 37:33-49.

An extensive review of the data now accumulated on the response of the Gulf of Bothnia ecosystem to
stress from human activity provides abundant evidence for  incipient ecosystem pathology.  Signs of
"ecosystem distress" appear at local, coastal, and basin-wide scales. Symptoms include early signs of
eutrophication in local and coastal waters, formation of local abiotic zones, reduced species diversity,
reduced genetic diversity  (particularly in salmonids), reduced size of biota, increased dominance by
opportunistic species, increased disease  prevalence and  bioaccumulation of toxic substances (e.g.,
PCBs and DDT).  Pathology may propagate between local, coastal, and basinwide regions by several
different pathways.  Despite reductions in loadings of some toxic substances in recent years (e.g.,
PCBs and DDT), stress from human activities  on the Gulf of Bothnia continues to impact the ecosystem
at all spatial scales.
Key  Words:  Baltic Sea, Gulf of Bothnia, Ecosystem degradation, Ecosystem behavior under stress,
State of environment, Ecosystem pathology

417.Rapport, D.J. 1990a. What constitutes ecosystem health?  Perspect. Biol. Med. 33(1 ):120-132.

What constitutes the health of Nature (i.e., What are the suitable concepts and conventions to assess
the condition of the environment?) is a question now being raised for the earth's major ecosystems
(forests, lakes, seas, etc.) and indeed the entire biosphere.  Ultimately, a healthy environment is
essential for a healthy human population. It does not follow, however, that the appropriate standards
for the health of nature need be based solely on criteria for human health. Ecosystems have lives of
their own with or without human components,  and it is this  life that is receiving more attention as
situations come to light in which ecosystems have become severely damaged. Topics covered include:
what are ecosystems, measures  of ecosystem health, and the role of social values.

418.Rapport, D.J. 1990b. Challenges in the detection  and  diagnosis of pathological change in aquatic
ecosystems. J. Great Lakes  Res. 16(4):609-618.

There are a number of challenges in developing better tools for the detection and  diagnosis of
pathological change  in ecosystems. The use of indicators can be improved by adopting a  pluralistic
approach rather than relying on any one type of measure of ecosystem health. This approach would
best fulfill three functions that indicators should serve in the context of ecosystem  health: (1) utility in
diagnosis of pathological  changes in ecosystem; (2) utility as an early warning indicator of ecosystem
breakdown and; (3) utility in reflecting ecosystem integrity.  Understanding ecosystem breakdown and
                                              114

-------
rehabilitation processes is enhanced by correlating, over space and time, the appearance of symptoms
of pathological change with changes in stress loadings. Such analyses, as illustrated by a case study
of Kyronjoki estuary (Baltic Sea), are complex because of both discontinuities in the response of
ecosystems to stress and lags between the onset of stress and ecosystem response.  As the practice
of "ecosystem medicine" evolves, much is to be gained by shifting the emphasis from "curative" to
"preventative" aspects.  Here, a "salutogenic" approach, one that is  focused on understanding the
origins of health and mechanisms that promote "healthiness," might find ready applications. Such an
approach would suggest bolstering ecosystem-coping responses to  stress, thereby promoting greater
immunity to the negative aspects of cultural disturbance.

Key Words: Fish management, Aquatic ecosystems, Ecological indicators, Ecosystem health

419.Rapport, D.J. 1990c. Workgroup issue paper: Criteria for ecological indicators. Environ. Monitor.
Assess.  15:273-275.

This article briefly discusses the criteria for good environmental indicators and other issues associated
with them, such as early warning potential, diagnostic capability, and baseline data.

420.Rapport, D.J. 1992a. What is clinical ecology? In: R. Costanza, B. Norton, and B. Haskell, eds.
Ecosystem Health: New Goals for Environmental Management. Island Press, Covelo, California.

Over the past decade and a half, interest in diagnosing the causes of ecosystem breakdown and in
coming to grips with strategies for rehabilitation of damaged ecosystem has been steadily growing.  A
decade ago, papers on the topic "ecosystem medicine" sparked debate about the aptness of medical
metaphors, while today International Societies for the Promotion of "ecosystem health" attest to the
growing acceptance of the approach.

It is fitting therefore, to take stock of the development of this fledgling field, which is here termed
"clinical ecology." To do so, the concept of "health" from an ecosystem perspective is  elaborated, and
then some promising approaches to gauging the health status of whole ecosystems are examined.
Curative  approaches are contrasted with preventive approaches in the treatment of ecosystems under
stress. Finally, areas of clinical ecology are suggested that remain undeveloped and need more
rigorous  definition to advance the practice of clinical ecology.

421.Rapport, D.J. 1992b. Evolution of indicators of ecosystem health. Pages 121-134. In: D. McKenzie,
D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald. Ecological  Indicators. Proceedings of the International Symposium on
Ecological Indicators held in  Fort Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October 1990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

Observations on the health of Nature and the use of "indicators" to denote changes are as old as
human culture.  Historical references to degradation of agricultural lands and forests can be found in
the writings  of Plato and even earlier.  Yet many centuries later, we are far from consensus regarding
the identity of a minimal but sufficient set of indicators by which to measure changes in the state of
Nature.   Such indicators ideally would satisfy these criteria: (1) provide "early warning" for some
incipient  transformation; (2) be sensitive to a variety of stresses; (3)  be "diagnostic," that is, reflective of
the integrity  of some suitably defined complex system. These properties do not go well together,  and
indicators that are suitable for one aspect are often the least suitable for another.

Two approaches to indicators of the state of the environment  are broadly discernable: one focuses on
the stress side and provides measures of loadings of various  types,  be they contaminants or physical
disturbances; the other looks at the response side.  Neither are entirely satisfactory - both have
strengths and weaknesses with regard to the capability to assess and monitor changes in regional
environments. In this paper the evolution of both stress and response indicators is traced and the
challenges of integration of these two approaches are addressed.

422.Rapport, D.J. 1992c. Evaluating ecosystem health. J. Aquat. Ecosys. Health 1(1):15-24.
                                              115

-------
In the past decade, metaphors drawn from human health are finding increasing application in
environmental assessment at ecosystem levels. If ecosystem medicine is to come of age, it must cope
with three fundamental dilemmas.  The first stems from the recognition that there are no strictly
objective criteria for judging health. Assessments of health, as in humans, inevitably are based on
some combination of established norms and desirable attributes.  The second stems from the irregular
pulse of nature which either precludes the early recognition of substantive changes or gives rise to false
alarms.  The third is posed by the  quest for indicators that have the attributes of being holistic, early
warning,  and  diagnostic. Indicators that excel in one of these aspects often fail in another.

Advances in ecosystem medicine are likely to come from closer collaborations with medical colleagues
in both clinical and epidemiological areas.  In particular the time appears ripe for a more systematic
effort to characterize  ecosystem maladies, to validate treatments and to develop more sophisticated
diagnostic protocols.  These aspects are illustrated with comparisons drawn from studies of
environmental transformation in the Laurentian Great Lakes, the Baltic Sea and Canadian terrestrial
ecosystems.

423.Rapport, D.J., and A. Friend. 1979. Towards a comprehensive framework for environmental
statistics: A stress-response approach. Occasional papers. Catalog 11-510. Statistics Canada, Ottawa.

This document consists of three parts: the need for environmental information; ecological perspective
and the design of environmental information systems; and frameworks for environmental statistics -
recent experience of  Statistics Canada.  Among many other topics and ideas covered within the
document are: measurement of the state of the natural ecosystem; data required to describe ecosystem
response to stress; mapping, modelling, and monitoring; environmental quality indices; and ecological
indicators.

424.Rapport, D.J., and H.A. Regier. 1980. An  ecological approach to environmental information.
Ambk>9(1):22-27.

The authors' ecological perspective implies three major interdependent sets of data.  To begin with, we
should classify terrestrial and aquatic systems according to ecological similarity, such as watersheds,
ecosystems, communities, and biomes (ecological transformations considered in terms of both plants
and animals in the area concerned). Second, we need to classify, quantify and geocode those aspects
of human activity that potentially alter the state  of nature.  Third, we must identify  a series of indicators,
some specific to particular types of ecosystems, which diagnose transformations in nature.

425.Rapport, D.J., and H. Regier. 1992. Disturbance and stress effects on ecological systems. In: B.
Patten and S. Jorgensen, eds. Complex Ecology: The Part-Whole Relation in Ecosystems. Prentice
Hall, Englewood Cliffs, NJ.

426.Rapport, D.J., H. Regier, and T. Hutchinson.  1985. Ecosystem behavior under stress. Am. Nat.
125:617-640.

Drawing  from representative empirical studies about the impacts of various stresses on the structure
and function of aquatic and terrestrial systems,  the authors identify common symptoms of ecosystem
distress and the major phases of ecosystem response to stress.  The authors find that Selye's model
serves to provide  a unifying framework for the description of ecosystem behavior  under stress.

427.Rapport, D.J., H. Regier, and C. Thorpe.  1981. Diagnosis, prognosis, and treatment of
ecosystems under stress. Pages 269-280. In: G. Barrett and R. Rosenberg, eds. Stress Effects on
Natural Ecosystems. John Wiley & Sons, Chichester, England.

In this paper the authors explore the application of concepts and  the practice of human medicine to the
development of new  directions in stress ecology. Their purpose is not merely heuristic.  The authors
believe that the application  of the experience of medical practice to stress ecology will provide a more
rigorous  approach to the questions of diagnosis and treatment of degraded ecosystems and that the
                                              116

-------
analogy suggests novel and worthwhile research questions that will increase our understanding of
ecosystem breakdown and recovery processes.

428.Rapport, D.J., C. Thorpe, and H.A. Regier.  1979. Ecosystem medicine. Bull. Ecol. Soc. Am.
60(4):180-182.

This article develops an analogy between human  and ecosystem medicine.  It proposes to raise
questions to be subjected to the critical, skeptical  tests of science. It notes some intriguing
commonalities in the practice of human and ecosystem medicine and suggests that perhaps each may
derive benefits from the transfer of ideas.

429.Reams, M.A., S.R. Coffee, A.R. Machen, and K.J. Poche. 1992. Use of environmental indicators
in evaluating effectiveness of state environmental  regulatory programs. Pages 1245-1275. In: D.
McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the International
Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October  1990. Elsevier, Essex,
England.

The Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has recommended that measures of environmental quality
can be used as benchmarks to measure the effectiveness of environmental regulatory programs.  This
paper attempts to characterize efforts of state regulatory officials in evaluating their environmental
programs.  Specifically, it describes the extent to which program performance indicators are based on
environmental parameters.  Also, an attempt is made to identify those factors that explain variation in
the use of environmentally based performance indicators.

430.Regier, H., rapporteur. 1986. Report of working group on technical information. Pages 235-237.
In: B. Haug, L. Bandurski, and A. Hamilton, eds. Towards a Transboundary Monitoring Network: A
Continuing Binational Exploration. International Joint Commission, Ottawa.

431.Regier, H. 1990. Workgroup issue paper: Indicators and assessment of the state of fisheries.
Environ. Monitor. Assess. 15:289-294.

This article addresses the research process behind assessment, gives criteria for environmental
indicators, and discusses the role of management.

432.Regler, H.A.  1992. Indicators of ecosystem integrity.  Pages 183-200. In:  D. McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt,
and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the International Symposium on Ecological
Indicators held in  Fort Lauderdale, FL,  16-19 October 1990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

The political reform movement in the late 1960s and early 1970s led, in the U.S.A., to the separate
incorporation of two concepts—ecosystem and integrity—into federal legislation.  These  concepts came
together in the statement of purpose of the 1978 Canada-U.S.A. Great Lakes Water Quality
Agreement. Progress under that Agreement and its several amending protocols  involves progressive
clarification of the notion of ecosystem  integrity (e.g., in the form of indicators and objectives).
Indicators of ecosystem integrity are under development at three spatial/temporal scales: local, as in
Remedial Action Plans for degraded Areas of Concern; subregional, as in Lakewide Management
Plans; and basin,  as in proposed policies to cope  with periodic fluctuations in water levels and flows.
The author attempts to explain the scientific aspects of this process of specification and  clarification.
The author also suggests that emphasis on ecosystem integrity and its indicators may serve political
needs in the second wave  of environmental/political reform, which is now expected for the 1990s.

433.Regler, H., and E. Co well. 1972. Applications of ecosystem theory, succession, diversity, stability,
stress, and conservation. Biol. Conserv. 4(2):83-88.

Processes at the ecosystem level of organization are examined as they are affected by conventional
regimes of fishery exploitation and pollution, the latter including both nutrient and toxic materials.
Exploitation and pollution are treated as stresses that deform and transform community structure and
                                              117

-------
reverse the usual sequence of ecological succession with respect to dominance of various taxa,
diversity, stability, and production. Broad economic implications of such processes are outlined.

434.Regier, H., and D.J. Rapport. 1983. Ecological information services for the Great Lakes. In:
Proceedings of the International Conference on Renewable Resources  Inventories for Monitoring
Changes and Trends.  Corvallis, OR.

435.Regler, H.A., and D.J. Rapport. 1980. Ecology's family coming of age in a changing world. Pages
49-63. In: Biological Evaluation of Environmental Impacts.  Proceedings of a symposium at the 1976
meeting of The Ecological Society of America. FWS/OBS-80/26. U.S. Department of the Interior, Fish
and Wildlife Service, Washington, DC,

This article discusses  a plethora of issues regarding the nature and development of ecology and relates
these to environmental impact assessment. Short sections of the article, however,  deal with  issues
related to EMAP, including levels of  organization, ecological factors or stresses, and stimulus-response
interactions.

436.Reichholf, J. 1982.  Water birds as indicators of the ecological state of aquatic ecosystems. (In
German, summary in German, English). Dech. Beih. 26:138-144.

Biological indicators have to fulfill certain criteria before they may  be used  for an "early-warning system"
that leads to actual controls.  Water  birds are considered useful because they have world-wide
distribution; are easy to determine and count; have different trophic positions between the full range of
primary and end consumers; are capable of independent respiration of  water; can yield  measurements
that can be integrated across space and time; sufficiently precise  reaction  in distribution and  numbers
to the trophic state of  the water; have a reflection of important structural parts of the aquatic ecosystem;
are indicators of medium and long-term changes (i.e., the diversion of an aquatic ecosystem  from its
basic state); and are suitable  for making testable predictions on trends.

437.Reid, W.V.,  J.A. McNeely,  D.B. Tunstall, D.A. Bryant, and M. Winograd. 1992. Developing
Indicators of Biodiversity Conservation. 31  pp. World Resources Institute, Washington, DC.

438.Reilly, W. 1989. Measuring for environmental results. EPA J. May/June:2-4.

This article by the former head of the U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency briefly describes the new
approach that the EPA is undertaking to assess the success of its environmental protection efforts.  It is
a strategic, "big-picture approach" to the collection and use of environmental data.

439.Reimold, R. J., D.M.  Kent, J.M. Kelly, and C.E. Tammi. 1992. Coupling wetlands structure and
function:  Developing  a condition index for  wetlands monitoring. Pages  557-568. In: D. McKenzie, D.E.
Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the International Symposium on
Ecological Indicators held  in Fort Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October 1990.  Elsevier, Essex, England.

Based on a review of  published wetlands monitoring efforts conducted  in support of delineation and
mitigation activities in  estuarine and freshwater wetlands throughout the United States, the authors
present an approach to integrate functional and structural wetland measurements for development of a
family of wetlands functional indices and a Wetlands Integrated Monitoring Condition Index (WIMCI).
WIMCI, with values ranging from 0 to 1, represents the overall functional condition of the monitored
wetland.  WIMCI averages individual functional values, is compensatory in nature, and does  not result
in any one function being a limiting factor for wetlands characterization. WIMCI is flexible, wetland
functions  can be added or deleted, depending on specific wetlands, or  weighted where  it has been
determined that the functions ascribed to a wetland are not equal in significance. The family of
functional indices and WIMCI can be easily field-verified in relation to ongoing wetlands monitoring
efforts associated with local, state, and federal permit activities requiring mitigation.  Based on these
functional indices and WIMCI, cost-effective and scientifically responsive, generic monitoring
approaches can be readily incorporated into future wetland monitoring permits.
                                              118

-------
440.Reiners, W. 1983. Disturbance and basic properties of ecosystem energetics. Pages 83-98. In:
H.A. Mooney and M. Godron, eds. Disturbance and Ecosystems: Components of Response. Springer-
Verlag, New York.

The thrust of comparison in this paper is not between undisturbed and disturbed ecosystems, but
between natural and human-engendered disturbances and their consequent effects.  What, if anything,
is different about the nature of human-caused disturbances and what, if any, difference in ecosystem
behavior can be expected? The article is divided into the following sections: (1) Biomass and Energy
Flow in Infrequently Disturbed Ecosystems — (a) Net Primary Production and Energy Flow Pathways,
(b)  Biomass and Detritus Accumulation, (c) Net Ecosystem Production, (d) Variation in Infrequent
Disturbance Events; (2) Biomass and Energy Flow in Multiple Disturbance Ecosystems — (a) Constant
Species Composition and Site Quality, (b) Changing Ecosystem Structure with Disturbance Frequency;
and (3) Conclusions: Integration.

441.Richardson, D., ed. 1987. Biological Indicators of Pollution. Royal Irish Academy, Dublin.

442.Riitters, K., and J. Barnard. 1990. Criteria for evaluating indicators of forest health. Pages 443-
452. In: H. Lund and G.  Preto, eds. Global Natural Resources Monitoring and Assessments: Preparing
for the 21st Century. American Society for Photogrammetry and Remote Sensing, Bethesda, MD.

The criteria to evaluate forest health indicators must be agreed so that a global forest health monitoring
system can be established. The criteria must be formulated within a framework for analyzing data that
takes into account:

1. Strategic value—Monitoring should be a part of a broader plan for identifying and assessing changes
       in forest health.
2. Tactical value—The indicators should give  useful information  for different types of assessments of
       health.
3. Scientific basis—The indicators should be chosen from biological models that lend realism and that
       are interpretable.

Once forest health  is defined, monitoring gives information on the emergence of new problems and the
development of known problems. Indicators of forest health for  global monitoring can be either very
general or very specific,  according to the intended assessment.  A modeling framework is suggested
such that global comparability for assessments may not require  that indicators to be monitored be
globally uniform.

443.Riitters,  K., B. Law, R.C. Kucera, A. Gallant, R.L. DeVelice, and C.J. Palmer. 1992. A selection
of forest condition indicators for monitoring. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 20:21-33.

Regional monitoring and assessments of the health of forested ecosystems require indicators of forest
conditions and environmental stresses.  Indicator selections depend on objectives and the strategy for
data collection and analysis.  This paper recommends a set of indicators to signal changes In forest
ecosystem distribution, productivity, and disturbance. Additional measurements are recommended to
help ascribe those  changes to climate variation, atmospheric deposition, and land use patterns.  The
rationale for these indicators  is discussed  in the context of a sequential monitoring and research
strategy.

444.Risser,  P.G. 1985. Toward a holistic management perspective. Bioscience  35(7):414-418.

Today, there  are several approaches to studying ecosystems under stress, and it remains to be seen
which, if any, will produce powerful problem-solving results. Some of the most significant questions
about stressed ecosystems relate to the temporal and spatial occurrence of stress symptoms: Which
characteristics are the best indicators of stress? and Which of the  ecosystem properties are able to
resist or recover from extreme stress? We must manage stressed ecosystems  in ways that recognize
the holistic nature of the system.  This and the other papers in this issue present several current
approaches to these challenges. The author begins by discussing agroecosystems, ecological-
                                              119

-------
economic interactions, landscape ecology, models and predictions, and short- and long-term ecological
horizons.

445.Robarge, G.M., and J. Benforado. 1992. Reducing agricultural impacts on the environment. J.
Sustain. Agric. 2(3):123-140.

Successful adaptation of sustainable agricultural practices in the United States will hinge on identifying
the potential benefits of the practices and demonstrating their feasibility within the context of agricultural
economic conditions.  The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency has a number of ongoing research
efforts that relate to sustainable agriculture.  However, these efforts have not been designed as, and do
not constitute, an organized environmental/agricultural research program.  New research initiatives,
such as the Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program, are evolving towards a more
integrated approach for solving environmental/agricultural problems.  These efforts  provide a foundation
for an integrated program in sustainable agricultural research. One of the major challenges will be to
work effectively with the U.S. Department of Agriculture, taking advantage of the research capabilities
and strengths of each agency.

446.Roberts, K.A. 1991. Field monitoring: Confessions of an addict. Pages 179-211. In: B. Goldsmith,
ed. Monitoring for Conservation and Ecology. Chapman and Hall, London.

The author suspects that most monitoring is thoughtless, so this chapter starts with some thoughts on
the nature of monitoring.  Monitoring is not as simple as collecting "the facts"; nor do the facts "speak
for themselves", and never are interpretations "not open to serious question", as one hopeful author
wrote.

The second part of the chapter consists of some personal monitoring tales.  These derive from the
author's work as a nature reserve warden, from expeditions abroad, from research to support the Lee
Valley Conservation Group, and from studies with his students of the University of London's Certificate
in Ecology  and  Conservation. The author found the practical experiences invaluable at the time
because they demonstrated a lot of strange  things about monitoring.

447.Roberts, L. 1990. Counting on science  at EPA. Science 249:616-618.

This news and comment feature describes the environmental risk ranking process undertaken by the
EPA. The  task was an attempt to focus the agency's resources on the environmental problems that
pose the biggest risks rather than those that have attracted the most political attention.

448.Robinson, G.R.,  R.D. Holt, M.S. Gains, S.P. Hamburg, M.L. Johnson, H.S.  Fitch, and E.A.
Martinko. 1992. Diverse and contrasting effects of habitat fragmentation. Science 257:524-526.

Diverse components of an ecosystem can respond in very different ways to habitat fragmentation.  AN
archipelago of patches, representing different levels of fragmentation, was arrayed within a
successional field and studied over a period of 6 years.  Ecosystem processes (soil mineralization and
plant succession) did  not vary with the degree of subdivision, nor did most measures of plant and
animal community diversity.  However, fragmentation affected vertebrate population dynamics and
distributional patterns  as well as the population persistence of clonal plant species.  The results
highlight the dangers of relying on broad community measures in lieu of detailed population analyses in
studies of fragmented habitats.

449.Roughgarden, J. 1989. Viewpoint: The United States needs an ecological survey. Bioscience
39(1 ):5.

In this commentary, the author proposes to  create a U.S. Ecological Survey that would describe the
biological component  of the environment and identify processes that shape it.

450.Rose, K., and E. Smith. 1992. Experimental design: The neglected aspect of environmental
monitoring. Environ. Manage.
                                              120

-------
Environmental monitoring is increasing due to regulatory mandates and public concerns over the health
of the environment.  Much of the data appear to be being collected without explicit statement of
hypotheses and with little regard for principles of experimental design. Mismatches between the
monitoring design and the hypotheses of interest arise when inappropriate designs are used,
hypotheses are poorly stated or change over time, and when data collected for one purpose are used
for other purposes (i.e., data are used to evaluate hypotheses which the data were never intended to
address). Two long-term time series on historical changes in dissolved oxygen (DO) in Chesapeake
Bay are analyzed to illustrate how a mismatch between monitoring design and the hypotheses  of
interest can lead to analyses of low power and even contradictory conclusions. Neither time series was
collected to evaluate long-term trends in DO; regression analysis results in one time series showing a
downward trend in DO, whereas the other time series shows no temporal trends.  The importance of
experimental design considerations will increase in the future as monitoring is used to not only  identify
and define environmental problems but also to quantify the effectiveness of management and remedial
actions taken in response to identified problems.  To ensure the usefulness of the large amounts of
environmental monitoring data accumulating, we need to ask more questions that relate how data are
collected (the experimental design) to why data are collected (the hypotheses of interest).

451.Rozema, J., and J. Verkleij, eds.  1991. Ecological Responses to Environmental Stresses. [Series:
Tasks for Vegetation Science 22 (1991)]. Kluwer Academic Publishers, Dordrecht, The Netherlands.

452.Rump, P. and N.  Hillary. 1987. Monitoring for Change:  Workshop Proceedings. Canada Land Use
Monitoring Program. Land Use in Canada Series Number 28. Lands Directorate, Environment Canada,
Ottawa.

These  proceeding consist of the edited papers and workshop summaries from the Monitoring for
Change Workshop held in Ottawa in late 1985. The overall objective of the workshop  was to
encourage dialogue, information exchange, and cooperation  to strengthen and enhance the land
monitoring contribution to the prevention and resolution of land use conflicts.  Summaries are placed
into three themes: Issues and Role; Methods and Techniques and; Strategies for Cooperation.  A
common thread throughout the proceedings is the contribution of land use change and land
degradation information towards improved land and natural resource management.

453.Ryder, R. 1990. Ecosystem health, a human perception—definition, detection, and the
dichotomous key. J. Great Lakes Res. 16(4):619-624.

This article presents a background to the concept of ecosystem health and provides some definitions.
It also covers detection of ecosystem malaise and uses the Great Lakes ecosystem as an example; it
discusses the use of the "dichotomous key" (a computerized expert system) as a tool to assess
ecosystem health.

454.Ryder, R., and C. Edwards, eds. 1985. A Conceptual approach for the Application of Biological
Indicators of Ecosystem Quality in the Great Lakes Basin. Great Lakes Regional Office. International
Joint Commission, Windsor, Ontario.

455.Salankl, J., and H. Salama. 1987. Signalization, monitoring, and evaluation of environmental
pollution using biological indicators. Acta Biol. Hung. 38(1):5-11.

This essay gives an overview of biological indicators, their advantages, and the role of laboratory and
field studies.

456.Saunders, D., R. Hobbs, and C. Margules. 1991. Biological consequences of ecosystem
fragmentation—A review. Conserv. Biol. 5(1 ):18-32.

Research on fragmented ecosystems has focused mostly on the biogeographic consequences  of the
creation of habitat "islands" of different sizes and has provided little of practical value to managers.
However, ecosystem fragmentation causes large changes in the physical environment as well as
biogeographic  changes.  Fragmentation generally results in a landscape that consists of remnant areas
                                             121

-------
of native vegetation surrounded by a matrix of agricultural or other developed land. As a result, fluxes
of radiation momentum (i.e., wind), water, and nutrients across the landscape are altered significantly.
These in turn can have important influences on the biota within remnant areas, especially at or near the
edge between the remnant and the surrounding matrix. The isolation of remnant areas by clearing also
has important consequences for the biota.  These consequences vary with the time since isolation,
distance from other remnants, and degree of connectivity with other remnants. The influences of
physical and biogeographic changes are modified by the size, shape, and position in the landscape of
individual remnants, with larger remnants being less adversely affected by the fragmentation process.
The dynamics of remnant areas are predominantly driven by factors arising in the surrounding
landscape. Management of, and research on, fragmented ecosystems should be directed at
understanding and controlling these external influences as much as  at the biota of the remnants
themselves. There Is a strong need to develop an integrated approach to landscape management that
places conservation reserves in the context of the overall landscape. .

457.Schaeffer, D.J. 1991. A toxicological perspective on ecosystem characteristics to  track sustainable
development: VII. Ecosystem health. Ecotoxicol. Environ. Saf. 22:225-239.

The goal of "ecosystem health," an emerging science paralleling human and veterinary medicine, is the
systematic diagnosis and treatment of stressed ecosystems.  Ecosystems are stressed by physical
factors such as boat traffic, biological factors such as introduction of exotic species, and chemical
factors such as pH change. Even if these classes of  stressors affect the same trophic levels, the
resulting disease ecosystem states have different etiologies because the stress is introduced and
propagated by different mechanisms.  This paper presents a toxicological perspective  on ecosystem
sustainability, and discusses how classical toxicological concepts have to be modified  when the
experimental unit is an ecosystem.  When exposures are high, effects are acute and are often
measurable (e.g., fish kill).  However, when exposures are low and chronic, effects are often hard to
separate from background. Ecosystem "threshold criteria" are established to ensure ecosystem
sustainability; high risk to sustainability is evident when these criteria are exceeded.

458.Schaeffer, D.  and D. Cox. 1992.  Approaches to  establish ecosystem threshold criteria. VIII.
Ecosystem health. In: R. Costanza, B. Norton, and B. Haskell, eds. Ecosystem Health: New Goals for
Environmental Management. Island Press, Covelo, CA.

The authors' preliminary definition of an ecosystem threshold criterion  is: "Any condition (internal  or
external to the system) which, when exceeded, increases the adverse risk to maintenance of the
ecological system." Systematic development of ecosystem threshold criteria is a significant, new
research area that integrates legal, political, social, and economic disciplines with biological and
physical sciences.

To adequately address the complex problems associated with development of threshold criteria, the
initial focus needs  to be on a comprehensive synthesis and integration rather than on  narrowly defined
topics.  Four major initial research objectives are to (1) examine the functionality of the proposed
definition of an "ecological threshold criterion"; (2) determine the extent to which ecological system
threshold criteria already exist and characterize the properties and measurements used in each
criterion; (3) learn whether meaningful criteria have been developed through the legal, political, social,
and economic disciplines and evaluate how well these criteria perform when compared with criteria
developed from the physical and biological sciences;  and (4) determine the extent to which ecosystem-
condition references can be established.

The legal,  political, social, and economic disciplines need to be examined to determine whether sound
criteria can be developed in the absence of good scientific data. The  nature and measures of threshold
criteria proposed by biological  and physical scientists should be determined based on  review of the
literature.  A variety of approaches for developing threshold criteria, ranging from court-imposed criteria
to consensus criteria and from measurements of ecological system properties and processes to
mathematical models of system connectedness and multispecies risk, need to be considered.
                                               122

-------
459.Schaeffer, D., D. Cox, and R. Deem. 1987. Variability of test systems used to assess ecological
effects of chemicals. Water Sci. Technol.  19(11):39-45.

Numerous chemicals may produce lexicological effects that are ecologically important. Assessment of
risk to ecological systems from chemical exposures includes the use of biological test systems to
evaluate toxicity.  Most biological test systems are oriented to the laboratory and have no clear
environmental relevance. To help focus the selection of test systems, the authors developed a series
of descriptions of test system characteristics and suggested some criteria for selecting test systems to
determine ecological effect.  Another step in the selection process is evaluation of the variability of
aquatic test systems by using published data.  Using the relative standard deviation v, the authors
classify variability as low  (v < 10%), medium (10% < v < 20%), high (20% < v < 30%), and very high
Key Words: Bioassays, Toxicity testing, Bioassessment, Coefficient of variation

460.Schaeffer, D.J., E.E. Herricks, and H.W. Kerster. 1988. Ecosystem health: I. Measuring
ecosystem health. Environ.  Manage. 12:445-455.

Ecosystem analysis has been advanced by an improved understanding of how ecosystems are
structured and how they function.  Ecology has advanced from an emphasis on natural history to
consideration of energetics, the relationships and connection between species, hierarchies, and
systems theory.  Still, we consider ecosystems as entities with a distinctive character and individual
characteristics.

Ecosystem maintenance and preservation are the object of impact analysis, hazard evaluation, and
other management or regulation activities.  In this article the authors explore an approach to ecosystem
analysis that identifies and quantifies factors that define the condition or state  of an ecosystem in terms
of health criteria. They relate ecosystem health  to human/nonhuman animal health and explore the
difficulties of defining ecosystem health; they suggest criteria that provide a functional definition of state
and condition. The authors suggest that, as has been found in human/nonhuman animal health
studies, disease states can be recognized before disease is of clinical magnitude. Example disease
states for ecosystems are functionally defined and discussed, together with test systems for their early
detection.

461.Schaeffer, D., and E. Novak. 1988. Integrating epidemiology and epizootiology information in
ecotoxicology studies: III. Ecosystem health. Ecotoxicol. Environ. Saf. 16:232-241.

Epidemiology is the study of the disease incidence rates in humans and epizootiology is the nonhuman
equivalent.  There have been  few attempts to integrate epidemiological epizootiological data from
human and nonhuman animal populations coexisting in the same environment. The authors propose
that epizootiological research be conducted on chemical pollutants by using the framework of the
natural environment as a laboratory. These kinds of studies are termed "epizootiologic ecotoxicology."
It is suggested that guilds, defined as a group of human individuals or a group of nonhuman species
that use their environment in a similar way, be used as experimental probes to assess the effects of
chemicals on ecosystems and humans. Improved data would increase the likelihood that effects in
exposed  populations will attain statistical significance so that high-risk populations can be detected
even though the number of affected individuals is low.  Epizootiological information, the product of this
research, must be treated as an important component of a unified health evaluation system.

462.Scherer, E. 1992. Behavioural responses as indicators of environmental alterations: Approaches,
results, development. J. Appl. Icthyol. 8:122-131.

Over the past 1 5 to 20 years,  growing awareness of anthropogenic alterations of aquatic environments
has led to a search for sensitive and ecologically relevant indicators and meaningful  early warning
signals at various levels of biological integration  from subcellular biophysics and biochemistry to
ecosystem function.  Besides playing its role  in basic ecology, the integrative whole-organism
behavioral response has long  been used in mammalian toxicology and pharmacology.  For its use in
                                              123

-------
assessing effects of physical and chemical changes of the environment on fish, however, broader
ecology-oriented concepts and new quantitative methods were needed, and are now being developed.
Published data are relatively numerous in the areas of unconditioned preference-avoidance responses
(relating to habitat selection and maintenance), and changes of locomotor activity. More complex
effects on intra- and interspecific interactions have recently attracted increased attention.  Recent
technical and methodological advances include instantaneous  response digitization and computerized
video image analysis. Apparent strengths and weaknesses of present behavioral testing are presented,
and some research needs and current developments are pointed out.

463.Schlndler, D.W. 1987. Detecting ecosystem responses to anthropogenic  stress. Can. J. Fish.
Aquat. Sci., Suppl.1 44:6-25.

Recent ecological work on aquatic populations, communities, and ecosystems is reviewed for advances
that show promise as early indicators of anthropogenic stress in aquatic ecosystems. Work at the
Experimental Lakes Area (ELA) in northwestern Ontario indicates that among  the earliest of responses
to stress are (1) changes in species composition of small, rapidly  reproducing species with wide
dispersal powers such as phytoplankton and (2) the disappearance of sensitive organisms from aquatic
communities.  Work elsewhere illustrates that the incidence of  morphological abnormalities in benthic
invertebrates is also highly sensitive to pollution stress.  For several categories of pollutants, this
sensitivity of benthic organisms may be the result of greater concentrations of pollutants in sediments
than in the water column.  Variables reflecting ecosystem functions, such as primary production,
nutrient cycling, and respiration, were not altered by eutrophication, acidification, or cadmium addition at
ELA and are relatively poor indicators  of early stress.  Mesocosm experiments appear to be fruitful for
addressing chemical- or plankton-related problems but are less useful for addressing community- or
ecosystem-level questions.  Among population-level approaches, life-table population studies of
invertebrates appear to be the most-sensitive early indicators of stress on ecosystems.

Relative sensitivities of freshwater and forested terrestrial ecosystems exposed to airborne pollutants
are compared. Primary production setms to be reduced at a much earlier stage of air pollution stress
in terrestrial ecosystems than in aquatic systems.  Soils, like lake sediments, tend to be sinks for
pollutants.  This may protect the pelagic regions of lakes from influxes of toxins that would occur if
watersheds and sediments were unreactive but may cause additional stresses to the fauna and flora of
soils and sediments. In extreme cases, high concentrations of toxins may inhibit the replacement of
terrestrial producers.

The importance of long-term monitoring in distinguishing natural from anthropogenic stress is
discussed. It  is suggested that paleoecological techniques be rapidly developed and calibrated with
whole-ecosystem experiments to resolve certain adequacies of past monitoring records.

464.Schlndler, D.W. 1990. Experimental  perturbations of whole lakes as  tests of hypotheses
concerning ecosystem structure and function. Oikos 57:25-41.

Production, respiration, nutrient concentrations, and changes in biological communities were monitored
for several years in two experimentally eutrophied and two experimentally acidified lakes in the
Experimental Lakes Area, Canada.  Results were examined to detect changes in ecosystem structure
and function that might be sensitive indicators of ecosystem stress.

Phytoplankton production in eutrophied lakes was higher than  in reference lakes.  It decreased quickly
to background values when fertilization was terminated.  Winter respiration was unchanged, and P/R
ratios were constant under constant N/P fertilization, but decreased for three years after the N/P ratio in
fertilizer was decreased from 14:1 to 5:1 by weight.

Phytoplankton production was not affected by acidification to a pH of 5.0.  Winter respiration declined at
pH values of 5.1 and below, causing P/R to be highest  at the  lowest pH values.  Respiration returned to
normal when the pH of the lake was increased to 5.4. Gross  periphyton production and respiration
both increased with acidification, but P/R  ratios declined at pH values below 6.2.  Nitrification in both
                                               124

-------
acidified lakes ceased at pH values of 5.4 to 5.7.  It recovered when pH was allowed to increase, but
with a lag time of 1 year. No other nutrient cycles appeared to be disrupted.

Both eutrophication and acidification caused declines in species diversity among several taxonomic
groups. Among  phytoplankton, both stresses caused an increase in size of organisms  in summer.
Among  higher taxa, there was not a consistent tendency for either small or large organisms to be
favored.

Periphyton metabolism was the most sensitive indicator of acidification, followed by taxonomic changes
in several groups. Ecosystem-level production and respiration were the most resistant  properties to
acid stress.

The earliest serious changes in ecosystems and food webs occurred when acidification eliminated acid-
sensitive organisms that were also the sole occupants of key ecological niches.  Such situations occur
frequently in northern lakes.

465.Schindler, D.W., and K.  Mills. 1985. Long-term ecosystem stress: The effects of eight years of
acidification on a small lake. Science 1:1395-1401.

Experimental acidification of a small lake from an  original pH value  of 6.8 to 5.0 over an 8-year period
caused  a number of dramatic changes in the lake's food web. Changes in phytoplankton species,
cessation of fish  reproduction, disappearance of the benthic crustaceans, and appearance of
filamentous algae in the littoral zone were consistent with deductions from synoptic surveys of lakes in
regions  of high acid deposition.  Contrary to what  had been expected from synoptic surveys,
acidification of Lake 223 did not cause decreases in primary  production, rates of decomposition, or
nutrient concentrations.  Key organisms in the food web leading to lake trout, including  Mysis  relicta
and Pimephales  promelas, were eliminated from the lake at pH values as high as 5.8, an indication that
irreversible stresses on aquatic ecosystems  occur earlier in the acidification process than was
heretofore believed. These changes are caused by hydrogen ion alone and not by the  secondary
effect of aluminum toxicity.  Because no species of fish reproduced at pH values below 5.4, the lake
would become fishless within  about a decade on the basis of the natural mortalities of the most long-
lived species.

466.Schneider, E.D.  1992.  Monitoring for ecological integrity: The state of the art. In: D. McKenzie,
D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald,  eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the  International Symposium
on Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October 1990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

467.Schroeder,  R.L., and M.E. Keller. 1992. Setting objectives —  A prerequisite of ecosystem
management. Pages  1-4. In: R.S. Mitchell, C.J. Sheviak, and D.J. Leopold, eds. Ecosystem
management: Rare Species and Significant Habitats. Proceedings of the 15th Annual Natural  Areas
Conference.  New York State Museum, Albany, NY.

Management implies movement toward desired end results.  Therefore, primary prerequisites  of
ecosystem management are : clear definition of the components of  the system to be managed and
establishment of  the desired end conditions for those components.  Several steps are recommended in
setting ecosystem management objectives: (1) objectives should be set early in the planning stages of
the project; (2) managers should decide exactly what resources are of concern  and focus the  objectives
on these specific resources; (3) objectives should  be set within a "top-down" framework to force the
consideration of larger scale constraints and needs;  (4) objective statements should be  made  clear and
concise, and stated in such  a  manner that progress in meeting those objectives can be measured; (5)
the process of setting objectives is dynamic and should be kept flexible to respond to new information.
It may be difficult to set clear objectives, due to imperfect knowledge or a lack of adequate data on the
resources of concern.  A great deal of additional research is needed to quantify and explain important
population, community, and ecosystem level processes in order to make such decisions.  In the interim,
however, resource managers should make the best use of available information and conduct their
management efforts within the framework of well-understood, measurable objectives.
                                              125

-------
Key Words: Ecosystem management, Rare species and significant habitats

468.Schroevers, P.J. 1983. The need of an ecological quality concept. Environ. Monitor. Assess.
3:219-226.

An indicator is something which makes visible, audible, or perceptible something which in itself is not
visible, audible, or perceptible.  Many times indicators concern rather concrete matters that might be
experienced also in a more direct way. Acidity can be tasted, but a pH meter is a better instrument. If
such an instrument is not available, the presence of Sphagnum cuspidatum indicates that the pH
cannot be higher than 6.5. When the accumulation of mercury in certain tissues of fish constitutes a
good reflection of mercury content of water, the observation will be far easier.  With this description,  the
concept of quality is introduced. Quality is something which is not visible, perceptible, or audible, but
which can be made such by our indicators. We experience how behind the perceived reality, another
reality is hidden, an abstract reality, not of matters  but of principles. Is "quality" such a principle? Are
we able, by looking at the things around us (e.g., plants, animals, communities, tissues, oxygen
concentrations) to tell something about the difficult  phenomenon of "quality"?

469.Schubert, R. 1992. Possibilities and limitations in bioindication on landscape monitoring scales.
Pages 817-828. In: D. McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings
of the International Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October
1990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

470.Scott, K.J., J.F.  Paul, A.F. Holland, S.B. Weisberg, J.K. Summers, and A. Robertson. 1992. In
Press. The estuarine component of the U.S. EPA's Environmental Monitoring and Assessment
Program. Chem. Ecol.

471.Segar, D., D. Phillips, and E. Stamman.  1987. Strategies for long-term pollution monitoring of the
coastal oceans. Pages 12-27. In: T.  Boyle, ed. New Approaches to Monitoring Aquatic Ecosystems.
ASTM STP 940. American Society for Testing and  Materials, Philadelphia.

Monitoring of long-term effects of marine pollution on regional marine  ecosystems can be most useful to
managers if based primarily on the use of bioindicators to monitor temporal changes in the mean
background abundance of bioavailable contaminants in the region.  Design of successful long-term,
regional bioindicator monitoring program requires that specific quantitative objectives be defined and
expressed as null hypotheses.  An optimum sampling and analysis plan designed to test these
hypotheses must select the age, size range, and number of individuals per sample, the number of
samples per site, the number of replicate analyses  per sample, and other factors based on the known
sources of variance in the environment, sampled population, and analysis procedure.  Sampling sites
must be systematically selected to be affected as little as possible by contaminant inputs that vary
temporally on short time scales. Many suitable sites will require the transplantation of bioindicators,
and the optimum program will probably require the exclusive use of transplanted populations.

Key Words: Bioindicators, Monitoring, Marine pollution, Sampling, Statistical design, Strategy

472.Seidl, P. and P. Murray, eds. 1991. A Proposed  Framework for  Developing Indicators  of
Ecosystem Health for the Great Lakes Region.  Council of Great Lakes Resource Managers,
International Joint Commission, Windsor, Ontario.

This report is a summary of the current knowledge about indicators.  It also is a cursory attempt to
show the linkages between socio-economic and biogeochemical variables. The report is divided into
five parts: Introduction; Relating indicator development to management goals for the Great Lakes Basin;
Framework for developing a monitoring program; Evaluating available indicators (physicochemical,
biological, and socio-economic) and; Conclusions and recommendations.  A reference list containing
170 citations  is provided.
                                              126

-------
473.Seitz, A., and H. Ratte. 1991. Aquatic ecotoxicology: On the problems of extrapolation from
laboratory experiments with individuals and populations to community effects in the field. Comp.
Biochem. Physiol. 100C(1/2):301-304.

1.  Ecotoxicology is defined as the study of the effect of toxicants on structure and function of
       ecosystems.
2.  Properties of individuals and populations in laboratory experiments differ from those in the field with
       respect to distribution in space and time as well as to genetic structure.
3.  Studies of community response can only be extrapolated to other systems if they include the analysis
       of the causal chain.
4.  Causal explanations require a system analysis at different trophic levels as well as a modelling of the
       system and an analysis  of sensitivity.
5.  A research project is presented that deals with most of the suggested problems.

474.Severinghaus, W. 1981. Guild theory development as a mechanism for assessing environmental
impact. Environ. Manage. 5:187-190.

The following proposed procedures are designed, through the use of guild theory, to allow relatively
accurate, quantifiable predictions of environmental impact that can be aimed at both quantitative
(biomass)  and qualitative (diversity) aspects of the flora and fauna of the proposed area of impact.
Examination of impact on plant and animal guilds should allow determination of the cause-effect
relationships between the perturbation and the environment, thus giving insight into potential mitigating
procedures. The author proposes that guilds designed from an applied perspective can be used as an
analytical and predictive tool in environmental management.

Key Words: Guild theory, Impact predictions

475.Sheehan, P. 1984. Effects on community and ecosystem structure and dynamics. Pages 51-99. In:
P. Sheehan, D. Miller, C. Butler, and P. Bourdeau, eds. Effects of  Pollutants at the Ecosystem  Level.
SCOPE 22. John Wiley & Sons, New York.

This chapter covers effects on ecosystems in the following areas: abundance and biomass, reduction in
population size and extinction, community composition and species dominance, species diversity and
similarity indices, spatial structure, stability, and succession and  recovery.

476.Sheehan, P.J. 1984. Functional changes in the ecosystem.  Pages 101-146 In: P.J. Sheehan, D.R.
Miller, and G.C. Butler, eds. Effects of Pollutants at the Ecosystem Level. SCOPE 22. John Wiley &
Sons, New York.

This chapter covers effects in the following areas: material  and energy movement, decomposition and
element cycles, productivity and respiration, food-web and functional regulation, and energy flow and
nutrient cycling.

477.Sheehy, G. 1989. Environmental indicator research: A literature review for state of the environment
(SOE) reporting. (Draft) Technical  Report Series No. 7. Strategies  and Scientific Methods, SOE
Reporting Branch, Canadian Wildlife Service.  Environment  Canada, Ottawa.

The development of a set of environmental indicators which represents the total array of desirable and
available data for state of the environment (SOE) reporting is a long-term goal of Environment
Canada's SOE  Reporting program. The concept of indicators is well-established, but rarely has the
literature been reviewed from the standpoint of information  needs in SOE reporting.  This study was
therefore commissioned as an initial stage in the development of an appropriate set of environmental
indicators for agencies which will be involved in SOE data collection and analysis. The review  provides
a documented assessment of the state of  the art of indicator research and application, with a particular
focus on North America, Europe and by international organizations. Research documents judged to be
most useful are included in an annotated bibliography of 56 references.
                                              127

-------
478.Shelfer, I.C. 1990. NOAA environmental digest: Selected environmental indicators of the United
States and the global environment - final report. NTIS No. PB91-108696/HDM. National Oceanic and
Atmospheric Administration, Office of the Chief Scientist, Washington, DC. September. ttO pp.

The National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration (NOAA) is the Nation's earth systems agency.
NOAA has the responsibility and capability to monitor the United States and the global environment.
NOAA currently monitors a number of environmental parameters on a regional and global scate.  The
paper describes a NOAA report of these atmospheric, oceanic, and biological indicators monitored by
NOAA, the offices collecting and synthesizing the data,  and the dissemination products.

479.Short, H.L. 1992. Use of the Habitat Linear Classification System to inventory and monitor the
structure of ecosystems. Pages 961-974. In: D. McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological
Indicators. Proceedings of the International Symposium on Ecological Indicators heW in Fort
Lauderdale, FL, t6-19 October, t990. Elsevier, Essex, England.

The Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP) of the Environmental Protection
Agency  can be used to describe habitat conditions and  trends for the nation's wildlife community and to
determine land-use changes attributable  to landscape fragmentation, pressure  of urbanization, impacts
of desertification, etc., within the coterminous United States.  The Habitat Linear Classification System
(HLCS)  may be a suitable indicator that,  if applied similarly across all ecosystems, could allow EPA to
achieve these important monitoring and assessment goals.  The HLCS is a simple way to translate
map-overlay data and on-site survey data into a graphic or numeric presentation that can be compared
between sample areas or between time periods for a single sample area.  HLCS provides detailed
information for all terrestrial ecosystems that have emergent vegetative structures.

The HLCS is  analogous to the  linear classification systems used by animal scientists to appraise
heritable traits of animals to represent those appraisals in an easily understood manner and to satisfy a
management goal by selecting desirable sires for herd improvement programs.  The HLCS evaluates
important structural traits of landscapes and  arrays trait information so that a manager can visualize or
understand a condition, so that management strategies to achieve some goal can be developed.

A structural trait is a variable such as broadleaf deciduous woody vegetation in the understory layer.
The HLCS is  based on point intercept measures of structural traits collected within a family of subplots
at an  evaluation site.  The HLCS provides three values when arraying trait information - density,
quantity, and  dumpiness.  Density pertains to the percent of intercept points within subplots that
encounter the trait; quantity is the percentage of  the population of subplots that contain the trait at a
prescribe density; and dumpiness is the  way that the quantity of subplots with the trait are arranged
within an evaluation site-clumped together or dispersed. The HLCS can represent data from aerial
photography or on-site measurements from field  sites.

The manuscript reports results from an intensive field assessment of a variety  of wildlife habitats in
southcentral Colorado. The point intercept data used in the HLCS analysis were of strudural traits
measured from the surface through the understory,  midstory, and overstory within 12 evaluation sites,
representing a variety of vegetational communities.  The HLCS analysis of these data described
differences in traits associated with vegetational communities and the effects of timber management
practices on vegetation structure.  The HLCS analysis associated bird species with structural traits
within layers of habitat and associated the presence of  small mammal species with structural traits at
the surface and within the understory layer of habitat.

Future efforts with the HLCS will emphasize its use in interpreting aerial photography and its potential
application to national assessments.

480.Shrlner,  D.S., C.R. Richmond, and S.E. Lindberg. 1980. Atmospheric Sulfur Deposition:
Environmental Impact and Health Effeds. Ann Arbor Science Publishers, Ann Arbor, Michigan.

Among  the different topics that are covered  include: process level effects, ecosystem level effects on
agroecosystems, forest and grassland ecosystems, and regional scale studies.
                                              128

-------
481.Shubert, L. 1984. Algae as Ecological Indicators. Academic Press, London. 434 pp.

The current volume considers the recent advances and current deficiencies in the use of algae as
indicators of ecological change. The text contains 14 papers, which are divided into 6 sections.
Sections include such subjects as freshwater, marine, and terrestrial ecosystems.  Other sections
consider toxic substances, the industrial application of algae indicators, and biological models. Tables,
graphs, and a subject index supplement the text.

482.Shugart, L.R., J. McCarthy, and R.S. Halbrook. 1992. Biological markers of environmental and
ecological contamination — An overview.  Risk Anal.  12(3):353-359.

An approach, using biomarkers (biological responses) for assessing the biological and ecological
significance of contaminants present in  the environment is described.  Living organisms integrate
exposure to contaminants in their environment and respond in some measurable and predictable way.
Responses are observed at several  levels of biological organization from the biomolecular level, where
pollutants can cause damage to critical  cellular macromolecules and elicit defensive strategies such as
detoxification and repair mechanisms, to the organismal level, where severe disturbances are
manifested as impairment in growth, reproduction, developmental abnormalities, or decreased survival.
Biomarkers  can provide not only evidence of exposure to a broad spectrum of anthropogenic
chemicals, but also a temporally integrated measure of bioavailable contaminant levels.  A suite of
biomarkers are  evaluated over time to determine the magnitude of the problem and possible
consequences.  Relationships between  biomarker response and adverse ecological effects are
determined from estimates of animal health and population structure.

Key Words: Biomarker, Environmental contamination, Environmental assessment, Ecological
significance

483.Simpson, J.W. 1989. Landscape medicine: A timely treatment. J.  Soil Water Conserv. 44:577-579.

The concept of  health is applied to the landscape in this commentary.  The author believes
opportunities in environmental management would improve if land planners and managers became
widely perceived as the landscape's doctors. The medical analogy is employed as the author promotes
diagnosis of ecosystem ills via symptoms  (indicators) such as soil erosion, water quality, reduction in
biomass, or changes in microclimate.

484.Sindermann, C. 1988.  Biological indicators and  biological effects of estuarine/coastal pollution.
Water Res. Bull. 24(5) :931-939.

Sustained interest in and concern about the health status of the aquatic environment have resulted in
extensive research focused on (1) effects  of pollution on survival, growth,  and reproduction of resource
species at all life stages; (2) diseases of fish and shellfish, that may be related to pollution and that
serve as indicators of environmental stress;  and (3) contaminant  body  burdens in fish and shellfish and
the effects of contaminants on the aquatic animals and their potential effect on humans.  Effects, lethal
and sublethal, of pollutants on life-history stages of fish and shellfish have been  documented, as have
impacts on local stocks in badly degraded habitats, but as yet there has been no adequate quantitative
demonstration of effects on entire aquatic species. This failure is probably attributable to the difficulty  in
sorting out relative effects of the many environmental factors that influence abundance.  Sublethal
effects, especially those that result in disease, have been examined intensively, and some diseases
and disease syndromes have been associated statistically with pollution.  Other pollution indicators
(biochemical- physiological,  genetic,  behavioral, and ecological) have also received some attention, as
have body burdens of contaminants  in aquatic animals.  Research, especially that conducted during the
past decade, has done much to clarify the many pathways and toxic effects of contaminants on aquatic
animals,  and has also helped to identify mechanisms for survival of fish and shellfish in  the presence of
environmental changes caused by human activities.
                                              129

-------
 Key Words: Pathology, pollution-associated; Biochemistry, pollution-associated; Chromosomes;
 Abnormalities; Indicators, biological; Lesions, liver; Skeletal abnormalities; Fin erosion; Fish; Ulcers, fish;
 Mixed function oxygenases, metallothioneins; Stress, pollution-related; Pollution, biological effects

 485.Slobodkin, L., and D. Dykhuizen.  1989. The two roles of ecotoxicology. In: Present Situation,
 Problem, Prospect and Practical Implementation Program of Education and Research for Efficient
 Utilization and Conservation of Inland Waters. Education and Research for Higher Agricultural
 Productivity, Conserving Nature and Agroecosystem in Asia and Pacific Countries Series 3. Asia and
 the Pacific Program of Educational Innovation for Development. University of Tsukuba,  Japan.

 There is still debate and uncertainty about how  to use ecotoxicology to asses whether or not and to
 what extent damage has been done to an ecological community.  The usual procedure is to use
 organisms or microorganisms as surrogates either for other organisms or for entire ecological systems.
 The authors suggest that this is an error. The ecological role of particular types of organisms should be
 independent of their role in monitoring toxicity.  The use of organisms chosen for convenience as
 chemical concentration monitors, rather than as surrogates for ecological communities would facilitate
 both  legal and managerial aspects of  applied ecology.

 486.Slocombe, D.S. 1992. Environmental monitoring for protected areas: Review and prospect.
 Environ. Monit. Assess. 21:49-78.

 Monitoring activities in protected areas have a long history.  Early internal planning and management
 needs led to ecological inventories. More recently, the  increasing number and awareness of external
 threats to parks has led to a variety of monitoring programs.  Efforts to use protected areas, especially
 biosphere reserves, as ecological baselines have reinforced this trend.  As protected areas are
 increasingly recognized to be islands  with complex internal and regional interactions, holistic, systems
 approaches to inventory, monitoring, and assessment of their state are being developed. This paper
 begins with a review of the threats to  parks and the origins and importance of inventory and monitoring
 activities and is followed by a review of resource survey methods. Ecosystem science and
 environmental monitoring are introduced as a basis for  considering several newer approaches to
 monitoring and assessing natural environments. These newer approaches are stress/response
 frameworks, landscape ecology, ecosystem integrity, and state of the environment reporting. A final
 section presents some principles for monitoring the state of protected areas.  Examples are drawn from
 experience with Canadian National Parks.

 487.Smith, W. 1984. Ecosystem pathology: A new perspective for phytopathology. For. Ecol.  Manage.
 9:193-219.

 Evaluations of ecosystem health are substantially different from evaluations  of individual plant health.
 The significance of regional air pollutants (e.g.,  ozone, acid deposition, and trace metals) must be
 evaluated in terms of ecosystem health. All ecosystems have common components organized in
 structural patterns and united by functional processes.  The most important ecosystem components
 affected by regional air pollutants include the producers and decomposers.  These influences can alter
, the processes of energy flow (production) and biogeochemical cycling.  This alteration, in turn, can
 change the production of biomass and/or the pattern of succession of the ecosystem.  Forest
 ecosystem interaction with three air pollutants is reviewed to illustrate ecosystem pathology.

 488.Smith, W. 1980. Air pollution—A 20th  century allogenic influence on forest ecosystems. Pages 79-
 87. In: Proceedings of Symposium on Effects of Air Pollutants on Mediterranean and Temperate Forest
 Ecosystems. U.S.D.A. Forest Service Pacific SW Forest Experiment Station General Technical  Report
 PSW-43. U.S. Department of Agriculture, Berkeley, CA.

 Chronic doses of ozone, sulfur dioxide, nitrogen oxides, hydrogen fluoride, and other primary  or
 secondary gaseous air contaminants  may cause subtle effects on forest ecosystems. Air pollutants
 may influence reproduction, nutrient cycling, photosynthesis, predisposition to entomological or
 pathological stress, or quantity of healthy foliar  tissue.  Forest ecosystem response to chronic air
 pollution may include alterations in growth  rates and successional patterns.  The establishment of
                                               130

-------
comprehensive field and laboratory investigations to systematically examine chronic air pollution stress
on forest ecosystems in those parts of the world subject to atmospheric contamination is concluded to
be of top priority.  In the United States, forest ecosystems judged to be at particular risk and In need of
more intensive investigation include the Northern Hardwood forest, Central Hardwood forest, and
Western Montane forest.

489.Smith, W.H. 1990. The health  of North American forests: Stress and risk assessment. What is the
condition of temperate forests? J. For. 88(1):32-35.

Making generalizations about the health of North American forests is difficult because of the
extraordinary diversity of forests, management regimes, and stress factors. Thus, this overview article
will summarize forest health fundamentals, significant health risks, and priorities in future forest health
management for temperate forests  of the United States.

490.Smol, J.P.  1992. Paleolimnology: An important tool for effective ecosystem management.  J.
Aquat.  Ecosyst. Health 1(1):49-58.

Effective management of aquatic resources requires long-term environmental data.  However, because
long-term observations are rarely available, indirect proxy methods must be used to substitute for these
missing historical data sets.  Major  advances have been made in paleolimnology over the past decade,
and many of these advances can be applied directly to integrated and cost-effective assessments of
aquatic ecosystem health.  This commentary uses the analogy of human health to argue that
paleolimnological data provide information crucial to the decision-making process of ecosystem
managers.

Key Words: Lake management, Ecosystem Health, Long-term monitoring, Indicators, Acidification

491.Spellerberg, I.F. 1991. Monitoring Ecological Change. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge,
England.

This book is an introductory survey on the topic of ecological monitoring. The author assesses how
changes in biological communities,  ecosystems,  and populations have been monitored. He also
assesses the role of single organisms in monitoring environmental change. The emphasis in this book
is not necessarily on pollution or even the effects of physical disturbances brought about by man's
exploitation of nature and natural resources. The emphasis throughout the book is on the assessment
of biological and ecological monitoring programs, particularly with regard to conservation.

Chapters are: The science and art of monitoring; World programs and monitoring organizations;
Biological monitoring in the United States and Europe; Elements of ecology and ecological methods;
Biological indicators; Diversity; Similarity; Environmental and biotic indices; Biological variables,
processes, and  ecosystems;  Planning the monitoring; Monitoring bird populations; Freshwater biological
monitoring; Insularization and nature conservation; Monitoring  land use and landscapes; Environmental
impact  assessments and monitoring; and Species monitoring and conservation.

492.Stakeholder Group on Environmental Reporting. 1987. A study of environmental reporting In
Canada. Environment Canada, Ottawa.

493.Stebbing, A. 1981. Stress, health, and homeostasis. Mar. Poll. Bull.  12:326-329.

In recent times the concept of stress has been applied to physiological studies of marine vertebrates,
but often its use is followed by requests for definition or qualification. The author attempts to identify
the causes of confusion, to discuss the concept of stress in a  context that may help clarify some of the
sources of difficulty, and to develop these ideas in the framework of toxicology.

494.Steedman, R., and H. Regier. 1987. Ecosystem science  for the Great Lakes: Perspectives on
degradative and rehabilitative transformations. Can. J. Fish. Aquat. Sci., Suppl. 2. 44:95-103.
                                              131

-------
Conventional approaches to ecological management presuppose the preeminence of normal natural
processes in quasi-equilibrium state, in the presence of one or a few cultural stresses of light to
moderate intensities. They also presuppose that the abiotic and biotic structural form of the ecosystem
is relatively unaffected. In some parts of the Great Lakes, normal natural ecosystem processes have
been overwhelmed by numerous intense cultural factors.  Rehabilitation of such areas requires
information and understanding of a type that is not central to conventional fisheries biology.  The
authors review and extend existing scientific approaches that contribute to an effective and relevant
"ecosystem science," according  to the criteria that they (1) incorporate spatial and structural models
appropriate to an ecosystem perspective of the Great Lakes basin, (2) incorporate functional attributes
actually observed in stressed  and culturally degraded aquatic ecosystems, and (3) provide information
directly relevant to effective, informal, broadly based mechanisms of ecosystem rehabilitation and
husbandry.

Subtopics covered in this article are (1)  approaches to the study of structure in aquatic ecosystems; (2)
ecosystem response to stress; and (3) rehabilitation of degraded systems.

495.Steedman, R.J., and H.A. Regier.  1990.  Ecological bases for an understanding of ecosystem
integrity in the Great Lakes Basin. Pages 257-270. In: C.J. Edwards and H.A. Regier, eds. An
Ecosystem Approach to the Integrity of the Great Lakes in Turbulent Times.  Great Lakes Fishery
Commission Special Publication 90-4. Great Lakes Fishery Commission, Ann Arbor, Ml.

Use of the word  integrity, when applied  to natural ecosystems as affected by human cultural activities,
may connote health as sketched by Neess (1974) in which the ecosystem

1. is energetic, in that natural ecosystemic processes are strong and nor severely constrained;

2. is self-organizing, in an emerging, evolving way;

3. is self-defending, against invasions by exotic organisms;

4. has biotic capabilities in reserve, to survive and recover from occasional severe crises;

5. is attractive, at least to informed humans; and

6. is productive in terms of goods and opportunities valued by humans.

Of these six features, the first four need not relate directly to human interests, as do the last two. Thus,
the first four may be treated objectively  in the  sense that subjective cultural interests are absent.  The
term integrality might be used to refer to the systemic state of a healthy ecosystem, which can be
characterized fully by the objective methods of natural science.

To  make operational a concept  of ecological integrity (or  integrality), ecological phenomena may be
related to ideas in system theory and to empiric generalizations about ecosystems.  In particular, we
should know how ecological  integrity develops, how it responds to turbulent or surprising external
influences or stresses, how it may be measured, and how it may be managed. Each of these topics is
addressed briefly in this chapter.

496.Steinhart, C.E., L. Schierow,  and  W.C. Sonzogi. 1982. An environmental quality  index for the
Great Lakes. Water Res. Bull. 18(6): 1025-1031.

To  facilitate communication on the environmental quality  of lakes, particularly among policymakers and
the general public, a new index for summarizing technical information is presented.  The index is
designed for the nearshore waters  of the North American  Great lakes, but the concept is applicable to
other temperate lakes with relatively good  water quality.  The index is based on nine physical (P),
chemical (C), biological (B), and toxic substance (T) variables.  Raw data are converted to subindex
values by mathematically defined functions based on national or international objectives.  Subindex
values are multiplied by weighting factors and are added together to yield a final  score  ranging from 0,
                                               132

-------
worst quality, to 100, highest quality.  Subscripted letters following the index score indicate the types
and numbers of variables whose values are equal to or worse than the objective (e.g., 70 C,P,
indicates that one chemical and one physical variable exceeded the objective). For eighteen nearshore
locations in the Great Lakes, index scores ranged from 98 at two stations in Lake Superior to 30
C2P,B2T3 off Point Mouillee, off Lake Erie.  If properly utilized, the index should be a useful tool to help
managers evaluate the response of the Great Lakes to the multibillion dollar cleanup efforts conducted
during the 1970s.

Key Words: Water quality, Index, Great Lakes, Toxic substances, Pollution control

497.Stohlgren, T.J., and J.F. Qulnn. 1992. An assessment of biotic inventories in the western United
States national parks. Natur. Areas J. 12(3):145-153.

The authors evaluated existing natural resources  data from 40 national parks and monuments in the
U.S. National Park Service's Western Region, which includes Arizona, California, Hawaii, Nevada, and
several Pacific Trust Territories.  Better information on species occurrence was available for vascular
plants, mammals, and birds than for other taxa (reptiles, amphibians, fish, terrestrial  invertebrates,
aquatic invertebrates, and non-vascular plants).  Although most parks had  compiled  species lists for at
least some taxa, the majority of the lists were reported to be less than complete in their species,
geographic, and ecologic (community type) coverage.  None of the species lists resulted from
systematic parkwide surveys.  About half of the parks reported essentially no research on invertebrates
or non-vascular plants — major components of biological diversity.  The actual status of natural
resources information is difficult to assess because of (1) a lack of catalogued and readily accessible
information on past studies of resources, (2) essentially no standardization in recording procedures, (3)
missing or poorly maintained voucher specimens, and (4) disproportionate  attention to "popular" taxa.
Large parks tended  to have more information about their natural resources than smaller parks that
historically have received less funding for research and resource management activities.  If parks are to
serve as baselines against which to measure environmental change,  there is an urgent need to rank
inventorying and monitoring needs, standardize recording techniques, test model inventory and
monitoring systems, substantially improve the natural  resource awareness of al National Park Service
staff, and develop a hierarchical framework of methods to collect and synthesize biological resource
data over large spatial and long temporal  scales.  The authors present suggestions for strengthening
biological inventory programs in the U.S. National Park system.

498.Stokes, P.,  M. Havas, and T.  Brydges. 1990. Public participation and volunteer help in monitoring
programs: An assessment. Environ. Monitor. Assess.  15:225-229.

A number of opportunities exist for  involving the public in environmental monitoring.  This paper outlines
some examples in which this has been done, evaluates these examples, and then summarizes some of
the benefits as well  as the disadvantages of this approach.

499.Stokes, P., and Piekarz, D., eds. 1987. Ecological indicators of  the state of the environment.
Environmental Interpretation Division. Environment Canada, Ottawa.

SOO.Stolte, K.W., D.M. Durlscoe, E.R. Cook, and S.P. Cllne. 1992.  Methods of assessing responses
of trees, stands, and ecosystems to air pollution. Pages 259-330. In:  R.K. Olsen, D.  Binkley, and M.
Bohn, eds. Response of Western Forests to Air Pollution. Springer-Verlag, New York.

501.Stork, N., and P. Eggleton. 1992. Invertebrates as determinants and indicators of soil quality. Am.
J.  Altem. Agric. 7(1-2):38-47.

Invertebrates are an  integral part of soils and are important in determining the suitability of soils for the
sustainable production of healthy crops or trees.  The authors discuss the importance of the soil
invertebrate fauna in relation to terrestrial and global biodiversity. The authors describe the role of the
main Invertebrate groups in soils, including earthworms, termites, springtails, and nematodes, and how
they determine soil quality. Practical problems in dealing with the invertebrate fauna include sampling,
taxonomy and availability of biological information on species. Various measures are available that use
                                              133

-------
invertebrates to assess soil quality, each with its advantages and disadvantages. They include
abundance,  biomass, density, species richness, trophic/guild structure, food web structure, keystone
species and ecosystem engineers.  The authors propose the three most useful and practical of these
as suitable to be combined with other biological (microbial) and non-biological (hydrological, physical,
chemical) criteria into a single index of soil quality that might be used on a regional, if not international
basis.

Key Words:  Biodiversity, Soil invertebrates, Species richness, Keystone species, Earthworms,
Springtails, Nematodes, Termites

502.Study Group on Environmental Monitoring. 1977. Environmental  Monitoring. Report to the U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency. National Research Council. National Academy of Sciences,
Washington, DC.

This report is divided into four sections: An overview of current environmental monitoring programs,
purposes of monitoring, EPA's management of scientific data, and toward more effective national
environmental monitoring. A brief discussion is provided on ecological effects monitoring and the use
of indicators.

503.Stumpp, J., and W.  Mucke. 1991. Environmental monitoring with biological indicators—A program
for recording the impact of pollutants on terrestrial ecosystems. (In German, abstract in German,
English). Staub Reinhalt.  Luft 51(9):295-299.

Biological indicators are used in environmental monitoring programs. Besides chemical and physical
measurements, biomonitoring methods are part of ecological monitoring  programs.  According to the
ranges of application, a minimum program for terrestrial ecosystems is presented.  Based on proved
and standardized methods it involves (1) long-term monitoring of natural ecosystems: control of
changes in vegetation and chemical analysis;  (2) wide-spread monitoring networks: lichen-vegetation,
indicators of photochemical oxidants, moss and spruce; and (3) local and regional monitoring: lichen-
exposure, indicators of photochemical oxidants, standardized grass-culture, and borecole.

504.Suter II, G.W. 1989.  Ecological endpoints. Pages 2-1 - 2-28. In: W. Warren-Hicks, B.R.  Parkhurst,
and S.S. Baker, Jr., eds.  Ecological assessment of hazardous waste sites: A field and laboratory
reference. EPA/600/3-89/013. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Corvallis,  OR.

The purpose of ecological assessment of hazardous waste sites is to provide input to the decision-
making processes  associated with  a broad range of applications, including site prioritization, waste
characterization, site characterization, cleanup or remediation assessment, and  site monitoring. The
results of the ecological assessment that constitute the input to the decision making processes are
descriptions of the relationship of pollutants to ecological endpoints.  If the ecological endpoints are not
compelling,  they will not contribute to the decision. This chapter describes two different types of
endpoints, presents criteria for judging endpoints, presents classes of endpoints that are potentially
useful in assessments of waste sites, judges them by the criteria, and discusses how the nature of the
assessment problem affects endpoint choice.

SOS.Suter II, G.W. 1990. Endpoints for regional ecological risk assessments. Environ. Manage. 14(1):9-
23.
Ecological risk assessments must have clearly defined endpoints that are socially and biologically
relevant, accessible to  prediction and measurement, and susceptible to the hazard being assessed.
Most ecological assessments do not have such endpoints, in part because the endpoints of toxicity
tests  or other measurements of effects are used as assessment endpoints. This article distinguishes
assessment and measurement endpoints in terms of their roles in risk assessments and explains how
the criteria for their selection differ.  It then presents  critical discussions of possible assessment and
measurement endpoints for regional ecological risk assessments.  Finally, the article explains how
endpoint selection is affected by the goal of assessment. Generic goals for regional risk assessment
include explanation of observed regional effects, evaluation of an action with regional implications, and
evaluation of the state  of a region.  Currently, population level assessment endpoints such as
                                               134

-------
abundance and range are the most generally useful.  For higher levels (ecosystems and regions) data
are generally not available and the validity of models has not been demonstrated, and for lower level
effects (physiological and organismal), data are not relevant. However, landscape descriptors, material
export, and other regional-scale measurement endpoints show promise for regional assessments.

Key Words: Endpoints, Risk, Assessment, Regional, Landscape

506.Suter II,  G.W. 1993.  In Press. A critique of ecosystem health concepts and indices.  Environ.
Toxicol. Chem. 12.

Because people wish to preserve their health and wish to do something equivalent for ecosystems, the
metaphor of ecosystem health springs to mind. This paper presents the argument that it is a mistake
for environmental  scientists to treat this metaphor as reality.  First, the metaphor fails because it
misrepresents both ecology and health science.  Ecosystems are not organisms, so they do not behave
like organisms and do not have the properties of organisms such as health.  Also, health is not an
operational concept for physicians or health  risk assessors because they  must predict, diagnose, and
treat specific  states called diseases or injuries; they do not calculate indices of health. Second,
attempts to operationally define ecosystem health result in the creation of indices of heterogeneous
variables. Such indices have no meaning, they cannot be predicted  so they are not applicable to most
regulatory problems, they have no diagnostic power, effects on one component are "eclipsed" by
responses of other components, and the  reason for a high or low index value is unknown. Their only
virtue is that they reduce the complex array of responses of various ecosystems to various disturbances
to one number with a reassuring name. A better alternative is to assess the real array of ecosystem
responses so that causes can be diagnosed, future states can be predicted, and benefits of treatments
can be compared.

Key Words: Endpoint, Ecosystem health, Environmental health, Index,  Indices, IBI

507.Szaro, R. 1986. Guild management:  An evaluation of avian guilds as a predictive tool. Environ.
Manage. 10:681-688.

The use and  applicability of the guild concept to management is evaluated and questioned.  Ecological
problems are never as simple as implied  in using one or two guild axes.  A close examination of bird
communities  in a ponderosa pine forest reveals little relationship between guilds or guild  blocks and the
responses exhibited by individual bird species or bird species groups.  Response guilds changed from
year to year without any obvious changes in vegetation.  A 3 year composite analysis shows a clearer
picture of the responses of ponderosa pine forest birds to the overall interactions between structure,
weather,  competition, and so on than  does guild analysis.  The six response groups in the composite
analysis are species that (1) were absent in  1973 on most or all study plots and showed  no preference
for any forested site; (2) had their highest densities on the medium-cut and light-cut plots; (3) were
absent in 1973 on most or all study plots and had their highest densities on the medium-cut and light-
cut plots; (4)  had their highest densities on the untested, light-cut and medium-cut plots;  (5) had their
highest densities on the untreated and light-cut plots and were either absent or had greatly reduced
densities on all other plots; (6) were present only on the clearcut, except for the Rock Wren which was
also on the medium-cut and heavy-cut plots.  The overall correlation between species density and guild
density was significantly higher for response guilds (alpha < 0.05) than for any of the structural or
functional guilds. The whole concept  of guild management must be further researched and developed
before it can  be recommended  as a management tool.

SOS.Szaro, R., and R. Balda. 1982. Selection and monitoring of avian  indicator species:  An example
from a ponderosa pine forest in the southwest. General Technical Report RM-89. U.S.D.A. Forest
Service.

509.Taub, F.  1987. Indicators of change in natural and human-impacted ecosystems: Status. Pages
115-144. In: S. Draggan, J. Cohrssen, and R. Morrison, eds. Preserving Ecological Systems:  The
Agenda for Long-term Research and Development. Praeger, New York.
                                              135

-------
Even if an ecological change is associated with human impacts, it is often a major problem to identify a
specific cause from among the myriad of changes that simultaneously impact a developed area.  It is
still a greater problem to decide when a change represents an unacceptable or dangerous alteration in
an ecosystem.  Some contend that only changes involving human health or economic concerns are
important. Others  see value in documenting ecological changes even if the biological significance of
these indices are currently unknown.  When is there enough confidence in our ecological indicators to
implement policies that have major economic impacts such as power production, chemical use  and
disposal? Is a modest change in an ecological index an early warning of a serious problem or  merely a
short-term alteration in a highly variable, complex, and self-regulating variable? This  paper is restricted
to reviewing indicators of change, their inadequacies, and new research that might improve the
situation.

51 O.Taylor,  G., and D. Shriner. 1981. Indicators of air pollution stress in terrestrial ecosystems.
(abstract only). BuH. Ecol. Soc. Am. 62(2):90.

Throughout regions of the eastern United States, various components of terrestrial ecosystems are
exposed  to differing degrees of elevated levels of gaseous and paniculate atmospheric pollutants.
Although the deposition of such pollutants under conditions of high pollutant loading is recognized to
cause significant alterations of ecosystem structure  and/or function, ecosystem level-responses to low
and intermediate levels of pollutant exposure are difficult to assess. To  estimate the  significance of
subtle air pollution stress on a regional basis, sensitive indicators of chronic exposure to low  levels of
pollutant  loading are required.  Parameters capable of direct measurement for  representative
ecosystem components are suggested (e.g., suppressed  photosynthesis, enhanced respiration  and
growth).  These parameters can be related to altered system function  (e.g., reduced productivity or
vigor), combinations of chemical fate, and mobility of pollutants impacting producer, consumer,  or
decomposer populations.

51 I.Thomas, J., D. McKenzie, and L. Eberhardt.  1981. Some limitations of biological monitoring.
Environ.  Int. 5:3-10.

Biological monitoring data are obtained to document changes in population abundance for resource
management, to verify compliance  with regulatory directives, and to assess cause and effect for
research purposes. Particular statistical analyses are often not appropriate because suitable field
designs are either not available or not matched a priori to the monitoring objectives.  When monitoring
to detect normal changes in population numbers, quantitative problems may not be as difficult as they
are in detecting and assigning causation induced by a natural or man-made pollutant. Changes in
biotic abundance can be caused or influenced by compensation, indirect effects, direct mortality,  and
interactions among environmental variables.  Even though data from baseline monitoring programs
usually should be only used to detect change in biotic abundance,  they sometimes can  be used to draw
inferences about cause by correlation or to test laboratory results against a long-term historical record.
Available quantitative  methodologies  useful in evaluating  monitoring data are limited and interpretations
about cause and effect are  difficult.

512.Thomas, W. 1972. Indicators of  Environmental Quality. Plenum Press, New York.

This book contains an overview of  indicators and environmental (and social) indices.  Chapters discuss:
Why environmental quality indices, uses of indices in policy formulation, the obligations  of scientists to
explain environment to the public, indicators of environmental quality of urban life, establishing  priorities
among environmental stresses, aquatic communities as indices of  pollution, plants as indicators of air
quality, biochemical indicators of pollution, and plants as  indicators in  ecology. Other chapters focus on
recreation, radioactivity, soil quality, and environmental noise.

513.Train, R.  1972. The quest for environmental indices. Science  178:121.

This editorial briefly discusses environmental indices: the need for  them, what  makes a good index, and
obstacles to developing a good index.
                                               136

-------
514.Treshow, M. 1978. Terrestrial plants and plant communities. Pages 223-237. In: G.C. Butler, ed.
Principles of Ecotoxicology. John Wiley & Sons, Chichester, England.

This chapter is divided into the following sections and subsections: Introduction; Toxicant Uptake;
Responses of  Communities to Perturbation — (i) Physiological responses, (ii) Responses  of organisms,
(Hi) Responses of plant communities, (iv) Agricultural systems; Diagnosing Community Dysfunction — (i)
Diagnosing changes, (ii) Predicting changes; and Conclusions.

51 S.Tyson, J., and M. House. 1989. The application of a water quality index to river management.
Pages 175-186. In: Urban Discharges and Receiving Water Quality Impacts. (Series: Advances in
Water Pollution Control). Pergamon Press,  Ltd., Oxford.

516.Ulanowicz, R. E. 1978. Modeling environmental stress. Pages 1-18. In: J. Thorp and J. Gibbons,
eds. Energy and Environmental Stress in Aquatic Systems. Department of Energy Symposium Series
CONF 771114. Department of Energy, Technical Information Service, Oak Ridge, TN.

The word "stress" when applied to ecosystems is ambiguous. Stress may be low-level, with
accompanying near-linear strain, or it may be of finite magnitude, with nonlinear response and possible
disintegration of the system.  Because there are no widely accepted definitions of ecosystem strain,
classification of models of stressed systems is tenuous. Despite appearances, most ecosystem models
seem to fall into the low-level linear response category. Although they sometimes simulate system
behavior well, they do not provide necessary and sufficient information about sudden structural changes
nor structure after transition.  Dynamic models of finite-amplitude response to stress are rare because
of analytical difficulties. Some idea about future transition states can be obtained by regarding the
behavior of unperturbed functions under limiting strain conditions.  Preliminary work shows that,
because community variables do respond in a coherent manner to stress, macroscopic analyses of
stressed ecosystems offer possible alternatives to compartmental models.

517.Ulanowicz, R.E. 1986. A phenomenological perspective of ecological development.  Pages 73-81.
In: T.M. Poston and R. Purdy, eds. Aquatic Toxicology and Environmental Fate: Ninth Volume. ASTM
STP 921. American Society for Testing and Materials, Philadelphia, Pa.

The most direct and realistic approach to quantifying ecosystems is to measure their supporting
networks of flows of materials and energy.  The growth and development of such networks may be
quantified by applying information theory to the data on flows. Once development has been formalized,
other heretofore subjective notions, such as "eutrophication" and "ecosystem health," take on more
precise, quantitative significance.

Key Words: Aquatic toxicology, Ecosystem theory, Food webs, Information theory, Thermodynamics,
Self-organization, Eutrophication,  Ecosystem health, Networks

518.Ulanowicz, R.E. 1986. Growth and Development:  Ecosystems Phenomenology. Springer-Verlag,
New York. 286 pp.

519.Ulrich, B.  1983. An ecosystem oriented hypothesis on the effect of air pollution on  forest
ecosystems. Pages 221-231. In: Ecological  Effects of Acid Precipitation. Rep. PM 1636. National
Swedish Environment Protection Board.

520.Underwood, A. 1989. The analysis of stress in  natural populations. Biol. J. Linnean Soc. 37:51-78.


Populations usually persist despite environmental variations.  Experimental analysis of responses to
stress must include distinction between potential stresses  (environmental perturbations that might not
cause stress) and actual stress (phenomena that cause a response by the population).  This is made
difficult by large temporal  fluctuations in the abundance data of many organisms.  Monitoring can
measure this variability but is insufficient to  predict the  potential impact of most stresses.  Experimental
analyses of stresses are also made difficult by differences in  population inertia (lack of response to
                                             137

-------
perturbation), resilience (magnitude of stresses from which a population can recover), and stability (rate
of recovery following a stress). These attributes of population cause a range of responses to
intermittent, temporary,  and acute (or "pulse") stresses and to long-term chronic ("press") disturbances.
The timing, magnitude,  and order of stresses can cause different responses by populations.
Synergisms between simultaneous or successive stresses can also have unpredictable effects on
populations and cause complexity in interpretation of patterns of competition and predation.
Experimental manipulations are needed to understand the likely  effect of environmental disturbance on
populations.  The appropriate  experiments are those designed to measure the effects of different types,
magnitudes, and frequencies of simulated stresses.  These will be more revealing than the more
common experimental analyses used to determine why and how observed changes in abundances of
populations are caused by existing stresses.

Key Words: Stress, Perturbation, Inertia, Resilience, Stability,  Experimental design, Prediction

521.Underwood, A. 1991. Beyond  baci — Experimental designs for detecting human environmental
impacts on temporal variations in natural populations. Aust. J. Mar. Freshwater Res. 42(5):569-587.

Biological effects of environmental impacts are usually defined simplistically in terms of changes in the
mean of some biological variable.  Many types of impacts do not necessarily change long-run mean
abundances.  Here, designs for detection of environmental impact are reviewed and some
shortcomings noted.  New sampling designs to detect impacts that cause changes in temporal variance
in abundance of populations, rather than in the means,  are described.  These designs are effective at
distinguishing pulse and press episodes of disturbance  and could be used for other variables of  interest
(size, reproductive state, rate  of growth, number of species, etc.) for monitoring.  The designs require
sampling different time-scales before and after a proposed development that might cause impact.
Cases are discussed in which there is a single control location.  This approach is inadequate for
management of impacts that cause temporal change rather than alterations of the mean abundance of
population.

522.United States House of  Representatives. 1984. "Environmental Monitoring and Improvement
Act": Hearings before the Subcommittee on Natural Resources,  Agricultural Research, and the
Environment of the Committee on Science and Technology. March 28, 1984. U.S. Government Printing
Office, Washington, DC.

523.Usher, M.B. 1991. Scientific requirements of a monitoring programme. Pages  16-32.  In: B.
Goldsmith, ed. Monitoring for  Conservation and Ecology. Chapman and Hall, London.

In planning a monitoring program, five basic questions need to be answered.  Each question is
important and should be answered  before any monitoring begins; these questions essentially form a
sequential set because a satisfactory answer to any individual question cannot be given until all
questions higher on the list have been answered.  The  questions are:

1. Purpose: What is the aim of monitoring?
2. Method: How can this aim  be achieved?
3. Analysis: How are the data, which will be collected periodically, to be handled?
4. Interpretation: What  might the data mean?
5. Fulfillment: When will the aim have been achieved?

The aim of this chapter is to follow these questions through,  discussing aspects of each that relate to
the data being collected and the interpretations likely to be placed on them. Many of the subsequent
chapters address specific issues raised by these five broader questions.

524.van Straalen, N.N., and  R.G.M. de Goede. 1987.  Productivity as a population performance index
in life-cycle toxicity tests. Water Sci. Technol. 19(11):13-20.

Toxicity at the population level is often measured by the intrinsic rate of population increase (rj. In this
paper, the biomass turnover ratio (P/B) of a population is introduced as another measure of population
                                              138

-------
performance under toxic stress. An expression is derived by which the intrinsic P/B ratio may be
calculated from life-table data. Unlike rm, P/B depends also on the individual growth curve. The theory
is exemplified by experimental data on the effect of cadmium on Orchesella cincta (Collembola) from
forest soil.  The results are compared with seasonal fluctuations of productivity in an unstressed field
population.  Toxic effects of cadmium appear at a much lower exposure level than would be deduced
from the P/B ratio. Some mechanism of compensation seems to be present in that the high natural
mortality (by predation) obscures the sublethal effects on growth.  This may explain why Collembola
can inhabit forest soils that are contaminated to levels far above the no-effect level for individual
growth.

Key Words: Cadmium,  Orchesella cincta, Collembola, Soil pollution,  Productivity, Toxicity

525.Vass, R. 1982. Surveillance monitoring versus system investigation. Pages 23-39. In: B. Hart, ed.
Water Quality Management: Monitoring  Programs and Diffuse Runoff.  Water Studies Centre. Chisolm
Institute of Technology  and Australian Society for Limnology, Melbourne, Australia.

526.Vighi, M. 1991. Environmental decision-making—The ecotoxicological contribution. Pages 211-216.
In: J.B. Opschoor and D.W. Pearce, eds. Persistent Pollutants: Economics and Policy. Kluwer
Academic Publishers, Dordrecht, The Netherlands.

This article provides two case studies as good examples of the kind of information ecotoxicology can
produce for  the management of environmental problems.  Ecotoxicological approaches for the study of
marine pollution and the environmental  impact of pesticides are provided.

527.Vinogradov, B. 1990. Remote sensing of biosphere state and ecosystem dynamics. Pages 693-
704. In: H. Lund and G. Preto, eds. Global Natural Resource Monitoring and Assessments: Preparing
for the 21st  Century. American Society for  Photogrammetry and Remote Sensing, Bethesda, MD.

At the present time the development of  a reliable system for ecological data collection is a main
problem of both a synthetical and analytical global approach to biosphere studies.  On the one hand,
the global synthesis of ecological data is provided with complete and regular space surveys at small
scales. On the other
hand, the local analysis of these data is obtained from selective and permanent ecological observations
on the set of the ground truth stations covering a wide range of the different ecoregions. This is a main
area of involvement of IGBP "Global Change", no less important than the formation of the satellite
world-wide data survey, collection, and analysis systems.  This set of ground truth stations which
provides the satellite systems with information and includes forest and agricultural experiment stations,
ecological observation sites, biosphere reserves, natural reserves,
undersatellite ecological test sites, and others.

528.Visser,  S., and D.  Parkinson. Soil  biological criteria as  indicators of soil quality: Soil
microorganisms. Am. J. Altern. Agric. 7(1-2):33-37.

Diverse soil  microbiological studies have attempted to assess deterioration or improvement in soil
quality.  These studies have been done on three levels:  population level studies of the dynamics of
species that are presumed to be important or sensitive; community level studies of microblal community
structure, such as species diversity and frequency of occurrence of species; and ecosystem level
studies of a range of soil processes. The authors suggest that ecosystem level approaches offer the
best possibilities for rapidly assessing changes in soil quality. Data from such studies will allow
researchers  to decide whether to proceed with population or community level studies.

Key Words:  Soil bacteria, Soil fungi, Total microbial  biomass, Carbon cycling, Nitrogen cycling, Nutrient
leaching, Soil enzymes

529.Vltousek, P. 1990. Biological invasions and ecosystem processes: Towards an integration of
population biology and ecosystem studies.  Oikos 57:7-13.
                                              139

-------
Biological invasions by exotic species clearly alter the composition and community structure of invaded
areas.  There is increasing evidence that they  can also alter properties of whole ecosystems, including
productivity, nutrient cycling, and hydrology. For example, the exotic actinorrhizal nitrogen-fixer Myrica
faya alters primary successions! ecosystems in Hawaii Volcanoes National Park by quadrupling inputs
of nitrogen  , the nutrient limiting to plant growth. A few other examples of ecosystem-level changes
have been documented. Biological invaders change ecosystems by differing from native species in
resource acquisition and/or  resource use efficiency,  by altering the trophic structure of the area invaded,
or by altering disturbance frequency and/or intensity.  Where exotic species clearly affect ecosystem-
level properties, they provide the raw material  for integrating the methods and approaches of
ecosystem ecology.

530.Vonk, J.W. 1983. Problems in characterizing the  ecological quality of soil in relation to human
activities. Environ. Monitor.  Assess. 3(3/4):289-296.

The  soil ecosystem is composed of various groups of organisms which have  complex relations.  The
physical structure and chemical characteristics of the soil provide the boundary conditions. In view of
various deteriorating human activities, it is important to find soil quality characteristics with respect to its
most important function: the ecological function. An enumeration has been given of chemical, physical,
and biological soil parameters which are more or less important for soil quality.  Several of these
parameters are discussed.  For use as indicators of deterioration, for a given site, the optimum values
of the soil parameters have to be established,  as well as acceptable deviations from the optimum,
taking into account natural fluctuation. It is concluded that, due to lack of data, such an approach is not
possible at  this moment.  However, it might be possible to identify those soil  parameters which should
be taken into consideration  when evaluating human activities.

531.Vos, J.B., J.F.  Feenstra, J. de Boer, L.C. Braat, and J. van Baalen. 1985. Indicators for the
State of the Environment. Institute for Environmental Studies, Free  University, Amsterdam.

532.Walker, B.H. 1992. Biodiversity and ecological  redundancy. Conserv. Biol. 6:18-23.

This paper  addresses the problem of which biota to choose to best satisfy the conservation goals for a
particular region  in the face of inadequate resources.  Biodiversity is taken to be the integration of
biological variability across  all scales, from the genetic, through species and  ecosystems,  to
landscapes. Conserving biodiversity is a daunting task, and the paper asserts that focusing on species
is not the best approach. The  best way to minimize species loss is to maintain  the integrity of
ecosystem  function.  The important questions  therefore concern the kinds of  biodiversity that are
significant to ecosystem functioning. To best focus  our efforts we need to establish how much (or how
little) redundancy there is in the biological composition of ecosystem.  An approach is suggested, based
on the  use  of functional groups of organisms defined  according to ecosystem processes.  Functional
groups with little or no redundancy warrant priority conservation effort. Complementary species-based
approaches for maximizing  the inclusion of biodiversity within a set of conservation areas  are compared
to the functional;! group approach.

533.Walker, J., and B. Jones.  1992. What is  meant by indicators and the decisions behind those
chosen for  the Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program of the U.S. EPA. Pages 44-49. ln:A.
Hamblin, ed. Environmental Indicators for Sustainable Agriculture. Bureau of Rural Resources, Dept. of
Primary Industry and Energy, Queen  Victoria Terra, Australia.

534.Walters, C.  1986. Adaptive Management  of Renewable Resources. MacMillan, New York.

This book discusses ways of dealing with uncertainty in the management of renewable resources, such
as fisheries and wildlife. The basic theme is that management should be viewed as an adaptive
process. The potentials of  natural populations to sustain harvesting mainly through experience with
management itselt,  rather than through basic research or the development of general ecological theory
are discussed.  The book includes sections on model building, problem bounding, and uncertainty in
environmental analysis.
                                              140

-------
535.Walters, C.J., and C. Moiling. 1990. Large-scale management experiments and learning by doing.
Ecology 71 (6) :2060-2068.

Even unmanaged ecosystems are characterized by combinations of stability and instability and by
unexpected shifts in behavior from both internal and external causes. This is even more true of
ecosystems managed for the production of food or fiber.  Data are  sparse, knowledge of processes Is
limited, and the act of management changes the system being managed.  Surprise and  change are
inevitable.  The authors review methods to develop, screen, and evaluate alternatives in a process in
which management itself becomes partner with the science by designing probes that produce updated
understanding as well as economic product.

536.Ward, R.C.  1992. Indicator selection: A key element in monitoring system design.  Pages 147-158.
In: D. McKenzie, D.E. Hyatt, and J. McDonald, eds. Ecological Indicators. Proceedings of the
International Symposium on Ecological Indicators held in Fort Lauderdale, FL, 16-19 October 1990.
Elsevier,  Essex,  England.

537.Warlng, R. 1991. Ecosystem stress and disturbance. In: J. Cole et al., eds. Comparative Analysis
of Ecosystems: Patterns,  Mechanisms, and Theories. Springer-Verlag, New York.

538.Waring, R.H., J.D. Aber, J.M. Melillo, and B. Moore HI. 1991. Precursors of change in terrestrial
ecosystems. Bioscience 36(7):433-438.

In this article, the authors describe some ecosystem variables that are precursors of change and
indicate the potential of using remote sensing to assess these variables.  Topics covered are changes
in net photosynthesis and transpiration,  patterns of carbon allocation,  plant maintenance respiration,
and organic matter turnover.

539.Weber, F.R. 1990. Preliminary indicators for monitoring changes  in the natural resource base.  AID
Program  Design and Evaluation Methodology-14;  AID-PN-AAX-233. NTIS No. PB90-262056/HDM.
Agency for International Development, Center for  Development Information and Evaluation,
Washington, DC. 43 pp.

The paper describes ten simple, practical indicators of the natural resource base and suggests ways in
which they can assist the Agency for International Development (AID) field personnel to  monitor both
the negative and positive impacts of project interventions on natural resources—soils, water, natural
vegetation, and wildlife.  It also discusses methods for collecting and using the indicators, stressing
reliance on locally available information  and simple techniques.  Furthermore, the paper contains a brief
discussion on indicators for measuring impacts on areas of historical,  religious, cultural, and scientific
significance. Although the main thrust of the paper deals with identifying impacts at project-output and
objective levels, it also touches on how  indicators can eventually be used  to measure longer range
impacts of USAID Mission programs, particularly in dealing with agricultural and rural development.

540.Welnert, E.  1991. Biomonitoring of  environmental change using plant distribution patterns. Pages
179-190.  In: D.W. Jeffrey and B.  Madden, eds. Bioindicators and Environmental Management.
Academic Press, London.

Plant  distribution depends on autoecological requirements of and behavior of species and on the
environmental situation, which is characterized by a complex interaction of biotic and abiotic factors.
Biomonitoring of environmental change may be accomplished by recording changes in the regional and
local distribution  of indicator plants as individuals,  populations, and  communities.

Distribution patterns of sensitive indicator plants are used to illustrate the range and intensity of human
impact (air, soil, and water pollution) that has led to  environmental change in central European
landscapes.

Key Words:  Phytoindicator,  Distribution pattern, Extinction, Expansion, Recession, Pollution,
Environmental change, Central Germany
                                              141

-------
541.Weinstein, D.A., and E.M. Birk. 1989. The effects of chemicals on the structure of terrestrial
ecosystems: Mechanisms and patterns of change. Pages 181-209. In: S.  Levin, M. Harwell, J. Kelly,
and K. Kimball, eds. Ecotoxicology: Problems and Approaches. Columbia University  Press, New York.

This chapter is divided into the following sections: mechanisms of chemical exposure, effects of
disturbance on organisms, consequences of organism injury to alterations in ecosystem structure, and
chronic exposures. The authors conclude that severe cases of physically and chemically induced
stresses in ecosystems have similar consequences with regard to retarding the development of
ecosystem biomass and composition.  Chronic levels of chemical exposure create a very different
perturbation than physical disturbance. As a consequence, the mechanisms that operate following
these perturbations differ, as do the changes in structural properties that result from  those mechanisms.


542.Westman, W.  1978. Measuring the inertia and resilience of ecosystems. Bioscience 28:705-710.

The resilience of natural ecosystems is a property of keen interest to both theoretical and applied
ecologists. Resilience,  in this context, refers to the degree, manner, and  pace of restoration of initial
structure and function in an  ecosystem after disturbance.  It is an important ecological characteristic,
reflecting ultimately the nature and complexity of homeostatic processes in an ecosystem.  A property
distinct from this is the ability of a system to resist displacement in structure or function  when subjected
to a disturbing force.  This property is referred to as "inertia."  Notions of inertia and  resilience in
ecosystems are of considerable interest to applied ecologists,  environmental managers, and planners.

543.White, D., A.J. Kimerling, and W.S. Overton. 1992. Cartographic and geometric components of a
global sampling design for environmental monitoring. Cartogr. Geogr. Inform. Syst 19(1):5-22.

A comprehensive environmental monitoring program based on a sound statistical design is necessary
to provide estimates of the status of, and changes or trends in, the condition of ecological resources. A
sampling design based upon a systematic grid can adequately assess the condition  of many types of
resources and retain  flexibility for addressing new issues as they arise. The randomization of this grid
requires that it be regular and retain equal-area cells when projected on the surface of the  earth. After
review of existing approaches to constructing regular subdivisions of the earth's surface, the authors
propose the  development of the sampling on the Lambert azimuthal equal area map projection of the
earth's surface to the face of a truncated icosahedron fit to the globe. This geometric model has less
deviation in area when  subdivided as a spherical tessellation than any of the spherical Platonic solids,
and less distortion in  shape over the extent of a face when used for a projection surface by the Lambert
azimuthal  projection.  A hexagon face of the truncated icosahedron covers the entire conterminous
United States, and can be decomposed into a triangular grid at an appropriate density for sampling.
The geometry of the triangular grid provides for varying the density, and points on the grid  can be
addressed in several ways.

Key Words: Global sampling design, Sampling grid, Map projections, Polyhedral tessellation, Truncated
icosahedron, Hierarchical grid geometry

544.White, G., et al.  1990.  The use of forest ecosystem process measurements in an integrated
environmental monitoring program in the Wind River Range. In: Proceedings-Symposium on Whitebark
Pine Ecosystems. General Technical Report INT-270. U.S. Department of Agriculture Forest Service,
Intermountain Research Station.

545.Whittier, T.R., and S.G. Paulsen. In Press. 1993. The surface water component of the
Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program: An overview. J. Aquat. Ecosyst. Health.

546.Wiersma, G.B. 1985. Recommended integrated monitoring system for pollutants on U.S. National
Parks. Informal report, EGG-PBS-6721. EG&G Idaho, Inc., Idaho Falls.
                                              142

-------
547.Williams, B., and M. Mar cot. 1991. Use of biodiversity indicators for analyzing and managing
forested landscapes. Pages 613-627. In: R. McCabe, ed. Transactions of the 56th North American
Wildlife and Natural Resources Conference. Wildlife Management Institute, Washington, DC.

This paper presents: (1) an overview of biodiversity of Klamath National Forest (KNF) and Klamath
Physiographic Province; (2) examples of how past land management trends have affected biodiversity
in the U.S Pacific Northwest; (3) a generalized approach to planning for biodiversity in National Forest
Land Management Plans and; (4) a set of indicators of biodiversity being used on KNF to evaluate the
effects of management alternatives on biodiversity and some preliminary data reflecting current
conditions on KNF relating to the indicators.

548.Woodley, S., and J. Theberge. 1992. Monitoring for ecosystem  integrity in Canadian National
Parks.  Pages 369-377. In:  J.H.M. Willison,  S. Bondrup-Nielsen, C. Drysdale, T.B. Herman, N.W.P.
Munro, and T.L. Pollack, eds. Science and the Management of Protected Areas. (Series: Developments
in Landscape Management and Urban Planning 7). Elsevier Science  Publishers, Amsterdam.

549.Woodward, F., and A. Diament. 1991. Functional approaches to predicting the ecological effects
of global change. Funct. Ecol. 5(2):202-212.

This paper is concerned with the potential of physiological ecology to investigate and predict the effects
of global environmental change on communities, ecosystems, or vegetation.  The aim is to incorporate
the mechanistic approach of physiological ecology with the large-scale approach of ecosystem ecology,
both in time and space, to  provide a scaling-down approach to ecological investigation and prediction.
This paper describes modelled examples of approaches for investigating physiological ecology at larger
scales.  They attempt to avoid the problems of scaling-up and exploit the  benefits of scaling-down, as
an approach to understanding function and the connections between  function and structure.

Key Words: Climate change, Fire, Forest, Grassland, Microwave backscatter, Saline soils, Scaling, Soil
water, Sound, Transpiration

550.Woodward, F., G. Thompson, and I.  McKee. 1991. The effects of elevated concentrations of
carbon dioxide on individual plants, populations, communities and ecosystems.  Ann. Bot. 67: 23-38.

Changes in atmospheric concentrations of CO2, over periods of millennia, are positively correlated with
the temperature of the world.  It is expected that this positive correlation will be manifested in the future,
warmer "greenhouse world" that will  have higher concentrations of atmospheric CO2. The predicted
changes in temperature and precipitation are expected to cause significant changes in the distribution
patterns of the world's terrestrial vegetation.

In addition to this indirect effect, CO2 influences plants directly; an increase in the concentration of CO2
may increase the rate of photosynthesis in  plants  with the C3 pathway of fixation.  Experimental
observations often differ in the degree and  length of this stimulation, reflecting the stronger impact of
other photosynthetic limitations.  Where photosynthetic stimulation does occur, there is a general
decrease in leaf protein, which may stimulate rates of leaf herbivory.  The well-established and
associated  increase in the  C/N ratio of individual leaves should reduce rates of  leaf decomposition.
However, the few community experiments at elevated  CO2 suggest little change in the rate of nutrient
cycling in communities.

Stomatal opening is generally reduced as CO2 concentration increases.  This feature scale-up through
to the community level, however, it appears that the total volume of water used by a community is
unlikely to alter with CO2 alone because plants tend to develop leafier canopies. This change, plus
enhanced rates of root development, indicate a  greater potential for carbon sequestration by terrestrial
ecosystems.  Monthly observations of atmospheric CO2 concentration above the tundra over the last 14
years indicate these expected increases in  the rates of CO2 drawdown by the northern ecosystems of
the tundra and the boreal and temperate deciduous forests. However, some of this change may be the
result of interactions with the warmer climate of  the 1980s and perhaps an increased aerial supply of
pollutant nitrogen.
                                              143

-------
Key Words: CO.,, Plant ecophysiology, Population biology, Ecosystem function and structure

551.Woodwell, G.  1970. Effects of pollution on the structure and physiology of ecosystems. Science
168:429-433.

This article summarizes the effects of chronic irradiation of a late successional oak-oine forest at
Brookhaven  National Laboratory, Long Island, New York.  In addition it discusses the general pattern of
ecosystem response to pollution.

552.Woodwell, G.  1975. Threshold problems in ecosystems. Pages 9-21. In: S. Levin, ed. Ecosystem
Analysis and Prediction. Society for Industrial and Applied Mathematics (SIAM), Philadelphia.

This article outline some of the issues surrounding the question  "Is  it reasonable to assume that
thresholds for effects of disturbance exist in natural ecosystems, or are all disturbances effective,
cumulative, and detrimental to the normal functioning of natural ecosystems?" It covers such factors as
distinguishing short-term or acute disturbances from chronic, long-term change and addresses the
question of what to measure when we seek thresholds for changes in ecosystems that normally change
more or less continuously.

553.Yasuno, M., and B. Whitlon, eds. 1988. Proceedings of the International Symposium on
Biomonitoring of the State of the Environment. Tohai University Press, Tokyo.

554.Zachariassen, K., T. Aunass, J. Borseth, and S. Einerson. 1991. Physiological parameters in
ecotoxicology.  Comp.  Biochem. Physiol. 100C(1/2):77-79.

1.  Regulated physiological parameters are normally maintained at a constant level by regulatory
       mechanisms.  Acute toxic effects develop whenever a pollutant causes a regulated parameter
       to be displaced beyond tolerated limits, and thus, regulated parameters may be convenient
       toxicity parameters.  The presented study indicates that  delta uNa+ across the adductor muscle
       membrane of  Mytilus edulis is a regulated parameter and that injuries develop whenever this
       parameter drops below -7000 J/mole.
2.  Regulatory physiological parameters may display quick and substantial changes when regulatory
       mechanisms are activated to  counteract variations in the regulated parameters. Thus,
       regulatory parameters may be used as sensitive alarm parameters in environmental monitoring.
       Results indicate that the phosphate index l(ATP x P-arginineVP,)2], metabolic rate, and
       strombine may be used as alarm parameters.
3.  The combined response of  all parameters may provide  a pollutant-specific fingerprint in
       environmental monitoring.

555.Zhou, J.H., S.J. Ma, and C.M. Chen. 1991. An index  of ecosystem diversity. Ecol. Modell. 59(3-
4):151-163.

An information entropy index is presented to measure ecosystem diversity based on the numbers  of
components and the strengths  of interactions between them.

Key Words:  Species diversity, Stability, Communities, Complexity

556.Zonneveld, I.  1983. Principles of bio-indication. Environ. Monitor. Assess. 3:207-217.

One can apply "indication" with two different incentives:

       • in order to gain more knowledge on the indicated item in a purely scientific sense or

       • to be able to judge the quality of the indicated item (applied research).

The latter goes further than the former because it requires a presumption of good and evil and a
consideration of society.  In this paper the authors restrict discussion to the indication as  such.
                                              144

-------